UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
FORM 10-K
 
 (Mark One)  
 ýANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 201729, 2019 
 ¨TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 
Commission file number 001-34460
KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
 Delaware 13-3818604 
 
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 
4820 Eastgate Mall, 10680 Treena St., Suite 200600
San Diego, CA 9212192131
(858) (858812-7300
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including
area code, of Registrant’s principal executive offices)
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OF THE ACT
 Title of Each Classeach class Trading Symbol(s)Name of each exchange on which registered 
 Common Stock, $0.001 par value $0.001 KTOSThe NASDAQ Global Select Market 
SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(g) OF THE ACT
None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yesý No ¨
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes ¨Noý
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant:registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.   Yesý  No o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (Section 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).   Yesý  No o
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company, or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act:
Large accelerated filerýAccelerated filer
 
Large accelerated filer ý
 
Accelerated
Non-accelerated fileroSmaller reporting company
 
 
Non-accelerated filer o
Smaller reporting company o
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
Emerging growth companyo
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. Yes o  No o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).   Yes o  No ý
The aggregate market value of the registrant’s voting and non-voting common stock held by non-affiliates as of June 23, 2017,28, 2019, the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, was approximately $822.4 million,$2,061.5 billion, based on the closing sale price for shares of the registrant’s common stock as reported by the NASDAQ Global Select Market on such date. This disclosure excludes shares of common stock held by executive officers, directors and stockholders whose individual ownership exceeds 10% of the common stock outstanding on June 23, 201728, 2019 because such persons may be deemed to be affiliates. This determination of affiliate status is not necessarily a conclusive determination for any other purpose.
As of February 23, 2018, 103,513,10320, 2020, 106,941,556 shares of the registrant’s common stock were outstanding.
 





Documents Incorporated by Reference
Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 of Part III of this annual report on Form 10-K incorporate information by reference from the registrant’s definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A in connection with the registrant’s 20182020 Annual Meeting of Stockholders or an amendment to this annual report on Form 10-K to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the close of the fiscal year covered by this annual report on Form 10-K.





2



KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
FORM 10-K
FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 201729, 2019
 
TABLE OF CONTENTS
  Page
  
  
  
  

2





All references to “us,” “we,” “our,” the “Company” and “Kratos” refer to Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its subsidiaries.
FORWARD‑LOOKING STATEMENTS
This Annual Report on Form 10-K (this “Annual Report”) contains “forward-looking statements” relating to our future financial performance, the market for our services and our expansion plans and opportunities. In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terminology such as “may,” “will,” “should,” “expect,” “plan,” “anticipate,” “believe,” “estimate,” “predict,” “potential,” or “continue,” the negative of such terms or other comparable terminology. These forward-looking statements reflect our current beliefs, expectations and projections, are based on assumptions, and are subject to known and unknown risks and uncertainties that could cause our actual results or achievements to differ materially from any future results or achievements expressed in or implied by our forward-looking statements. Many of these factors are beyond our ability to control or predict. As a result, you should not place undue reliance on forward-looking statements. The most important risks and uncertainties that could cause our actual results or achievements to differ materially from the results or achievements expressed in or implied by our forward-looking statements, include, but are not limited to those specifically addressed in Item 1A “Risk Factors” in this Annual Report, as well as those discussed elsewhere in this Annual Report. These forward-looking statements reflect our views and assumptions only as of the date such forward-looking statements are made. Except as required by law, we assume no responsibility for updating any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.


PART I.


Item 1. Business.


Overview


Kratos is a government contractor at the forefront of the U.S. Department of Defense’s (the “DoD”) Third Offset Strategyrecapitalization of strategic weapon systems to address peer and near peer threats and its related Rapid Innovation Initiatives. Kratos is a leading technology, intellectual property, proprietary product and system solution company focused on the U.S. and its allies’ national security. Kratos is a recognized industry leader in the rapid development, demonstration and fielding of high technology systems and products at an affordable cost. A key element of our business plan is to make Company-funded investments related to key platforms, productsKratos’ primary focus areas are unmanned systems, space and systems, so that we own the related intellectual property, providing us designed in, sole and single source positions with our offerings. We are an industry leader in high performance, jet powered, unmanned aerial drone target systems used to test weapon systems and to train the warfighter and a provider of high performance unmanned combat aerial systems for force multiplication and amplification. We are also an industry leader in satellite communications, microwave electronics, cyber security/warfare, training systems, missile defense, turbine technologies, and combat and training systems. Our workforce is primarily engineering and technically oriented with a significant number of employees holding national security clearances. Substantially all of our work is performed at customer locations, in a secure facility or at a critical infrastructure location. Our primary end customers are national and homeland security related agencies.C5ISR (as defined below). We believe that our technology, intellectual property, proprietary products and designed-in positions on our customers’ programs, platforms and systems, and our ability to rapidly develop, demonstrate and field affordable leading technology systems gives us a competitive advantage and creates a high barrier to entry into our markets. Our workforce is primarily engineering and technically oriented with a significant number of employees holding national security clearances. Much of our work is performed at customer locations, or in a secure manufacturing facility. Our primary end customers are national security related agencies. Our entire organization is focused on executing our strategy of becoming the leading technology and intellectual property based product and system company in our industry.


Industry Update
 
In May 2017,On December 18, 2019, President Trump signed two 2020 spending bills totaling $1.4 trillion. The bills allocate $738 billion to the President signed into law the fiscal year (“FY”) 2017 Consolidated Appropriations Act. In total for 2017, Congress appropriated $524military and $632 billion in base discretionary funding for the DoD, consistent with the Budget Control Actto non-defense agencies, representing increases over FY 2019 of 2011 (the “BCA”). Congress also appropriated approximately $68 billion in Overseas Contingency Operations (“OCO”) funding and approximately $15 billion in additional DoD appropriations.

In May 2017, the President released a revised FY 2018 budget request, which seeks $575$22 billion for the DoD’sPentagon and $27 billion for non-defense agencies. The National Defense Authorization Act (“NDAA”) grants a base budget of approximately $52$666.5 billion above(including the statutory caps providedestablishment of a new, sixth armed service for in the BCA. The President’s budget request also seeksspace) and an additional $65$71.5 billion in OCOfor overseas contingency operations funding, for expeditionary needs, not capped bya.k.a. the BCA.

On September 8, 2017, the President signed a continuing resolution which generally funded the government at FY 2017 levels through December 8, 2017. The continuing resolution was extended to December 22, 2017 and further extended to January 19, 2018. As Congress did not enact appropriations legislation or a new continuing resolution by January 19, 2018, on January 20, 2018, the U.S. Government temporarily shut down. On January 22, 2018, a fourth continuing resolution was

3


enacted, which funded the government through February 8, 2018.

On February 9, 2018, the Congress approved and the President signed the Bipartisan Budget Act of 2018, which provides that:

1.spending limits created by the BCA will be increased by approximately $300 billion over the next two years;
2.defense spending will be increased by $80 billion in the current FY and by $85 billion next year, to approximately $700 billion and $705 billion, respectively;
3.domestic spending will be increased by $63 billion this year and by $68 billion next year; and
4.Congress will suspend the debt limit through March 2019, putting the next debt limit vote past the 2018 midterm elections.

The Congress and the President also executed a fifth continuing resolution authorization through March 23, 2018, to provide congressional appropriators the time required to appropriately document and allocate the authorized spending.

war budget. The federal budget and debt ceiling are expected to continue to be the subject of considerable debate, which could have a significant impact on defense spending broadly and the Company’s programs in particular inparticular. The U.S. Government’s fiscal year (“FY”) ends September 30.

The budget environment, including budget caps mandated by the future.Budget Control Act of 2011 (“BCA”) for fiscal years 2020 and 2021, and uncertainty surrounding the debt ceiling and the appropriations process, remain significant short and long-term risks. Considerable uncertainty exists regarding how future budget and program decisions will unfold, including the defense spending priorities of the Administration and Congress and what challenges budget reductions (required by the BCA and otherwise) will present for the defense industry. If annual appropriations bills are not timely enacted for FY 2021 or beyond, the U.S. Government may again operate under a continuing resolution, restricting new contract or program starts, presenting resource allocation challenges and placing limitations on some planned program budgets, and we may face another government shutdown of unknown duration. If a prolonged government shutdown of the DoD were to occur, it could result in


program cancellations, disruptions and/or stop work orders and could limit the U.S. Government’s ability to effectively progress programs and to make timely payments, and our ability to perform on our U.S. Government contracts and successfully compete for new work.
Additionally, funding for certain programs in which we participate may be reduced, delayed or cancelled, and global budget cuts could adversely affect the U.S. Government’s ability to make timely payments.viability of our subcontractors, suppliers, and employee base. While we believe that our business is well-positioned in areas that the DoD and other customers have indicated are areas of focus for future defense spending, the long-term impact of the BCA, other defense spending cuts, challenges in the appropriations process, the debt ceiling and the ongoing fiscal debates remain uncertain.


Significant delays or reductions in appropriations; long-term funding under a continuing resolution; an extended debt ceiling breach or government shutdown; and/or future budget and program decisions, among other items, may negatively impact our business and programs and could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flows.

Current Reporting Segments
 
The Company currently operates in threetwo reportable segments. The Kratos Government Solutions (“KGS”) reportable segment which is comprised of an aggregation of KGS operating segments, theincluding our microwave electronic products, space, training and cybersecurity, C5ISR/modular systems, turbine technologies, and defense and rocket support services operating segments. The Unmanned Systems (“US”) reportable segment and the Public Safety & Security (“PSS”) reportable segment.

KGS has four operating segments: Defense Rocket Support Services (“DRSS”), Microwave Electronics Division (“ME”), Technical and Training Solutions (“TTS”), and Modular Systems (“MS”) that provide technology-based defense solutions, involving products and services, primarily for mission critical U.S. National Security priorities, with the primary focus relating to the nation’s Command, Control, Communications, Computing, Combat Systems, Intelligence, Surveillance and Reconnaissance requirements. The US reportable segment providesconsists of our unmanned aerial systemssystem and unmanned ground and seaborne systems. The PSS reportable segment provides integrated solutions for advanced homeland security, public safety, critical infrastructure security, and security and surveillance systems for government, industrial and commercial customers.system products.


We organize our businessoperating segments based primarily on the nature of the products, solutions and services offered. Transactions between segments are negotiated and accounted for under terms and conditions similar to other government and commercial contracts, and these intercompany transactions are eliminated in consolidation. For additional information regarding our reportable segments, see Note 1314 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.Statements contained within this Annual Report. From a customer and solutions perspective, we view our business as an integrated whole, leveraging skills and assets wherever possible.


On February 27, 2019, the Company acquired 80.1% of the issued and outstanding shares of capital stock of Florida
Turbine Technologies Inc., a Florida corporation (“FTT Inc.”), and 80.1% of the membership interests in FTT CORE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“FTT Core” and, together with FTT Inc. and their respective subsidiaries, “FTT”), for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $60 million. FTT is a leading turbomachinery design and manufacturing company specializing in engineering, development, and testing of gas turbines, propulsion components, engine and other systems for military and commercial applications. FTT is now the KTT Division, which is focused on the development and production of small, affordable, high-performance jet engines for the next generation of tactical weapon systems and tactical jet Unmanned Aerial Systems (“UAS”). The KTT Division is included in the KGS segment. For additional information regarding the acquisition of FTT, see Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report.

Competitive Strengths
We believe that our intellectual property, proprietary products, and technology are strongly aligned with certain of the highest priority spending areas of the DoD including the 2018 National Defense Strategy document, and the DoD’s focus on leveraging technology to defeat or deter peer and near-peer adversaries. We also believe that our proven ability to rapidly design, develop, demonstrate and field leading technology products and systems at an affordable cost differentiates us from our competitors. When combined withWe believe that our longstanding customer relationships, and the designed-in position of our systems, technology and products into our customers’ platforms, programs and systems, we believe these factors provide a unique competitive advantage and position us well for accelerated growth.


Specialized national security focus aligned with mission-critical national security priorities. Continued concerns related to the threats posed by certain foreign nations, including nations with peer or near peer capabilities and terrorists have caused the U.S. Government to identify national security as an area of functional and spending priority. Budget pressures, particularly related to DoD spending, have placed a premium on developing and fielding low-cost, high-technology solutions to assist in national security missions. While recent budget pressures have at times caused delays in orders for our business, current budget projections, including the pendingrecently enacted fiscal 20182020 DoD budget, the Pentagon’s fiscal 2021 DoD budget request which was released on February 10, 2020 and 2019 DoD budgets,the Fiscal Year Defense Plan (“FYDP”), suggest defense spending will increase over the next few years. The improving outlook for defense spending is primarily focused on enhanced power projection,

4


warfighting readiness, lethality, and recapitalization of key strategic defense systems to address peer and near peer threats. Our primary


capabilities and areas of focus, listed below, are strongly aligned with the objectives of the U.S. Government:Government as outlined in the 2018 National Defense Strategy document:
Unmanned aerial drone, unmanned ground and unmanned seaborne systems and artificial intelligence
Satellite communications and radio frequency interference detection location and mitigation
Microwave electronics supporting warfare, missile, radar and communication systems
Electronic warfare, attack, missile, and radar systems
Intelligence, surveillance and reconnaissance
Ballistic missile defense and hypersonic systems
Command, control and combatC5ISR systems
CybersecurityCyber security and information assurance
Specialized training systems and operational readiness


IP-centric defense company with proprietary products and technology which address critical current and emerging threats faced by U.S. and allied militaries. As a technology-focused defense company at the forefront of the DoD’s strategy offor technology rich and affordable systems, our current and growing portfolio of proprietary systems, products, solutions, and related intellectual property addresses some of the most critical needs of U.S. and allied militaries in the fields of unmanned systems, space & satellite communications, microwave electronics, cybersecurity/cyber security/warfare, missile defense, combat and training systems. A key element of our customers’ strategy, and where we have invested significantly, is the development of capabilities and intellectual property addressing the recent challenges faced by U.S. and allied militaries in Anti-Access and Aerial-Denial (“A2/AD”) environments. This is evidenced by our significant investment in high-performance Unmanned Aerial Drone System (“UADS”) platforms and technology, which has culminated in a series of Unmanned Combat Aerial System (“UCAS”) contract wins. Additionally, with our space & satellite and terrestrial ground segment command, control, radio frequency interference monitoring, geolocation and mitigation products and capabilities, we believe we are well-positioned to capitalize on the 20182020 DoD budget request of $9.3 billion for space investments, a 29.1 percent increase over the 2017 budget, and a significant portion of which is for the development and protection of U.S. national security space assets and infrastructure. Accordingly, our proprietary products, systems and technologies are developed and refined with the goal of enabling our customers to maintain an advantage over the advanced and constantly evolving threats of adversaries, at an affordable cost. In many instances, we are one of the few companies that produce the mission-critical technology our customers require, or we outperformed our peers in a competitive bidding process. We maintain a strategy of internally funding research and development and owning the intellectual property of many of these high-performance capabilities and systems.
Technology-driven company aligned with and supporting our customers’ increased innovation, technology, and strategic national security initiatives, with focus on speed and affordability. As the DoD works to increase or maintain its technological advantage over adversaries, it has continued its efforts to create breakthrough technologies for national security, accelerate innovation to the warfighter, and repurpose current capabilities to create cost-effective, disruptive technology advances. With our focus on delivering proven leading edge systems, products and technologies that address the most critical current and emerging threats, our customers include some of the most technologically advanced organizations of the defense establishment, including the Defense Innovation Unit (“DIU”) (formerly the Defense Innovation Unit Experimental (“DIUx”)), Defense Advanced Research Projects Agency (“DARPA”), Air Force Research Laboratory (“AFRL”), the Strategic Capabilities Office (SCO), the Strategic Command (STRATCOM), the National Aeronautics and Space Administration, the U.S. intelligence community, and other confidential customers. We believe our focus on constant innovation, capability improvements across our product and solutions portfolio, speed of development, and production and affordability are key differentiators that align us with and address our customers’ key initiatives.
In-depth understanding of customer missions. We have a reputation for successfully and rapidly designing, developing, demonstrating and fielding mission-critical products, solutions and services to our customers, at an affordable cost. Our long-term relationships with the U.S. Air Force, U.S. Army, U.S. Navy and other national security related customers and agencies enable us to develop an in-depth understanding of their missions, problems and technical requirements. In addition, a substantial number of our employees are located at our customer locations, or at secure manufacturing facilities, or at critical infrastructure locations, all of which provides Kratos with valuable strategic insight into our customers’ ongoing missions and future program and mission requirements. This understanding of our customers’ missions, requirements, and needs, in conjunction with the strategic location of our employees, enables us to offer technical solutions tailored to our customers’ specific requirements and evolving mission objectives. In addition, once our products are “designed in” and we are on-site with a customer and providing our products and solutions, wehave historically been successful in winning new and recompete business.
Kratos is one of thean industry leadersleader in high performance, jet powered, unmanned aerial target drone systems which are designed to replicate state of the art adversarial fighter aircraft, missiles and other threats. Kratos is the sole source or primary unmanned aerial target drone system provider to the U.S. Air Force, Navy, Army, and numerous allied foreign defense agencies.

5



Leveraging off of this technology, for which Kratos owns the intellectual property, we made a significant investment over the past foursix years developing Kratos’ first UCAS, our Unmanned Tactical Aerial Platform (“UTAP-22”), now formally called “Mako.” After successfully achieving the Mako’s first concept flights at the end of 2015, in 2016 we received a $12.6 million single-award contract to demonstrate certain payload integration and loyal wingman teaming with manned aircraft in a major military exercise. ThisAt the time, this contract iswas one of the largest recently awarded contracts by the DIUx. We are currently under contract with several additional customers related to Kratos’ Mako.


A select sample of Kratos’ other key Kratos’ UAS products and contracts includes:
In 2016, we were awarded two of the four Gremlins Phase I UAS contracts awarded by DARPA, the government’s leader in breakthrough technologies for national security. For one contract we are a prime or lead contractor, and for the other contract we are teamed with a lead partner company.
In 2017, we successfully advanced to Phase II of the Gremlin’sGremlins program, awarded by DARPA, the U.S. Government’s leader in breakthrough technologies for national security, teamed with our partner company.company, Dynetics. In 2018, as part of the Dynetics led team, we were selected for award on Phase III of the Gremlins program to demonstrate safe and reliable launch and aerial recovery of multiple unmanned drone system aircraft, capable of employing and recovering diverse distributed payloads in volley quantities. In January 2020, DARPA and Dynetics announced that the successful first flight of the X-61A Gremlins Air Vehicle was completed on November 23, 2019.
In 2016, we were awarded the AFRL Low Cost Attritable Strike Demonstration (“LCASD”) UCAS single-award cost share contract. The LCASD, or Valkyrie, is an approximately 30 foot by 22 foot unmanned strike aerial drone system. We expectDuring 2019, the initialCompany announced that the Kratos/AFRL team successfully completed three flights for the Valkyrie, or the XQ-58A. In January 2020, the Company completed its fourth demonstration flight, including the successful deployment of this leading technology UAS to occurits parachutes, and landed normally, validating the design changes incorporated for the test flight airbag system following the third flight in 2018.2019.
In 2016 we were2019, the Kratos XQ-58A Valkyrie was awarded a contract by the DIUx related to our UTAP-22 Mako UCAS.Aviation Week’s Laureate Award for Defense Technology and Innovation.
We have redeveloped our Air Force Subscale Aerial Target BQM-167 into what we believe to be the highest performance unmanned aircraft in the world, the U.S. Navy Sub-Sonic Aerial Target (“SSAT”) Drone BQM-177A, with low rate initial production awarded to Kratos in June 2017. In 2018, delivery of the first production aerial targets was made to the U.S. Navy, and achievement of Initial Operational Capability (IOC) was reported by the U.S. Navy in February 2019. In 2019, the Company was awarded a $25.4 million contract for Lot 3 of low rate initial production for 34 BQM-177A aerial targets. To date, the Company has been awarded production orders for 105 BQM-177A aerial targets. We expect the SSAT program to become one of the largest and most important to Kratos in the near term.
We recentlyIn 2018, we received a single award $109 million maximum value three year production contract for Air Force Subscale Aerial Target BQM-167A, with $27 million being initially obligated at the time of $93award for 30 Lot 14 BQM-167A aerial targets and production support, and an additional $31.9 million being obligated for 35 Lot 15 BQM-167A targets in 2019.
In 2018, we received a ten-year, sole source, single award framework contract from QinetiQ UK for Kratos’ MQM-178 Firejet aerial targets, spares, ground support equipment, technical services, and training. In 2018, we were awarded a prime contract for the Aerial Target Systems 2 (ATS-2), Multiple Award Indefinite Delivery Indefinite Quantity (“IDIQ”) Contract with a ceiling value of $93.3 million, and a five year period of performance.
In 2018, we received a sole source, single award multi-year IDIQ contract from the U.S. Army Contract CommandSwedish Defence Materiel Administration for advanced subscaleour MQM-178 Firejet aerial drone systems, an unmanned target aircraft with launchers and associated ground support equipment, spares, payloads, components, expendables and spares, with an estimated completion datesupport services. The first order under the three-year IDIQ contract was received in the first half of December 17, 2022.
We recently received an approximately $23 million sole source initial production award2019. Additionally, there are two three-year exercisable option periods for a total potential contract performance term of nine years.
In 2019, the Company produced its first MQM-178 Firejet target drones at its new high performance, jet powered UADS which has been under development, with an expected execution period through 2018.

production facility in Oklahoma City.
We believe that our internally developed and owned intellectual property allows us to provide more capable jet powered, unmanned aircraft, designed to fly in A2/AD environments and with performance capabilities equal to or greater than fourth generation manned jet fighter aircraft, at an affordable cost. Kratos’ tactical UAS provide force multiplication and augmentation for manned high performance fighter aircraft. We believe that there are very few high-performance UAS that are affordable and as advanced as our technologies addressing the A2/AD environment, which the DoD has identified as a U.S.


capabilities gap. As such, consistent with the needs and requirements of the U.S. and allied militaries, we believe that our leadership in these types of high performance unmanned aircraft provides us with a future market opportunity of these types of low-cost, high-performance systems.
We are also an industry leader in ground-based command, control and communications systems for satellites, and a leader in related radio frequency interference identification, geolocation and mitigation.mitigation, or Space Situational Awareness (SSA). Our primary customers include the U.S. Air Force, Space Command and other agencies. Our microwave electronics business products have designed-in positions on critical combat system programs, including Barak, Gripen, Iron Dome, Sling of David, F-15, F-16, Gripen, and Arrow. Our advanced capabilities in the training systems and solutions market, including for aircraft and combat vehicles, have allowed us to successfully remain at the forefront of defense industry readiness initiatives. We believe our strategy of internally funding the research and development of many of our systems, products, solutions and capabilities will continue to solidify our position in high growth markets, such as high performance UADS, satellite communications, microwave electronics and training systems, and allow us to grow, over the long-term, at a rate greater than that of the industry.
Diverse base of key contracts with low concentration. Many of our contracts are single-award and/or sole source in nature, where we are the only awardee by the customer. In many cases, our ability to obtain single award, sole source contracts is due to our intellectual property, proprietary products, historical performance qualifications, relative experience and affordability. Additionally, as a result of our business development focus on securing key contracts, we are also a preferred contractor on numerous multi-year, government-wide acquisition contracts (“GWACs”) and multiple award contracts. Our preferred contractor status provides us with the opportunity to bid on billions of dollars of business each year against a discrete number of other pre-qualified companies.

6


We have a highly diverse base of customers and contracts with no contract representing more than 5%8% of 20172019 revenue. Our fixed-price contracts, the majority of which are production contracts, represent approximately 88%83% of our 20172019 revenue. Our cost-plus-fee contracts and time and materials contracts represent approximately 8%12% and 4%5%, respectively, of our 20172019 revenue. We believe our diverse base of key contracts and low reliance on any one contract provides us with a stable, balanced revenue stream. Our recent major contract awards, including a $93single award $223 million UASU.S. Navy contract for short and medium range suborbital flight vehicles (for which Kratos has teamed with Corvid Technologies), a $31.8 million funding award with the Army, $23 million UAS sole source initialfor production award, $37 million SSAT low rate initial production contract, $16 million in specialized equipment for radars and systems, $22 million Lot 13 Option Exercise15 for the Air Force Subscale Aerial Target program, $46a $35.0 million single award trainingIDIQ contract for Air Force subscale aerial target peculiar spares, $32.0 million in additional task orders awarded on Foreign Military Sales (“FMS”) to support the Royal Saudi Naval Forces, $54a prime contract award to deliver up to 33 Oriole Rocket motors to a U.S. Government customer, a $17.6 million Marine Common Aircrew Trainers, $20contract award for new tactical drone system research, development and initial production, a $24 million KC-46 Tanker Maintenance Training System,microwave electronic products contract in support of a missile system program, a C5ISR $50 million single award production contract in support of a National Security Program, a $39 million contract for 24-hour space-based RF signal communication (SSA) services, a $25.4 million contract for Lot 3 for BQM-177A aerial targets, and multiple tactical UADSspace and satellite communications awards have continued to allow us to grow the business while maintaining a diverse contract base.
Significant cash flow visibility driven by stable backlog. As of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, our total backlog (see Backlog below) was approximately $730.4$601.2 million and $899.7$620.7 million respectively, of which approximately $531.1$501.3 million was funded in 20172019 and $626.1$537.2 million was funded in 2016.2018. The majority of our sales are from awards issued under long-term contracts, typically three to five years in duration. Our contract backlog provides visibility into stable future revenue and cash flow over a diverse set of contracts. Importantly, a number of our systems and products are designed-in on and support long term, multi-year/multi-decade programs, which provides significant operational and financial visibility to our Company.
Highly skilled employees and an experienced management team. We deliver our systems, products and services through a skilled and primarily engineering and technically oriented workforce of approximately 2,9003,000 employees. Our senior managers have significant experience with U.S. Government agencies, the U.S. military and U.S. Government contractors. A significant number of Kratos employees hold national security clearances. Members of our management team have experience growing businesses both organically and through acquisitions and delivering significant value to stakeholders. We believe that the cumulative experience and differentiated expertise of our personnel in our core focus areas, coupled with our sizable and technically oriented employee base, allow us to qualify for and bid on larger programs and contracts in a prime contracting role.
Our Strategy
Our strategy is to focus on our core business areas, including Unmanned Systems, Satellite Communications, Cyber Security, Microwave Electronics, Missile Defenseunmanned systems, space and Training Systems.satellite communications, cyber security, microwave electronics, missile defense and hypersonic systems, turbine technologies, training and C5ISR systems, which are closely aligned with the DoD’s mission and funding priorities. We will continue to invest in differentiating


systems, products, technology and intellectual property. We intend to be the leader in rapidly developing, demonstrating and delivering to the warfighter proven leading technology systems, at an affordable cost.
Internal Growth
We are focused on generating internal growth by capitalizing on our ability to rapidly develop, demonstrate and field leading technology systems and products at an affordable cost. We will make targeted discretionary investments in mission critical DoD priority areas, including;including unmanned systems, space and satellite communications, cyber security, microwave electronics, cyber securitymissile defense and training systems, which have the highest potential for growth based on recent DoD funding requests, and in which we will retain the intellectual property rights.
Expand technology product, solution and service offerings provided to existing customers. We are focused on expanding the technology, products, systems and solutions we provide to our current customers by leveraging our strong relationships, technical capabilities, intellectual property and past performance qualifications as well as by offering a wider range of comprehensive low-cost technology richleading and proven products and solutions. In regard to areas of specialization, our product and solution offerings include the manufacturing of specialized defense electronics; integrated technology solutions for satellite command, control and communications; specialized high performance UADS and drone aircraft for tactical and threat representation target purposes; and Unmanned Ground Systems (“UGS”) and Unmanned Seaborne Systems (“USS”).Systems. We believe our understanding of customer needs, missions, requirements and processes, and our ability to rapidly deliver low cost, technology leading systems, products and solutions, position us well for success in the current National Securitynational security environment.
Capitalize on current contract base. We are pursuing new program and contract opportunities and awards as we build the business with our expanding technology base, intellectual property ownership, contract portfolio, and product, solution and service offerings. We are also aggressively pursuing several national security priority areas, including high performance UADS, satellite communications command, control, communication and signal monitoring products (SSA), microwave electronics for missiles, radars, electronic warfare and communications, cyber security solutions, specialized training systems, autonomy and artificial intelligence systems, robotics, directed energy systems, hypersonic systems, electromagnetic rail gun systems and next generation ballistic missile targets. We are also assessing new tactical program areas and platforms to pursue that are consistent with our core capabilities, technology and intellectual property.

7


Expand customer and contract base. We are focused on expanding our customer base into areas with significant growth opportunities as indicated by the FY 2018 and 20192020 DoD budget, request,the 2021 DoD budget requests and FYDP, and the 2018 National Defense Strategy document, by leveraging our technology, intellectual property, proprietary products, capabilities, industry reputation, long-term customer relationships and diverse contract base. We also believe that our ability to rapidly develop, demonstrate and field high technology systems and products at an affordable cost is a clear competitive differentiator for our Company. We anticipate that this overall expansion in our capabilities will enable us both to pursue larger program opportunities, higher value work and to further diversify our revenue base across additional U.S. Government, international and commercial customers.
Improve operating margins. We believe that we have opportunities to increase our operating margins and improve profitability by capitalizing on our corporate infrastructure investments as our business grows, production of our products and systems increases and related revenues increase. We are proactively focused on continuously improving efficiencies, reducing costs, and concentrating our efforts on operational excellence.
Invest in strategic growth areas. Over the past several years, we have made significant internally funded investments in strategic growth areas including unmanned tactical aircraft drone systems. Specifically, we have increased internally funded research and development, capital expenditures and infrastructure investments, including executive management, bid, proposal and new business capture, pursuit and related expenses. We have made these investments with the intention of developing, demonstrating, fielding and bringing to production high performance jet powered unmanned aerial combat systems. These investments also allow us to retain the intellectual property rights, design and data packages for these platforms and systems, and to ultimately secure sole source production positions in these strategic growth areas. Specifically, since 2012, we have invested over $85$120 million in our UAS through internally funded research, development and contract design retrofit costs for new platforms under development and capital expenditures for aircraft and related equipment related to this strategic growth area.
We invested in internally funded research, development and capital expenditures to build our own UTAP-22 (Mako) UAS from 2012 to 2015, and demonstrated the capabilities of the UTAP-22 Mako in a flight demonstration in the fall of 2015.2015 where Kratos Mako drones flew as an unmanned wingman to manned tactical fighter jet aircraft. As a result of these successful flights and capabilities demonstrations, we were awarded an initial $12.6 million prime contract from the DIUx for sensor integration and flight demonstration of our UTAP-22 Mako unmanned aerial system the following year. Under this effort, we integrated certain sensors into our


UTAP-22 Mako and participated in a large, complex flight exercise in 2017. WeAs a result of our development and demonstration of the Mako, we have been awarded several tactical and developmental awards, including an initial $17.6 million contract award in October 2019 for jet drone research, development and initial production efforts, with the scope of work and related funds under this program expected to increase as execution and performance milestones are currently working under a funded contract on Kratos’ UTAP-22 Mako.successfully achieved.
We received a $40.8 million single award, cost-share contract from the AFRL for the LCASD. Under the LCASD contract award, we are designing, developing, and will deliver, demonstrate and test a technical baseline for a high-speed long-range, low-cost limited life-strike UAS. For our investment, we will retain hard (including two LCASD aircraft) and other assets, and important intellectual property, software, data, platform and system rights, which we believe will be critically important and valuable over the expected long-term life of this platform, including with respect to future production opportunities. During 2019, the Company announced that the Kratos/AFRL team successfully completed three flights for the Valkyrie, or the XQ-58A. In January 2020, the Company completed its fourth demonstration flight, including the successful deployment of its parachutes, and landed nominally, validating the design changes incorporated for the test flight airbag system following the third flight in 2019.
We were awarded one of four prime contract awards from the DARPA for the Gremlins program. Under the Gremlins program, DARPA envisions a swarm of approximately 20 high performance unmanned aerial vehicles that are deployed by an inflight aircraft, and are later recovered, inflight, by an aircraft. The approximate $3.9 million Phase I contracts were awarded to four competing companies, with the intent to ultimately down select to one finalist company over a period of approximately 36 months. In 2017, we successfully advanced to Phase II of the Gremlin’s program, teamed with our partner company.company Dynetics. In 2018, as part of the Dynetics-led team, we were selected for award on Phase III of the Gremlins program to demonstrate safe and reliable launch and aerial recovery of multiple unmanned drone system aircraft, capable of employing and recovering diverse distributed payloads in volley quantities. In January 2020, DARPA and Dynetics announced that the successful first flight of the X-61A Gremlins Air Vehicle was completed on November 23, 2019. Kratos is a key subcontractor to Dynetics on the Gremlins program.


Capitalize on corporate infrastructure investments. In recent periods, we have made significant investments in our senior management and corporate infrastructure related to cyber security threats to our Company, increased and changing regulations we are subject to, and the changing national security industry environment. These investments also included hiring senior executives with significant experience in the national security industry, hiring firms to support us on Capitol Hill, Congressionally and with our customers, strengthening our internal controls over financial reporting and accounting staff in support of increasing public company reporting requirements, expanding our infrastructure in response to increases in cybersecuritycyber security protection and related regulatory requirements, and expanding our backlog and bid and proposal pipeline. We expect to be allocating additional resources in our pursuit of new, larger and highly technical prime contract opportunities. We believe our management experience and corporate infrastructure can support a company with a much larger revenue base than ours. Accordingly, we believe that, to the extent our revenue grows, we will be able to leverage this infrastructure base and increase our operating margins.

8


Customers
A representative list of customers in our KGS and US segments during 20172019 included the U.S. Air Force, U.S. Army, U.S. Navy, U.S. Marines, Missile Defense Agency, Space Command, the Department of Homeland Security, the National Aeronautics and Space Administration, Foreign Military Sales (“FMS”),FMS, the U.S. Southern Command, STRATCOM, the Strategic Capabilities Office (SCO), DIU or DIUx, the Rapid Capabilities Offices, the U.S. intelligence community and certain confidential customers. In 2017, representative customers in the PSS segment included Metropolitan Transportation Authority of New York, Prince George’s County Public Schools, Children’s Hospital of Philadelphia, JP Morgan Chase, Alamo Colleges, City of Galveston, Texas Orthopedic Hospital, Port Authority of New York & New Jersey, Fidelity, Scripps Clinic, PNC Bank, AT&T, Exxon, Calpine Power Plants, DuPont Fabros, BP America, Houston Community College, Siemens, San Francisco Municipal Transportation Agency, and New Flyer.
Revenue from the U.S. Government (which includes FMS) includes revenue from contracts for which we are the prime contractor as well as those for which we are a subcontractor and the ultimate customer is the U.S. Government. Revenues from U.S. Government agency customers in aggregate accounted for approximately 60%71%, 60%72% and 61%75% of total revenues in 2017, 2016,2019, 2018, and 2015,2017, respectively.

Revenues from foreign customers were approximately $84.7 million or 11%, $80.1 million or 12%, and $73.2 million or 11% of total revenue for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015, respectively.


Backlog
 
Effective January 1, 2018, we adopted the requirements of Accounting Standards Codification 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“ASC 606”), utilizing the modified retrospective method as discussed in Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report. Since our adoption of ASC 606, revenues from remaining performance obligations, also referred to as total backlog, are now calculated as the dollar value of our remaining performance obligations on executed contracts. As of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, our backlog was


approximately $730.4$601.2 million and $899.7$620.7 million, respectively, of which $531.1$501.3 million was funded in 20172019 and $626.1$537.2 million was funded in 2016. Backlog2018. We expect to recognize approximately 62.0% of the remaining total backlog as revenue in 2020, an additional 21.0% in 2021 and the balance thereafter.

Total backlog is our estimate of the amount of revenue we expectexpected to realizebe realized over the remaining life of awarded contracts and task orders that we have in hand as of the measurement date. Our totalTotal backlog consistscan include award fees, incentive fees, or other variable consideration estimated based on the most likely amount the Company is expected to be entitled to receive, to the extent that it is probable that a significant reversal of cumulative revenue recognized will not occur. Total backlog can include both funded and unfunded backlog. future revenue under government contracts. Total backlog does not include orders for which neither party has performed and which each party has the unilateral right to terminate a wholly unperformed contract without compensating the other party. As such, total backlog generally does not include options for additional performance obligations which have not been executed unless they are considered a material right of the base contract. For IDIQ contracts, only awarded or funded task orders are included for backlog purposes.

We define funded backlog as estimated future revenue under government contracts and task orders for which funding has been appropriated by Congress and authorized for expenditure by the applicable agency, plus ouran estimate of the future revenue we expectexpected to realizebe realized from our commercial contracts that are under firm orders. Our fundedFunded backlog does not include the full potential value of ourthe Company’s contracts because Congress often appropriates funds to be used by an agency for a particular program of a contract on a yearly or quarterly basis even though the contract may call for performance over a number of years. As a result, contracts typically are only partially funded at any point during their term, and all or some of the work to be performed under the contracts may remain unfunded unless and until Congress makes subsequent appropriation and the procuring agency allocates funding to the contract.

Unfunded backlog reflects our estimate of future revenue under awarded government contracts and task orders for which either funding has not yet been appropriated or the expenditure has not yet been authorized. Our total backlog does not include estimates of revenue from government wide acquisition contracts (“GWACs”) or General Services Administration (“GSA”) schedules beyond awarded or funded task orders, but our unfunded backlog does include estimates of revenue beyond awarded or funded task orders for other types of indefinite delivery or indefinite quantity (“IDIQ”) contracts based on our experience under such contracts and similar contracts. Unfunded backlog also includes priced options, which consist of the aggregate contract revenues expected to be earned as a result of a customer exercising an option period that has been specifically defined in the original contract award.

Contracts undertaken by us may extend beyond one year. Accordingly, portions are carried forward from one year to the next as part of backlog. Because many factors affect the scheduling of projects, no assurance can be given as to when revenue will be realized on projects included in our backlog. Although funded backlog represents only business that is considered to be firm, we cannot guarantee that cancellations or scope adjustments will not occur. The majority of funded backlog represents contracts with terms that would entitle us to all or a portion of our costs incurred and potential fees upon cancellation by the customer.


A significant number of the programs that KratosKratos’ systems, products and solutions support are multi-year/multi-decade in nature. Accordingly, based on historical customer usage or operational tempo, the Company has reasonable expectations or visibility of what ultimate orders for Kratos’ systems, products and solutions will be. The Company does not include these expected amounts in its backlog until a related contract award is received.


Management believes that year-to-year comparisons of backlog are not necessarily indicative of future revenues. The actual timing of receipt of revenues, if any, on projects included in backlog could change because many factors affect the scheduling of projects. In addition, cancellations or adjustments to contracts may occur. Backlog is typically subject to large

9


variations from quarter to quarter as existing contracts are renewed or new contracts are awarded. Additionally, all U.S. Government contracts included in backlog, whether or not funded, may be terminated at the convenience of the U.S. Government.

Upon the Company’s adoption of ASU 2014-09 on January 1, 2018, the Company’s backlog will be calculated as the dollar value of the remaining performance obligations on executed contracts. Backlog can include award fees, incentive fees, or other variable consideration estimated at the most likely amount to which the Company is expected to be entitled to the extent that it is probable that a significant reversal of cumulative revenue recognized will not occur. Backlog can include both funded and unfunded future revenue under government contracts. Backlog will not include orders for which neither party has performed and which each party has the unilateral right to terminate a wholly unperformed contract without compensating the other party. As such, backlog generally will not include options for additional performance obligations which have not been executed unless they are considered a material right of the base agreement or contract. For IDIQ contracts, only tasks that have been executed should be included for backlog purposes. Based on the expected impact to the reported backlog that will occur upon adoption of ASU 2014-09 on January 1, 2018, we expect that our backlog balance as of December 31, 2017 when recast on a pro forma comparative basis in accordance with ASU 2014-09 will be reduced.


Employees
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, we had a work force of approximately 2,9003,000 full-time, part-time and on-call employees.
Competition
Our market is competitive and includes a number of companies in the U.S. defense and National Securitynational security industries. Most of the companies that we compete against have significantly greater financial, technical, marketing and other resources and generate greater revenues than we do. Competition in the KGS and US segments include tier one, large U.S. Government contractors and system integrators such as Northrop Grumman, Lockheed Martin, General Dynamics, Raytheon, BAE Systems, L3, Orbital/ATKL3Harris, General Atomics and Boeing. While we view other government contractors as competitors, we also team with these same companies in joint proposals or in the delivery of our products, solutions and services for customers. Tier two competitors include smaller government contractors such as Mercury Computer,Systems, Qinetiq, Cobham, Aerojet Rocketdyne and AAR.AAR Corp. Intense competition and long operating cycles are key characteristics of our business within the defense industry. It is also common in the defense industry for work on major programs to be shared among a number of companies. A company competing to be a prime contractor or subcontractor on an award may, upon final award of the contract to another competitor, become a subcontractor for the final prime contractor. It is not unusual to compete for a contract award with a peer company


and simultaneously perform as a supplier to or be a customer of that same competitor on other contracts, or vice versa. The nature of major defense programs, conducted under binding contracts, allows companies that perform well to benefit from a level of program continuity not frequently found in other industries.
We believe that the principal competitive factors in our ability to win new business include our strategy of focusing on priority DoD requirements and funding areas, our intellectual property, proprietary products, technology and our ability to rapidly develop, demonstrate and deliver systems to the warfighter at an affordable cost. Also important is our past performance qualifications, customer relationships, domain and technology expertise, the ability to obtain and replace contract vehicles, the ability to deliver results within budget (time and cost), reputation, accountability, staffing flexibility, and project management expertise. Additionally, our ability to deliver cost effective systems, products, solutions and services that meet our customers’ requirements is also a key differentiator.
In the U.S. defense, IT, and services markets, the U.S. Government has stressed competition and affordability or low cost in connection with its future procurement of products and services. This has led to fewer sole source awards, as well as more emphasis on cost competitiveness, with contract awards issued on a Low Price Technically Acceptable (“LPTA”) basis rather than a best value basis, which has negatively impacted our DRSSDefense and Rocket Support Services (“DRSS”) business in our KGS segment. In addition, competitor bid protests have become more prevalent in the current competitive environment, resulting in further delay of contract procurement activity.
The majority of our government services business is included in our DRSS business. This cost competitive environment resulted in an impairment in the carrying value of our DRSS business in the fourth quarter of 2017. Approximately 10% of Kratos’ business for the year ended December 31, 2017 is IT or government services based. In 2010, Kratos changed its strategy to focus on being a system, product, technology and intellectual property based company and we deemphasized our focus in our legacy government services businesses. See the Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further discussion.

10


Research and Development
We believe that our future success depends upon our ability to continue to rapidly develop new products and services, and enhancements to and applications for our existing products and services, to be delivered at an affordable cost. Our research and development expenses were $18.0 million, $15.6 million and $17.8 million $13.9 millionin 2019, 2018, and $16.2 million in 2017, 2016, and 2015, respectively. We intend to continue our focus on research and development as a key strategy for growth, which will focus on investments in those fields that we believe will offer the greatest opportunity for growth and profitability. Our current primary internal research and development (“IR&D”)focus areas include satellite communications and signal monitoring, unmanned systems, electronic products, and electronic products.turbine technologies.
Intellectual Property
We believe that our continued success depends in large part on our proprietary technology, the intellectual skills of our employees and the ability of our employees to continue to innovate. We rely on a combination of patent, copyright, trademark and trade secret laws, as well as confidentiality agreements, to establish and protect our proprietary rights.
As of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, we held a number of U.S. and foreign patents. We do not consider our business to be materially dependent upon any individual patent. We will continue to file and pursue patent applications when and where appropriate to attempt to protect our rights in our proprietary technologies. We also encourage our employees to continue to invent and develop new technologies so as to maintain our competitiveness in the marketplace.
We own or have rights to use certain trademarks, service marks and trade names that we use in conjunction with the operation of our business. Certain of our trademarks have also been registered in selected foreign countries.
Government Regulation
We are subject to various government regulations, including various U.S. Government regulations as a contractor and subcontractor to the agencies of the U.S. Government. Among the most significant U.S. Government regulations affecting our business are:
the Federal Acquisition Regulations and supplemental agency regulations, which comprehensively regulate the formation, administration, and performance under government contracts;
the Truthful Cost or Pricing Data Statute (formerly the Truth in Negotiations Act,Act), which requires certification and disclosure of all cost and pricing data in connection with contract negotiations;
the Cost Accounting Standards, which impose accounting requirements that govern our right to reimbursement under cost-based government contracts;
the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, which prohibits U.S. companies from providing anything of value to a foreign official to help obtain, retain or direct business, or obtain any unfair advantages;
the False Claims Act and the False Statements Act, which, respectively, impose penalties for payments made on the basis of false facts provided to the government and impose penalties on the basis of false statements, even if they do not result in a payment; and


laws, regulations and executive orders restricting the use and dissemination of information classified for national security purposes and the exportation of certain products and technical data.
We also need special security clearances to continue working on and advancing certain of our programs and contracts with the U.S. Government. Classified programs generally will require that we comply with various Executive Orders, federal laws and regulations and customer security requirements that may include restrictions on how we develop, store, protect and share information, and may require our employees to obtain government clearances.
The nature of the work we do for the federal government may also limit the parties who may invest in or acquire us. Export laws may keep us from providing potential foreign acquirers with a review of the technical data they would be acquiring. In addition, there are special requirements for foreign parties who wish to buy or acquire control or influence over companies that control technology or produce goods in the security interests of the U.S. There may need to be a review under the Exon-Florio provisions of the Defense Production Act. Finally, the government may require a prospective foreign owner to establish intermediaries to actually run that part of the company that does classified work, and establishing a subsidiary and its separate operation may make such an acquisition less appealing to such potential acquirers.
In addition, the export from the U.S. of certain of our products may require the issuance of a license by the U.S. Department of Commerce under the Export Administration Act, as amended, and its implementing regulations as kept in force

11


by the International Emergency Economic Powers Act of 1977, as amended. Some of our products may require the issuance of a license by the U.S. Department of State under the Arms Export Control Act and its implementing regulations, which licenses are generally harder to obtain and take longer to obtain than do Export Administration Act licenses.
Our business may require compliance with state or local laws designed to limit the uses of personal user information gathered online or require online services to establish privacy policies.
Material Availability
We procure critical material, components, products and subsystems from both domestic and global supply partners. These supply sources may be single sources for certain components and the material provided may have extended lead times. To support our continuing customer needs, we have taken steps to mitigate sourcing risks. This includes working closely with our suppliers to ensure future material and subsystem availability to support our manufacturing plans. In some cases, we have elected to stock reserve material to ensure future availability.


Environmental
Our manufacturing operations are subject to many requirements under environmental laws. In the U.S., the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency and similar state agencies administer laws that restrict the emission of pollutants into the air, discharges of pollutants into bodies of water and disposal of pollutants in the ground. Violations of these laws can result in significant civil and criminal penalties and incarceration. The failure to obtain a permit for certain activities may be a violation of environmental law and subject the owner and operator to civil and criminal sanctions. Most environmental agencies also have the power to shut down an operation if it is operating in violation of environmental law. U.S. laws also allow citizens to bring private enforcement actions in some situations. Outside the U.S., the environmental laws and their enforcement vary and may be more burdensome. We have management programs and processes in place that are intended to minimize the potential for violations of these laws.
Other environmental laws, primarily in the U.S., address the contamination of land and groundwater and require the clean-up of such contamination. These laws may apply not only to the owner or operator of an on-going business, but also to the owner of land contaminated by a prior owner or operator. In addition, if a parcel is contaminated by the release of a hazardous substance, such as through its historic use as a disposal site, any person or company that has contributed to that contamination, whether or not it has a legal interest in the land, may be subject to a requirement to clean up the parcel.
Available Information
We file reports with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). We make available on our website under “Investor Relations/Financial Information/SEC Filings,” free of charge, our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such materials with or furnish them to the SEC. Our website address is www.kratosdefense.com. You may read and copy any materials we file with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains an Internet site that contains our reports, proxy and information statements, and other information at www.sec.gov.
References to our website and the SEC’s website in this report are provided as a convenience and do not constitute, and should not be viewed as, incorporation by reference of the information contained on, or available through, such websites.


Such information should not be considered a part of this report, unless otherwise expressly incorporated by reference in this report.


Item 1A.  Risk Factors.
You should carefully consider the following risk factors and all other information contained herein as well as the information included in this Annual Report and other reports and filings made with the SEC in evaluating our business and prospects. Risks and uncertainties, in addition to those we describe below, that are not presently known to us or that we currently believe are immaterial may also impair our business operations. If any of the following risks occur, our business and financial results could be harmed and the price of our common stock could decline. You should also refer to the other information contained in this Annual Report, including our Consolidated Financial Statements and the related Notes.

12


Risks Related to Our Business
The U.S. Government provides a significant portion of our revenue, and our business could be adversely affected by changes in the fiscal policies of the U.S. Government and governmental entities.
In fiscal 2017, 20162019, 2018 and 2015,2017, we generated 60%71%, 60%72% and 61%75%, respectively, of our total revenues from contracts with the U.S. Government (including all branches of the U.S. military and FMS), either as a prime contractor or a subcontractor. We expect to continue to derive most of our revenues from work performed under U.S. Government contracts. See the Industry Update section in Item 1 “Business” contained within this Annual Report for a discussion of the current budgetary and funding constraints on U.S. Government spending and legislation enacted to reduce the U.S. federal deficit. As a result, we have experienced and expect to continue to experience reduced or delayed awards on some of our programs, with a related negative impact to our revenues, earnings and cash flows. Competitor bid protests also have become more prevalent in the current competitive environment resulting from decreased government spending, which has led to further contract award delays. In addition, any future changes to the fiscal policies of the U.S. Government and foreign governmental entities may decrease overall government funding for defense and homeland security, result in delays in the procurement of our products and services due to lack of funding, cause the U.S. Government and government agencies to reduce their purchases under existing contracts, or cause them to exercise their rights to terminate contracts at-will or to abstain from exercising options to renew contracts, any of which would have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and/or cash flows.
Significant delays or reductions in appropriations for our programs and U.S. Government funding more broadly may negatively impact our business and programs and could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flows.
U.S. Government programs are subject to annual congressional budget authorization and appropriation processes. For many programs, Congress appropriates funds on a fiscal year basis even though the program performance period may extend over several years. Consequently, programs are often partially funded initially and additional funds are committed only as Congress makes further appropriations. If we incur costs in excess of funds obligated on a contract, we may be at risk for reimbursement of those costs unless and until additional funds are obligated to the contract. We cannot predict the extent to which total funding and/or funding for individual programs will be included, increased or reduced as part of the annual budget process ultimately approved by Congress and the President or in separate supplemental appropriations or continuing resolutions, as applicable. Laws and plans adopted by the U.S. Government relating to, along with pressures on and uncertainty surrounding the federal budget, potential changes in priorities and defense spending levels, sequestration, the appropriations process, use of continuing resolutions (with restrictions, e.g., on new starts) and the permissible federal debt limit, could adversely affect the funding for individual programs and delay purchasing or payment decisions by our customers. In the event government funding for our significant programs becomes unavailable, or is reduced or delayed, or planned orders are reduced, our contract or subcontract under such programs may be terminated or adjusted by the U.S. Government or the prime contractor.
The federal budget and debt ceiling are expected to continue to be the subject of considerable debate, which could have a significant impact on defense spending broadly and our programs in particular.
The budget environment, including sequestration as currentlybudget caps mandated by the BCA for fiscal years 2020 and 2021, and uncertainty surrounding the debt ceiling and the appropriations processes,process, remain significant short and long-term risks. Considerable uncertainty exists regarding how future budget and program decisions will unfold, including the defense spending priorities of the new Administration and Congress, what challenges budget reductions (required by the BCA and otherwise) will present for the defense industry and whether an annual appropriations billbills for all agencies will be enacted for FY 2018.in a timely manner. If an annual


appropriations bill isbills are not timely enacted, for FY 2018 or beyond, the U.S. Government may continue toagain operate under a continuing resolution, restricting new contract or program starts, presenting resource allocation challenges and placing limitations on some planned program budgets, and we may face aanother government shutdown of unknown duration. If a prolonged government shutdown of the DoD were to occur, it could result in program cancellations, disruptions and/or stop work orders and could limit the U.S. Government’s ability to effectively progress programs and to make timely payments, and our ability to perform on our U.S. Government contracts and successfully compete for new work.
We believe continued budget pressures would have serious negative consequences for the security of our country, the defense industrial base, including the Company, and the customers, employees, suppliers, investors, and communities that rely on companies in the defense industrial base. It is likely budget and program decisions made in this environment would have long-term implications for our Companyus and the entire defense industry.
If the debt ceiling is breached, we may be required to continue to perform for some period of time on certain of our U.S. Government contracts even if the U.S. Government is unable to make timely payments. Unforeseen circumstances could cause an extended debt ceiling breach and have significant short and long-term consequences for our Company, our employees, our suppliers and the defense industry.
Long-termAdditionally, funding for certain programs in which we participate may be reduced, delayed or cancelled. In addition,cancelled, and budget cuts globally could adversely affect the viability of our subcontractors and suppliers, and our employee base. While we believe that our business is well-positioned in areas that the DoD and other customers have indicated are areas of focus for future defense spending, the long-term impact of the BCA, other defense spending cuts, challenges in the appropriations process, the debt ceiling and the ongoing fiscal debates remain uncertain.

13


Significant delays or reductions in appropriations; long-term funding under a continuing resolution; an extended debt ceiling breach or government shutdown; and/or future budget and program decisions, among other items, may negatively impact our business and programs and could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flow.flows.
If we fail to establish and maintain important relationships with government agencies and prime contractors, our ability to successfully maintain and develop new business may be adversely affected.
Our reputation and relationship with the U.S. Government, and in particular with the agencies of the DoD and the U.S. intelligence community, are key factors in maintaining and developing new business opportunities. In addition, we often act as a subcontractor or in “teaming” arrangements in which we and other contractors bid together on particular contracts or programs for the U.S. Government or government agencies. We expect to continue to depend on relationships with other prime contractors for a portion of our revenue for the foreseeable future. Negative press reports regarding conflicts of interest, poor contract performance, employee misconduct, information security breaches or other aspects of our business, regardless of accuracy, could harm our reputation. Additionally, as a subcontractor or team member, we often lack control over fulfillment of a contract, and poor performance on the contract could tarnish our reputation, even when we perform as required. As a result, we may be unable to successfully maintain our relationships with government agencies or prime contractors, and any failure to do so could adversely affect our ability to maintain our existing business and compete successfully for new business.
Many of our contracts contain performance obligations that require innovative design capabilities, are technologically complex, require state-of-the-art manufacturing expertise, or are dependent upon factors not wholly within our control. Failure to meet these obligations could adversely affect our profitability and future prospects. Early termination of client contracts or contract penalties could adversely affect our results of operations.
We design, develop, and manufacture technologically advanced and innovative products and services, which are applied by our customers in a variety of environments. Problems and delays in development or delivery as a result of issues with respect to design, technology, licensing and intellectual property rights, labor, inability to achieve learning curve assumptions, manufacturing materials or components could prevent us from meeting requirements. Either we or the customer may generally terminate a contract as a result of a material uncured breach by the other. If we breach a contract or fail to perform in accordance with contractual service levels, delivery schedules, performance specifications, or other contractual requirements set forth therein, the other party thereto may terminate such contract for default, and we may be required to refund money previously paid to us by the customer or to pay penalties or other damages. Even if we have not breached, we may deal with various situations from time to time that may result in the amendment or termination of a contract. These steps can result in significant current period charges and/or reductions in current or future revenue.revenue, and/or delays in collection of outstanding receivables and costs incurred on the contract. Other factors that may affect revenue and profitability include inaccurate cost estimates, design issues, unforeseen costs and expenses not covered by insurance or indemnification from the customer, diversion of management focus in responding to unforeseen problems, and loss of follow-on work.


If our subcontractors or suppliers fail to perform their contractual obligations, our performance and reputation as a contractor and our ability to obtain future business could suffer.
As a prime contractor, we often rely upon other companies as subcontractors to perform work we are obligated to perform for our customers. As we secure more work under certain of our contracts, we expect to require an increasing level of support from subcontractors that provide complementary and supplementary services to our offerings. We are responsible for the work performed by our subcontractors, even though in some cases we have limited involvement in that work. If one or more of our subcontractors fails to satisfactorily perform the agreed-upon services on a timely basis or violates U.S. Government contracting policies, laws or regulations, our ability to perform our obligations as a prime contractor or meet our customers’ expectations may be compromised. In extreme cases, performance or other deficiencies on the part of our subcontractors could result in a customer terminating our contract for default. A termination for default could expose us to liability, including liability for the agency’s costs of re-procurement, could damage our reputation and could hurt our ability to compete for future contracts.
We also are required to procure certain materials and parts from supply sources approved by the U.S. Government. The inability of a supplier to meet our needs or the appearance of counterfeit parts in our products could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

14


Our earnings and profitability depend, in part, on subcontractor and supplier performance and product availability.
We rely on other companies to provide major components for our products. For instance, we build the airframe, electronics and flight control systems for our unmanned aerial systems. We primarily rely on our suppliers to provide the engines and parachutes for landing the aircraft. Disruptions or performance problems caused by our subcontractors and suppliers, or a misalignment between our contractual obligations to our customers and our agreements with our subcontractors and suppliers, could have an adverse effect on our ability to meet our commitments to customers.
Our ability to perform our obligations on time could be adversely affected if one or more of our subcontractors or suppliers were unable to provide the agreed-upon products or materials or perform the agreed-upon services in a timely, compliant and cost-effective manner or otherwise to meet the requirements of the contract. Changes in economic conditions, including changes in defense budgets or credit availability, or other changes impacting a subcontractor or supplier (including changes in ownership or operations) could adversely affect the financial stability of our subcontractors and suppliers and/or their ability to perform. The inability of our suppliers to perform, or their inability to perform adequately, could also result in the need for us to transition to alternate suppliers, which could result in significant incremental cost and delay or the need for us to provide other resources to support our existing suppliers.
In connection with our U.S. Government contracts, we are required to procure certain materials, components and parts from supply sources approved by the customer. We also are facing increased and changing regulatory requirements, many of which apply to our subcontractors and suppliers. In some cases, there may be only one supplier for certain components. If a sole source supplier cannot meet our needs or is otherwise unavailable, we may be unable to find a suitable alternative.
Our procurement practices are intended to reduce the likelihood of our procurement of counterfeit, unauthorized or otherwise non-compliant parts or materials. We rely on our subcontractors and suppliers to comply with applicable laws and regulations, including regarding the parts or materials we procure from them; in some circumstances, we rely on certifications provided by our subcontractors and suppliers regarding their compliance. We also rely on our subcontractors and suppliers to effectively mitigate the risk of cyber and security threats or other disruptions with respect to the products and components they deliver to us and the information entrusted to them by us or our customers.
If we are unable to procure, or experience significant delays in subcontractor or supplier deliveries of, needed materials, components, intellectual property or parts; if our subcontractors or suppliers do not comply with all applicable laws and regulations; if the certifications we receive from them are inaccurate; or if what we receive is counterfeit or otherwise improper, it could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flows.
We face intense competition from many competitors that have greater resources than we do, which could result in price reductions, reduced profitability or loss of market share.
We operate in highly competitive markets and generally encounter intense competition to win contracts from many other firms, including mid-tier federal contractors with specialized capabilities, large defense contractors and IT service providers. Competition in our markets may increase as a result of a number of factors, such as the entrance of new or larger competitors, including those formed through alliances or consolidation, or the reduction in the overall number of government


contracts. We may also face competition from prime contractors for whom we currently serve as subcontractors or teammates if those prime contractors choose to offer customer services of the type that we are currently providing. Recently, procurement award determinations have been based on lowest price, technically acceptable proposals. In addition, we may face competition from our subcontractors who, from time-to-time, seek to obtain prime contractor status on contracts for which they currently serve as a subcontractor to us.


Many of our competitors have greater financial, technical, marketing and public relations resources, larger customer bases and greater brand or name recognition than we do. Such competitors may be able to utilize their substantially greater resources and economies of scale to, among other things:


divert sales from us by winning very large‑scale government contracts, a risk that is enhanced by the recent trend in government procurement practices to bundle services into larger contracts and the recent trend of making award determinations on a lowest price, technically acceptableLPTA basis;
divert sales from us by the award of government contracts to our competitors who may be willing to bid at substantially lower prices;
force us to charge lower prices; or
adversely affect our relationships with current customers, including our ability to continue to win competitively awarded engagements in which we are the incumbent.

15




In the event that the market for products in our US segment expands, we expect that competition will intensify as additional competitors enter the market and current competitors expand their product lines. In order to secure contracts successfully when competing with larger, well-financed companies, we may be forced to agree to contractual terms that provide for lower aggregate payments to us over the life of the contract, which could adversely affect our margins. In addition, larger diversified competitors serving as prime contractors may be able to supply underlying products and services from affiliated entities, which would prevent us from competing for subcontracting opportunities on these contracts. If we lose business to our competitors or are forced to lower our prices, our revenue and operating profits could decline.


Our business is dependent upon our ability to keep pace with the latest technological changes.
The market for our services is characterized by rapid change and technological improvements. Failure to respond in a timely and cost-effective way to these technological developments would result in serious harm to our business and operating results. We have derived, and we expect to continue to derive, a substantial portion of our revenues from providing innovative engineering services and technical solutions that are based upon today’s leading technologies and that are capable of adapting to future technologies. As a result, our success will depend, in part, on our ability to develop and market service offerings that respond in a timely manner to the technological advances of our customers, evolving industry standards and changing customer preferences.
We believe that, in order to remain competitive in the future, we will need to continue to invest significant financial resources to develop new offerings and technologies or to adapt or modify our existing offerings and technologies, including through internal research and development, acquisitions and joint ventures or other teaming arrangements. These expenditures could divert our attention and resources from other projects, and we cannot be sure that these expenditures will ultimately lead to the timely development of new offerings and technologies or identification of and expansion into new markets. Due to the design complexity of our products, we may, in the future, experience delays in completing the development and introduction of new products. Any delays could result in increased costs of development or deflect resources from other projects. In addition, there can be no assurance that the market for our products will develop or continue to expand or that we will be successful in newly identified markets as we currently anticipate. The failure of our technology to gain market acceptance could significantly reduce our revenues and harm our business. Furthermore, we cannot be sure that our competitors will not develop competing technologies that gain market acceptance in advance of our products.


Additionally, the possibility exists that our competitors might develop new technology or offerings that might cause our existing technology and offerings to become obsolete. If we fail in our new product development efforts or our products or services fail to achieve market acceptance more rapidly as compared to our competitors, our ability to procure new contracts could be negatively impacted, which could negatively impact our results of operations and financial condition.


If the UAS and UGS markets do not experience significant growth, if we cannot expand our customer base or if our
products do not achieve broad acceptance, then we may not be able to achieve our anticipated level of growth.

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, our US segment accounted for 16.2%22.5% of our total revenue. We cannot
accurately predict the future growth rate or size of this market. Demand for our products may not increase, or may decrease,
either generally or in specific markets, for particular types of products or during particular time periods. There are only a


limited number of programs under which the U.S. military, our primary customer, is currently funding the development or purchase of our UAS and UGS products. Although we are seeking to expand our US customer base to include foreign
governments, domestic non-military agencies and commercial customers, we cannot assure that our efforts will be
successful. The expansion of the UAS and UGS markets in general, and the market for our products in particular, depends on a number of factors, including the following:


customer satisfaction with these types of systems as solutions;
the cost, performance and reliability of our products and products offered by our competitors;
customer perceptions regarding the effectiveness and value of these types of systems;
limitations on our ability to market our US products and services outside the U.S. due to U.S.
government regulations; and
marketing efforts and publicity regarding these types of systems.


Even if UAS and UGS gain wide market acceptance in general, our specific products may not adequately address market requirements or may not gain market acceptance. If these types of systems generally, or our products specifically, do not gain wide market acceptance, then we may not be able to achieve our anticipated level of growth and our revenue and results of operations may suffer.

16




Loss of our GSAGeneral Services Administration (“GSA”) contracts or GWACs could impair our ability to attract new business.
We are a prime contractor under several GSA contracts and GWAC vehicles. We believe that our ability to provide services under these contracts will continue to be important to our business because of the multiple opportunities for new engagements each contract provides. If we were to lose our position as prime contractor on one or more of these contracts, we could lose substantial revenues and our operating results could suffer. GSA contracts and other GWACs typically have a one or two-year initial term with multiple options exercisable at the government customer’s discretion to extend the contract for one or more years. We cannot be assured that our government customers will continue to exercise the options remaining on our current contracts, nor can we be assured that our future customers will exercise options on any contracts we may receive in the future.
Government contracts differ materially from standard commercial contracts, involve competitive bidding and may be subject to cancellation or delay without penalty.
Government contracts frequently include provisions that are not standard in private commercial transactions and are subject to laws and regulations that give the U.S. Government rights and remedies not typically found in commercial contracts, including provisions permitting the U.S. Government to:
terminate our existing contracts;
reduce potential future income from our existing contracts;
modify some of the terms and conditions in our existing contracts;
suspend or permanently prohibit us from doing business with the U.S. Government or with any specific government agency;
impose fines and penalties;
subject us to criminal prosecution;
suspend work under existing multiple year contracts and related task orders if the necessary funds are not appropriated by Congress;
decline to exercise an option to extend an existing multiple year contract; and
claim rights in technologies and systems invented, developed or produced by us.


In addition, government contracts are frequently awarded only after formal competitive bidding processes, which have been and may continue to be protracted and typically impose provisions that permit cancellation in the event that necessary funds are unavailable to the government agency. Competitive procurements impose substantial costs and managerial time and effort in order to prepare bids and proposals for contracts that may not be awarded to us. In many cases, unsuccessful bidders for government contracts are provided the opportunity to formally protest certain contract awards through various agencies, administrative and judicial channels. We have experienced an increase in competitor bid protests on contracts on which we were the successful bidder due to the competitive environment resulting from decreased government spending. In addition, we have formally protested procurement awards in which we were not the initial successful bidder, but believed that the source selection process was flawed. The protest process may substantially delay a successful bidder’s contract performance, result in cancellation of the contract award entirely and distract management. We may not be awarded contracts for which we bid, and substantial delays or cancellation of purchases may follow our successful bids as a result of such protests. We believe that this environment of protracted competitive bidding processes and competitor bid protests will continue.


Certain of our government contracts also contain “organizational conflict of interest” clauses that could limit our ability to compete for certain related follow-on contracts. For example, when we work on the design of a particular solution, we may be precluded from competing for the contract to install that solution. While we actively monitor our contracts to avoid these conflicts, we cannot guarantee that we will be able to avoid all organizational conflict of interest issues.
We may not receive the full amounts estimated under the contracts in our backlog, which could reduce our revenue in future periods below the levels anticipated. This makes backlog an uncertain indicator of future operating results.
Backlog is typically subject to large variations from quarter to quarter and comparisons of backlog from period to period are not necessarily indicative of future revenues. The contracts comprising our backlog may not result in actual revenue in any particular period or at all, and the actual revenue from such contracts may differ from our backlog estimates. The timing of receipt of revenues, if any, on projects included in backlog could change because many factors affect the scheduling of projects. Cancellation of or adjustments to contracts may occur. Additionally, all U.S. Government contracts included in backlog, whether or not funded, may be terminated at the convenience of the U.S. Government. The failure to realize all amounts in our backlog could adversely affect our revenues and gross margins. As a result, our funded, unfunded and total backlog as of any particular date may not be an accurate indicator of our future earnings.

17


A preference for minority-owned, small and small disadvantaged businesses could impact our ability to be a prime contractor and limit our opportunity to work as a subcontractor on certain governmental procurements.
As a result of the Small Business Administration (“SBA”) set-aside program, the federal government may decide to restrict certain procurements only to bidders that qualify as minority-owned, small, or small disadvantaged businesses. As a result, we would not be eligible to perform as a prime contractor on those programs and in general would be restricted to no more than 49% of the work as a subcontractor on those programs. An increase in the amount of procurements under the SBA set-aside program may impact our ability to bid on new procurements as a prime contractor, limit our opportunity to work as a subcontractor or restrict our ability to compete on incumbent work that is placed in the set-aside program.
U.S. Government in-sourcing could result in loss of business opportunities and personnel.
The U.S. Government has continued to reduce the percentage of contracted services in favor of more federal employees through an initiative called “in-sourcing.” Over time, in-sourcing could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. Specifically, as a result of in-sourcing, government procurements for services could be fewer and smaller in the future. In addition, work we currently perform could be in-sourced by the federal government and, as a result, our revenues could be reduced. Moreover, our employees could also be hired by the government. This loss of our employees would necessitate the need to retain and train new employees. Accordingly, the effect of in-sourcing or the continuation of in-sourcing at a faster-than-expected rate could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.
Our business could be negatively impacted by cyber and other security threats or disruptions.

As a defense contractor, we face various cyber and other security threats, including cybersecurity threats, and other disruptions.
Many of the systems we develop, install and maintain involve managing and protecting information involved in intelligence, national security and other sensitive or classified U.S. Government functions. We face various security threats, including cybersecurity threats,attempts to gain unauthorized access to thisand to harm sensitive information. Such threats can come from external as well as internal sources. We also faceinformation and networks; insider threats; threats to the safety of our directors, officers and employees; threats to the security and viability of our facilities, infrastructure and infrastructure;supply chain; and threats from terrorist acts.acts or other acts of aggression. Our customers and partners (including our supply chain and joint ventures) face similar threats and growing requirements. Although we utilize various procedures and controls to monitor these threats and mitigate our exposure to suchthe risk of these threats, there can be no assurance that these procedures and controls will be sufficient in preventing securitysufficient. These threats from materializing. If any of these events were to materialize, they could lead to the losslosses or misuse of sensitive information criticalor capabilities; theft of data; harm to personnel, infrastructure personnel or capabilities essential to our operationsproducts; and prevent us from being eligible for further work on sensitive or classified systems for U.S. Government customers. Further, any losses we incur from such a security breach could exceed the policy limits under our errors and omissions and product liability insurance. Any losses we incur, anyfinancial liabilities, as well as damage to our reputation as a government contractor and provider of cyber-related or any limitations on our eligibility for additional work resulting from a security breach could materially reduce our revenuecyber-protected goods and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.services.
Cybersecurity attacks in particular
Cyber threats are evolving and include, but are not limited to,to: malicious software, destructive malware, attempts to gain unauthorized access to data, disruption or denial of service attacks, and other electronic security breaches that could lead to disruptions in mission critical systems,systems; unauthorized release of confidential, personal or otherwise protected information and(ours or that of our employees, customers or partners); corruption of data. We have experienced cybersecurity attacksdata, networks or systems; harm to individuals; and may experience themloss of assets. In addition, we could be impacted by cyber threats or other disruptions or vulnerabilities found in the future.products we use or in our partners’ or customers’ systems that are used in connection with our business. These events, if not prevented or effectively mitigated, could damage our reputation, require remedial actions and lead to financial losses from remedial actions, loss of business, regulatory actions, potential liability and other financial losses.



We provide systems, products and services to various customers (government and commercial) who also face cyber threats. Our systems, products and services may themselves be subject to cyber threats and/or they may not be able to detect or deter threats, or effectively to mitigate resulting losses. These losses could adversely affect our customers and our Company.

The impact of these various factors is difficult to predict, but one or more of them could result in the loss of proprietary and trade secret information or capabilities, harm to individuals or property, damage to our reputation, loss of business, contractual or regulatory actions and potential liability.liabilities, any one of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flows.

If we experience systems or service failure, our reputation could be harmed and our customers could assert claims against us for damages or refunds.
We create, implement and maintain IT solutions that are often critical to our customers’ operations. We have experienced, and may in the future experience, some systems and service failures, schedule or delivery delays and other problems in connection with our work. If we experience these problems, we may:
lose revenue due to adverse customer reaction;
be required to provide additional services to a customer at no charge;
cause customers to postpone, cancel or fail to renew contracts;
receive negative publicity, which could damage our reputation and adversely affect our ability to attract or retain customers; and
suffer claims for substantial damages.


We cannot ensure that provisions in our customer contracts will be legally sufficient to protect us if we are sued.


18



In addition, our errors and omissions and product liability insurance coverage may not be adequate, may not continue to be available on reasonable terms or in sufficient amounts to cover one or more large claims, or the insurer may disclaim coverage as to some types of future claims. The successful assertion of any large claim against us could seriously harm our business. Even if not successful, these claims may result in significant legal and other costs, be a distraction to our management and harm our reputation.
Our products are complex and could have unknown defects or errors, which may increase our costs, harm our reputation with customers, give rise to costly litigation, or divert our resources from other purposes.
Our products, including but not limited to unmanned vehicles, aerial targets, UAS and ballistic missile targets, are extremely complex and must operate successfully with complex products from other vendors. Despite testing, our products have contained defects and errors and may in the future contain defects or errors, or experience performance problems when first introduced, when new versions or enhancements are released, or even after these products have been used by our customers for a period of time. These problems could result in expensive and time-consuming design modifications or warranty charges, delays in the introduction of new products or enhancements, significant increases in our service and maintenance costs, diversion of our personnel’s attention from our product development efforts, exposure to liability for damages, damaged customer relationships, and harm to our reputation, any of which could materially harm our results of operations. In addition, increased development and warranty costs could be substantial and could reduce our operating margins.


The existence of any defects, errors, or failures in our products or the misuse of our products could also lead to lawsuits against us, result in injury, death, or property damage, and significantly damage our reputation and support for our products in general.


Although we maintain insurance policies, we cannot provide assurance that this insurance will be adequate to protect us from all material judgments and expenses related to potential future claims or that these levels of insurance will be available in the future at economical prices or at all. A successful liability claim could result in substantial cost to us. Even if we are fully insured as it relates to a claim, the claim could nevertheless diminish our brand and divert management’s attention and resources, which could have a negative impact on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.


Due to the volatile and flammable nature of certain components of our products and equipment, fires or explosions may
disrupt our business or cause significant injuries, which could adversely affect our financial results.
The development and manufacture of certain of our products involves the handling of a variety of explosive and flammable materials as well as high power equipment. From time to time, these activities may result in incidents that could


cause us to temporarily shut down or otherwise disrupt some manufacturing processes, causing production delays and resulting in liability for workplace injuries and/or fatalities. We have safety and loss prevention programs that require detailed reviews of process changes and new operations, along with routine safety audits of operations involving explosive materials, to mitigate such incidents, as well as a variety of insurance policies. However, we cannot ensure that we will not experience such incidents in the future or that any such incidents will not result in production delays or otherwise have a material adverse effect on our business and financial condition. In addition, our microwave electronics business which is based in Israel may suffer disruption or damage from acts of terrorism, or other conflicts in that geographic region.


Our financial results may vary significantly from quarter to quarter.


We expect our revenue and operating results to vary from quarter to quarter. Reductions in revenue in a particular quarter could lead to lower profitability in that quarter because a relatively large amount of our expenses are fixed in the short-term. We may incur significant operating expenses during the start-up and early stages of large contracts and may not be able to recognize corresponding revenue in that same quarter. We may also incur additional expenses when contracts are terminated or expire and are not renewed.


In addition, payments due to us from our customers may be delayed due to billing cycles or as a result of failures of government budgets to gain congressional and administration approval in a timely manner. The U.S. Government’s fiscal year ends September 30. If a federal budget for the next federal fiscal year has not been approved by that date in each year, our customers may have to suspend engagements that we are working on until a budget has been approved. Any such suspensions may reduce our revenue in the fourth quarter of the federal fiscal year or the first quarter of the subsequent year. The U.S. Government’s fiscal year end can also trigger increased purchase requests from customers for equipment and materials. Any increased purchase requests we receive as a result of the U.S. Government’s fiscal year end would serve to increase our third or fourth quarter revenue, but will generally decrease profit margins for that quarter, as these activities generally are not as profitable as our typical offerings.

19


Additional factors that may cause our financial results to fluctuate from quarter to quarter include those addressed elsewhere in this Item 1A “Risk Factors” and the following factors, among others:
the terms of customer contracts that affect the timing of revenue recognition;
variability in demand for our services and solutions;
commencement, completion or termination of contracts during any particular quarter;
timing of shipments and product deliveries;
timing of award or performance incentive fee notices;    
timing of significant bid and proposal costs;
the costs of remediating unknown defects, errors or performance problems of our product offerings;
variable purchasing patterns under GSA contracts, GWACs, blanket purchase agreements and other IDIQ contracts;
restrictions on and delays related to the export of defense articles and services;
costs related to government inquiries;
strategic decisions by us or our competitors, such as acquisitions, divestitures, spin-offs and joint ventures;
strategic investments or changes in business strategy;
changes in the extent to which we use subcontractors;
seasonal fluctuations in our staff utilization rates;
changes in our effective tax rate, including changes in our judgment as to the necessity of the valuation allowance recorded against our deferred tax assets; and
the length of sales cycles.


Significant fluctuations in our operating results for a particular quarter could cause us to fall out of compliance with the financial covenants related to our debt, which if not waived, could restrict our access to capital and cause us to take extreme measures to pay down the debt, if any, under our $90.0 million Amended and Restated Credit and Security Agreement, dated November 20, 2017 (the(as amended, the “Credit Agreement”), by and among the Company, the lenders named therein, SunTrust Bank, as Agent (the “Agent”), and SunTrust Robinson Humphrey, Inc. as Lead Arranger and Sole Book Runner. In addition, fluctuations in our financial results could cause our stock price to decline. See the risks and uncertainties related to our ability to raise additional capital below in “We may need additional capital to fund the growth of our business, and financing may not be available on favorable terms or at all.”



Our margins and operating results may suffer if we experience unfavorable changes in the proportion of cost-plus-fee or fixed‑price contracts in our total contract mix.


Although fixed-price contracts entail a greater risk of a reduced profit or financial loss on a contract compared to other types of contracts we enter into, fixed-price contracts typically provide higher profit opportunities because we may be able to benefit from cost savings and operating efficiencies. In contrast, cost-plus-fee contracts are subject to statutory limits on profit margins and generally are the least profitable of our contract types. Our U.S. Government customers typically determine what type of contract we enter into. Cost-plus-fee and fixed-price contracts in our federal business accounted for approximately 13%17% and 82%79%, respectively, of our federal business revenues for the year ended December 31, 2017.29, 2019. To the extent that we enter into more cost-plus-fee or less fixed-price contracts in proportion to our total contract mix in the future, our margins and operating results may suffer. Our operating results may also suffer to the extent we have a contract mix that is focused on developmental projects, which are typically at lower profit margins as compared to margins on production projects.


Our cash flow and profitability could be reduced if expenditures are incurred prior to the final receipt of a contract.
We provide various professional services, specialized products, and sometimes procure equipment and materials on behalf of our customers under various contractual arrangements. From time to time, in order to ensure that we satisfy our customers’ delivery requirements and schedules, we may elect to initiate procurement in advance of receiving final authorization from the government customer or a prime contractor. In addition, from time to time, we may build production units such as unmanned aerial vehicles in advance of receiving an anticipated contract award. If our government or prime contractor customer’s requirements should change or if the government or the prime contractor should direct the anticipated procurement to another contractor, or if the anticipated contract award does not materialize, or if the equipment or materials become obsolete or require modification before we are under contract for the procurement, our investment in the equipment or materials might be at risk if we cannot efficiently resell them. This could reduce anticipated earnings or result in a loss, negatively affecting our cash flow and profitability.
We have incurred and may continue to incur goodwill impairment charges in our reporting entities, which could harm our profitability.
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, goodwill represented approximately 45%38% of our total assets. We periodically review the carrying values of our goodwill to determine whether such carrying values exceed the fair value.test for impairment annually. If impairment testing indicates

20


that the carrying value of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the goodwill of the reporting unit is deemed impaired. Accordingly, an impairment charge would be recognized for that reporting unit in the period identified.
TheWe test goodwill for impairment by performing a qualitative assessment or using a two-step impairment process. If we choose to perform a qualitative assessment and determine it is more likely than not that an impairment may exist, the two-step impairment process is then performed. For operations where the two-step process is used, the identification and measurement of impairment involves the estimation of the fair value of reporting units. If the fair value is determined to be less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to determine the amount of the impairment. Accounting for impairment contains uncertainty because management must use judgmentmake judgments in determining appropriate assumptions to be used in the measurement of fair value. The estimates of fair value of reporting units are based on the best information available as of the date of the assessment, incorporate management assumptions about expected future cash flows and contemplate other valuation techniques. Future cash flows can be affected by changes in industry or market conditions, among other things.


Given the current market conditions and continued economic uncertainty in the U.S. defense industry, including sequestration and issues surrounding the national debt ceiling, our future revenues, profits and cash flows could be substantially lower than our current projections. Current market conditions including increased price competitiveness specifically in the government services space, includingand procurements awarded on an LPTA rather than best value basis, can significantly impact our current projections, which specifically resulted in an impairment of the carrying value in 2017 of our goodwill balance in our Defense Rocket Support ServicesDRSS reporting unit within our Kratos Government SolutionsKGS reportable segment. In addition, our ability to penetrate new international markets could also impact our current projections. Additional market factors could impact our projections and our ability to successfully develop new products and platforms. For example, our US reporting unit forecasts include the successful completion of certain performance criteria on new unmanned systems platforms, and acceptance of new unmanned systems platforms on a technical basis as well as from a political and government budgetary standpoint. In addition, market-based inputs to the calculations in the impairment test, such as weighted average cost of capital, and market multiples, could also be negatively impacted. Such circumstances may result in the future deterioration of the fair value of our reporting units and an impairment of our goodwill. Due to continual changes in market and general business conditions, we cannot predict whether, and to what extent, our goodwill and long-lived intangible assets may be impaired in future periods. Any resulting impairment loss could harm our profitability and financial condition.



Failure to properly manage projects may result in additional costs or claims.
Our engagements often involve large scale, highly complex projects. The quality of our performance on such projects depends in large part upon our ability to manage the relationship with our customers and to effectively manage the project and deploy appropriate resources, including third-party contractors and our own personnel, in a timely manner. Any defects or errors or failure to meet customers’ expectations could result in claims for substantial damages against us. Our contracts generally limit our liability for damages that arise from negligent acts, errors, mistakes or omissions in rendering services to our customers. However, we cannot be sure that these contractual provisions will protect us from liability for damages in the event we are sued. In addition, in certain instances, we guarantee customers that we will complete a project by a scheduled date. If the project experiences a performance problem, we may not be able to recover the additional costs we will incur, which could exceed revenues realized from a project. Finally, if we underestimate the resources or time we need to complete a project with capped or fixed fees, our operating results could be adversely affected.
We use estimates when accounting for contracts, and any changes in such estimates could have an adverse effect on our profitability and our overall financial performance.
When agreeing to contractual terms, our management makes assumptions and projections about future conditions and events, many of which extend over long periods. These projections assess the productivity and availability of labor, complexity of the work to be performed, cost and availability of materials, impact of delayed performance and timing of product deliveries. Contract accounting requires judgment relative to assessing risks, estimating contract revenues and costs, and making assumptions for schedule and technical issues. Due to the size and nature of many of our contracts, the estimation of total revenues and costs at completion is complicated and subject to many variables. For example, assumptions are made regarding the length of time to complete a contract since costs also include expected increases in wages, prices for materials and allocated fixed costs. Similarly, assumptions are made regarding the future impact of our efficiency initiatives and cost reduction efforts. Incentives, awards or penalties related to performance on contracts are considered in estimating revenue and profit rates and are recorded when there is sufficient information to assess anticipated performance. Suppliers’ assertions are also assessed and considered in estimating costs and profit rates.
Because of the significance of the judgment and estimation processes described above, it is possible that materially different amounts could be obtained if different assumptions were used or if the underlying circumstances were to change. Changes in underlying assumptions, circumstances or estimates may have a material adverse effect upon the profitability of one or more of the affected contracts, future period financial reporting and performance.

21


Our ability to utilize our net operating loss carryforwards and certain other tax attributes may be limited.
Federal and state income tax laws impose restrictions on the utilization of net operating loss (“NOL”) and tax credit carryforwards in the event that an “ownership change” occurs for tax purposes, as defined by Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended. We believe we underwent an ownership change in March 2010 that limited the Company’s federal annual utilization of NOL carryforwards. If the entire limitation amount is not utilized in a year, the excess can be carried forward and utilized in future years. For the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, there was no impact of such limitations on the income tax provision since the amount of taxable income did not exceed the cumulative annual limitation amount. In addition, future equity offerings or acquisitions that have equity as a component of the purchase price could also cause an “ownership change.”If and when any other “ownership change” occurs, utilization of the NOL or other tax attributes may be further limited.
We expect to incur substantial research and development costs and devote significant resources to identifying and developing new products and services, which could significantly reduce our profitability and may never result in revenue to us.
Our future growth depends on penetrating new markets, adapting existing products to new applications, and introducing new products and services that achieve market acceptance. We plan to incur substantial research and development costs as part of our efforts to design, develop and commercialize new products and services and enhance existing products. We spent $17.8$18.0 million, or 2.4%2.5% of our revenue, in our fiscal year ended December 31, 201729, 2019 on internally funded research and development activities. We believe that there are significant investment opportunities in a number of business areas. Because we account for research and development as an operating expense, these expenditures will adversely affect our earnings in the future. Further, our research and development programs may not produce successful results, and our new products and services may not achieve market acceptance, create additional revenue or become profitable, which could materially harm our business, prospects, financial results and liquidity.


Risks Related to Our Operations


We may need additional capital to fund the growth of our business, and financing may not be available on favorable terms or at all.


We currently anticipate that our available capital resources, including the cash we raised in our recent equity offerings, the net proceeds from the divestiture of our PSS business, amounts available under our Credit Agreement and operating cash flow will be sufficient to meet our expected working capital and capital expenditure requirements for at least the next 12 months. However, these resources may not be sufficient to fund the long-term growth of our business, especially in the event that we are awarded future multiple sizable production awards related to our tactical drone programs which require significant amounts of working capital to fund such growth. If we determine that it is necessary to raise additional funds, either through an expansion or refinancing of our Credit Agreement or through public or private debt offerings or additional equity financings, additional financing may not be available on terms favorable to us, or at all. Disruptions in the capital and credit markets may continue indefinitely or intensify, which could adversely affect our ability to access these markets. Limitations on our borrowing base contained in our Credit Agreement may limit our access to capital, and we could fall out of compliance with financial and other covenants contained in our Credit Agreement which, if not waived, would restrict our access to capital and could require us to pay down any then-existing debt under the Credit Agreement. Our lenders may not agree to extend additional or continuing credit under our Credit Agreement or waive restrictions on our access to capital. If adequate funds are not available or are not available on acceptable terms, we may not be able to take advantage of available opportunities, develop new products or otherwise respond to competitive pressures and our business, operating results or financial condition could be materially adversely affected.


Past acquisitions and future acquisitions could prove difficult to integrate, disrupt our business, dilute stockholder value and strain our resources.


We have in the past and may, in the future, acquire additional businesses that we believe could complement or expand our business or increase our customer base. For example, in 2019 we completed the acquisition of FTT, a leading turbomachinery design and manufacturing company. Whether we realize the anticipated benefits from these acquisitions and related activities depends, in part, upon our ability to integrate the operations of the acquired business, the performance of the underlying product and service portfolio, and the performance of the management team and other personnel of the acquired operations. Integrating the operations of acquired businesses successfully or otherwise realizing any of the anticipated benefits of acquisitions, including anticipated cost savings and additional revenue opportunities, involves a number of potential challenges. The failure to meet these integration challenges could seriously harm our financial condition and results of operations. Realizing the benefits of acquisitions depends in part on the integration of operations and personnel. These integration activities are complex and time-consuming, and we may encounter unexpected difficulties or incur unexpected costs, including:


our inability to achieve the operating synergies anticipated in the acquisitions;

22


diversion of management attention from ongoing business concerns to integration matters;
difficulties in consolidating and rationalizing IT platforms and administrative infrastructures;
complexities associated with managing the geographic separation of the combined businesses and consolidating multiple physical locations where management may determine consolidation is desirable;
difficulties in integrating personnel from different corporate cultures while maintaining focus on providing consistent, high quality customer service;
difficulties or delays in transitioning U.S. Government contracts pursuant to federal acquisition regulations;
challenges in demonstrating to customers of Kratos and to customers of acquired businesses that the acquisition will not result in adverse changes in customer service standards or business focus;
possible cash flow interruption or loss of revenue as a result of change of ownership transitional matters; and
inability to generate sufficient revenue to offset acquisition costs.


Acquired businesses may have liabilities or adverse operating issues that we fail to discover through due diligence prior to the acquisition.acquisition, including cyber and other security vulnerabilities. In particular, to the extent that prior owners of any acquired businesses or properties failed to comply with or otherwise violated applicable laws or regulations, or failed to fulfill their contractual obligations to the U.S. Government or other customers, we, as the successor owner, may be financially responsible for these violations and failures and may suffer reputational harm or otherwise be adversely affected. Acquisitions also frequently result in the recording of goodwill and other intangible assets that are subject to potential impairment in the future that could harm our financial results. In addition, if we finance acquisitions by issuing debt or equity securities, our existing stockholders may be diluted, which could affect the market price of our stock. Acquisitions and/or the related equity financings could also impact our ability to utilize our NOL carryforwards. As a result, if we fail to properly evaluate acquisitions or investments, we may not achieve the anticipated benefits of any such acquisitions, and we may incur costs in


excess of what we anticipate. Acquisitions frequently involve benefits related to integration of operations. The failure to successfully integrate the operations or to otherwise realize any of the anticipated benefits of the acquisition could seriously harm our financial condition and results of operations. While we believe that we have established appropriate and adequate procedures and processes to mitigate these risks, there is no assurance that these transactions will be successful.
We also evaluate from time to time the potential disposition of assets or business that may no longer meet our growth, return and/or strategic objectives. Divestitures have inherent risks, including the possibility that any anticipated sale will be delayed or will not occur, the potential failure to realize the perceived strategic or financial merits of the divestment, difficulties in the separation of operations, services, information technology, products and personnel, unexpected costs associated with such separation, diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns and potential post-closing claims for alleged breaches of related agreements, indemnification or other disputes. A failure to successfully complete a disposition or to otherwise realize any of the anticipated benefits of a disposition could seriously harm our financial condition and results of operations.
If we are unable to manage our growth, our business and financial results could suffer.
Sustaining our growth has placed significant demands on our management, as well as on our administrative, operational and financial resources. For us to continue to manage our growth, we must continue to improve our operational, financial and management information systems and expand, motivate and manage our workforce. Additionally, our future financial results depend in part on our ability to profitably manage our growth on a combined basis with the businesses we have acquired and those we may acquire in the future. If we are unable to manage our growth while maintaining our quality of service and profit margins, or if new systems that we implement to assist in managing our growth do not produce the expected benefits, our business, prospects, financial condition or operating results could be adversely affected.
The loss of any member of our senior management could impair our relationships with U.S. Government customers and disrupt the management of our business.
We believe that the success of our business and our ability to operate profitably depends on the continued contributions of the members of our senior management. We rely on our senior management to generate business and execute programs successfully. In addition, the relationships and reputation that many members of our senior management team have established and maintain with U.S. Government personnel contribute to our ability to maintain strong customer relationships and to identify new business opportunities. The loss of any member of our senior management could impair our ability to identify and secure new contracts, to maintain good customer relations and to otherwise manage our business.
If we fail to attract and retain skilled employees or employees with the necessary national security clearances, we might not be able to perform under our contracts or win new business.
The growth of our business and revenue depends in large part upon our ability to attract and retain sufficient numbers of highly qualified individuals who have advanced technical and/or engineering skills. These employees are in great demand

23


and are likely to remain a limited resource in the foreseeable future. In addition, certain U.S. Government contracts require us, and some of our employees, to maintain national security clearances. Obtaining and maintaining national security clearances for employees involves a lengthy process, and it is difficult to identify, recruit and retain employees who already hold national security clearances. Further, some of our contracts contain provisions requiring us to staff an engagement with personnel that the customer considers key to our successful performance under the contract. In the event we are unable to provide these key personnel or acceptable substitutions, the customer may terminate the contract. As a result, if we are unable to recruit and retain a sufficient number of qualified employees, we may lose revenue and our ability to maintain and grow our business could be limited.
Moreover, in a tight labor market our direct labor costs could increase or we may be required to engage large numbers of subcontractor personnel, which could cause our profit margins to suffer. Conversely, if we maintain or increase our staffing levels in anticipation of one or more projects and the projects are delayed, reduced or terminated, we may underutilize the additional personnel, which would increase our general and administrative expenses, reduce our earnings and possibly harm our results of operations.
We are subject to the requirements of the National Industrial Security Program Operating Manual for our facility security clearance, which is a prerequisite to our ability to perform on classified contracts for the U.S. Government.
A facility security clearance is required for a company to perform on classified contracts for the DoD and certain other agencies of the U.S. Government. Security clearances are subject to regulations and requirements including the National


Industrial Security Program Operating Manual (“NISPOM”), which specifies the requirements for the protection of classified information released or disclosed in connection with classified U.S. Government contracts.
We require certain facility and personnel security clearances to perform our classified U.S. Government related business. As such, we must comply with the requirements of the NISPOM and any other applicable U.S. Government industrial security regulations. If we were to violate the terms and requirements of the NISPOM or any other applicable U.S. Government industrial security regulations (which apply to us under the terms of classified contracts), any of our cleared facilities could lose its facility security clearance. We cannot be certain that we will be able to maintain our facility security clearances. If for some reason one or more of our facility security clearances is invalidated or terminated, we would not be able to continue to perform on classified contracts at that facility and would not be able to enter into new classified contracts, which could adversely affect our revenues. Failure to comply with the NISPOM or other security requirements may subject us to civil or criminal penalties, loss of access to classified information, loss of a U.S. Government contract, or potentially debarment as a government contractor.
We will be subject to the new DoD Cybersecurity Maturity Model Certification (“CMMC”) requirement recently issued by the Pentagon which may limit our ability to bid and win projects. The cost for the new CMMC requirement may be significant.
The Pentagon, on January 31, 2020, released the official version of its unified Cybersecurity standard that all contractors must meet by 2026. This standard, the CMMC, will apply to any company that does business with the Department of Defense. CMMC will also apply to subcontractors as well as prime contractors. The DoD has stated that it expects a roll-out of this requirement over a five-year timeline. CMMC borrows heavily from the existing NIST Cybersecurity Framework, and intends to rely heavily on a CMMC accrediting body. The DoD is currently drafting a memorandum of understanding to establish rules, roles and responsibilities between it and the accrediting body. Once up and running, companies will be able to apply for certification through a portal run by the accrediting body. The CMMC certification will be good for three years; with it, companies will be able to bid on contracts across the DoD and military services. There will be five levels of certification, Level 1 through Level 5. The new certification will not be required for existing contracts already signed, only on new contracts. The first “pathfinder” solicitations mandating CMMC are expected to come out in the fall of 2020. It is expected to take until 2026 to bring all contractors into compliance, since five years is the typical duration of a government contract.
Under CMMC, contractors will no longer “self-attest” they meet a given standard. Instead, Pentagon approved third parties will assess each company, at the company’s expense. There will be no fines for non-compliance, however contractors will not be able to be awarded new contracts that require a particular level of certification.
We may be unable to bid on new contract awards or on follow-on awards for existing work, depending on the level of standard as required for each solicitation, which could adversely impact our revenues, operating margins and cash flows. The cost to comply with the new CMMC requirement may be significant.
We may be unable to realize any benefit from our cost reduction and restructuring efforts and our profitability may be hurt or our business otherwise might be adversely affected.affected.
We have engaged in cost reduction and restructuring activities in the past, including the recent restructuring actions in our modular systems business and our divestiture of the Modular Systems and Public Safety businesses,& Security business, and we may engage in other cost reduction restructuring activities in the future. These types of cost reduction and restructuring activities are complex. If we do not successfully manage our current cost reduction and restructuring activities, or any other cost reduction and restructuring activities that we may take in the future, any expected efficiencies and benefits might be delayed or not realized, and our operations and business could be disrupted. In addition, the costs associated with implementing cost reduction and restructuring activities might exceed expectations, which could result in additional future charges.
Our operations expose us to the risk of material environmental liabilities.
We are subject to various U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. laws and regulations related to environmental protection, including the discharge, treatment, storage, disposal and remediation of hazardous substances and wastes. We could incur substantial costs, including cleanup costs, fines and civil or criminal sanctions, as well as third-party claims for property damage or personal injury, if we were to violate or become liable under environmental laws or regulations. In some cases, we may be subject to such costs due to environmental impacts attributable to our current or past manufacturing operations or the operations of companies we have acquired. In other cases, we may become subject to such costs due to an indemnification agreement between us and a third party relating to such environmental liabilities. In addition, new laws and regulations, more


stringent enforcement of existing laws and regulations, the discovery of previously unknown contamination or the imposition of new remediation requirements could result in additional costs.

Risks Related to Our International Operations
Revenues derived from our international business could be subject to global economic downturn and hardship.


Our international business represents 11%18% of our total revenue for the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, which may be impacted by changes in foreign national priorities and government budgets and may be further impacted by global economic conditions and fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates. Continued international economic uncertainty and reductions in consumer spending may result in reductions in our revenue. In particular, recent events have caused increased attention on U.S. defense sales to the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia (“KSA”). Although we currently do not expect to be prevented from doing business in KSA, which represents nearly 8% of our sales (which are through FMS), if government action impairs our ability to fulfill our contractual obligations or otherwise to continue to do business in KSA, it could have an adverse effect on our financial results.
Additionally, disruptions in international credit markets may materially limit consumer credit availability and restrict credit availability of our customers. Any reduction in international sales of our solutions resulting from reductions in consumer spending or continued disruption in the availability of credit to retailers or consumers, could materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.

24


Our international business exposes us to additional risks.
Our operations outside of the U.S. are subject to risks that are inherent in conducting business under non-U.S. laws, regulations and customs, including those related to:


foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations, potentially reducing the U.S. dollars we receive for sales denominated in foreign currency;
the possibility that unfriendly nations or groups could boycott our solutions;
political conditions in the markets in which we operate;
potential increased costs associated with overlapping tax structures;
import-export control;
the ability to obtain required U.S. government agency issued export licenses to ship our product overseas;
more limited protection for intellectual property rights in some countries;
difficulties and costs associated with staffing and managing foreign operations;
unexpected changes in regulatory requirements;
the difficulties of compliance with a wide variety of foreign laws and regulations;
longer accounts receivable cycles in certain foreign countries, whether due to cultural differences, exchange rate fluctuation or other factors;
technology transfer restrictions;
changes to our distribution networks;
our employees; and
war and terrorist events, including impacts to our employees.international operations such as Microwave Electronics, which is headquartered in Israel.


These risks, individually or in the aggregate, could have an adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition. For example, we are subject to compliance with the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and similar anti-bribery laws, which generally prohibit companies and their intermediaries from making improper payments to foreign government officials for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. While our employees and agents are required to comply with these laws, we cannot be sure that our internal policies and procedures will always protect us from violations of these laws, despite our commitment to legal compliance and corporate ethics. The occurrence or allegation of these types of risks may adversely affect our business, performance, prospects, value, financial condition, and results of operations. In addition, our international contracts may include industrial cooperation agreements requiring specific in-country purchases, investments, manufacturing agreements or other financial obligations, known as offset obligations, and provide for penalties if we fail to meet such requirements. In addition, due to the nature of our products, we must obtain licenses and authorizations from various U.S. government agencies before selling our products outside of the U.S. Our ability to obtain these licenses and authorizations timely or at all is subject to risks and uncertainties, including changing U.S. government policies or laws or delays in Congressional action due to geopolitical and other factors. The impact of these factors is difficult to predict, but one or more of


them could adversely affect our financial position, results of operations, or cash flows.


Violations of the International Traffic in Arms Regulations (“ITAR”) or other applicable trade compliance regulations could result in significant sanctions including fines, more onerous compliance requirements and debarments from export privileges or loss of authorizations needed to conduct aspects of our international business. A violation of ITAR or other applicable trade regulations could have a materially adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
Risks Related to Our Outstanding IndebtednessLong-term Borrowings
We have substantial indebtedness,long-term borrowings, which could adversely affect our cash flow, financial condition and business.
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, we had approximately $294.3$295.1 million of total indebtednesslong-term borrowings outstanding, which includes $6.5is net of $4.9 million of unamortized debt issuance costs. As a result of this indebtedness, our interest payment obligations are significant. The degree to which we are leveraged could have adverse effects on our business, including the following:
it may limit our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industries in which we operate;
it may require us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to payments on our indebtedness, thereby reducing the availability of our cash flow to fund working capital, capital expenditures and other general corporate purposes;
it may restrict us from making strategic acquisitions or exploiting business opportunities;
it may place us at a competitive disadvantage compared to our competitors that have less debt;
it may limit our ability to borrow additional funds;
it may prevent us from raising the funds necessary to repurchase our outstanding 6.5% Notes (as defined below) tendered to us if there is a change of control, which would constitute a default under the Indenture (as defined below) governing our 6.5% Notes and under our Credit Agreement; and

25


it may decrease our ability to compete effectively or operate successfully under adverse economic and industry conditions.


Our high level of indebtednesslong-term borrowings increases the risk that we may default on our debt obligations. We may be unable to generate sufficient cash flow to pay the interest on our debt. If we are unable to service our indebtedness, we will be forced to adopt an alternative strategy that may include actions such as reducing capital expenditures, reducing internal investments in research and development efforts, selling assets, restructuring or refinancing our indebtedness or seeking additional equity capital. These alternative strategies may not be affected on satisfactory terms, if at all, and they may not yield sufficient funds to make required payments on our indebtedness.
If, for any reason, we are unable to meet our debt service and repayment obligations, we would be in default under the terms of the agreements governing our debt, which would allow our creditors at that time to declare certain outstanding indebtedness to be due and payable, which would in turn trigger cross‑acceleration or cross‑default rights between the relevant agreements. In addition, the holders of our 6.5% Notes could foreclose against the assets securing the 6.5% Notes and we could be forced into bankruptcy or liquidation and/or our lenders could compel us to apply all of our available cash to repay our borrowings or they could prevent us from making payments on our indebtedness. If the amounts outstanding under any of our indebtedness were to be accelerated, our assets may not be sufficient to repay in full the money owed to the lenders or to our other debt holders.
We and our subsidiaries may incur more debt, which may increase the risks associated with our substantial leverage, including our ability to service our indebtedness.
The agreements governing our debt permit us, under some circumstances, to incur certain additional indebtedness or obligations. To the extent that we incur additional indebtedness or such other obligations, the risks associated with our substantial leverage described above, including our possible inability to service our debt, would increase.
Changes in our credit ratings or macroeconomic conditions may affect our liquidity, increasing borrowing costs and limiting our financing options.
Macroeconomic conditions, such as increased volatility or disruption in the credit markets, could adversely affect our ability to refinance existing debt or obtain additional financing at terms satisfactory to us, thereby affecting our resources to support operations or to fund new initiatives. In addition, if our credit ratings are lowered, borrowing costs for future long-term


debt or short-term credit facilities may increase and our financing options, including our access to the unsecured credit market, could be limited. We may also be subject to restrictive covenants that would reduce our flexibility.


A portion of our business is conducted through foreign subsidiaries, and the failure to generate sufficient cash flow from these subsidiaries, or otherwise repatriate or receive cash from these subsidiaries, could result in our inability to repay our indebtedness.
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, approximately 11% of our consolidated assets, based on book value, and 10%16% of our consolidated revenues for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019, were held by foreign subsidiaries, which do not guarantee the 6.5% Notes. Our ability to meet our debt service obligations with cash from foreign subsidiaries will depend upon the results of operations of these subsidiaries and may be subject to legal, contractual or other restrictions and other business considerations. In addition, dividend and interest payments to us from the foreign subsidiaries may be subject to foreign withholding taxes, which would reduce the amount of funds we receive from such foreign subsidiaries. Therefore, to the extent that we must use cash generated in foreign jurisdictions to make principal or interest payments on our debt, there may be a cost associated with repatriating the cash to the U.S. Dividends and other distributions from our foreign subsidiaries may also be subject to fluctuations in currency exchange rates and legal and other restrictions on repatriation, which could further reduce the amount of funds we receive from such foreign subsidiaries.
The agreements governing our debt impose significant operating and financial restrictions on us and our subsidiaries that may prevent us and our subsidiaries from pursuing certain business opportunities and restrict our ability to operate our business.
The Indenture and the Credit Agreement subject us, and our subsidiaries, to several financial and other restrictive covenants, including limitations on liens or indebtedness, payment of dividends, transactions with affiliates, and mergers, sales or other dispositions of our assets.

26


Our Credit Agreement also requires us to comply with specified financial ratios, including a borrowing base availability and minimum fixed charge coverage ratio which is required to be maintained if borrowing levels, as defined, under the Credit Agreement, occur under the line of credit. Many factors, including events beyond our control, may affect our ability to comply with these covenants and financial ratios. We cannot be sure we will meet our debt-related obligations or that lenders will waive any failure to meet those obligations. Any failure to meet those debt-related obligations could result in an event of default under our other indebtedness and the acceleration of such indebtedness.


The restrictions contained in the Indenture and in our Credit Agreement could also limit theour ability of the Company and its subsidiaries to plan for or react to market conditions, meet capital needs or otherwise restrict theirour activities or business plans and adversely affect theour ability to finance their operations, enter into acquisitions or to engage in other business activities that would be in theirthe Company’s interest.
Changes in the method for determining LIBOR and the potential replacement of LIBOR may affect interest rates on our credit facilities and interest rate swaps.
LIBOR, the London interbank offered rate, is the basic rate of interest used in lending between banks on the London interbank market and is widely used as a reference for setting the interest rate on loans globally. Interest rates under our Credit Agreement are based partly on the LIBOR. On July 27, 2017, the United Kingdom’s Financial Conduct Authority, which regulates LIBOR, announced that it intends to phase out LIBOR by the end of 2021. It is unclear if at that time LIBOR will cease to exist or if new methods of calculating LIBOR will be established such that it continues to exist after 2021. If the method for calculation of LIBOR changes, if LIBOR is no longer available or if lenders have increased costs due to changes in LIBOR, we may suffer from potential increases in interest rates on our borrowings under the Credit Agreement. Further, we may need to renegotiate our credit facilities or any other borrowings that utilize LIBOR as a factor in determining the interest rate to replace LIBOR with the new standard that is established.

Risks Related to Our Intellectual Property


We may be unable to protect our intellectual property rights.
We rely on a combination of patents, trademarks, copyrights, trade secrets and nondisclosure agreements to protect our proprietary intellectual property. Our efforts to protect our intellectual property and proprietary rights may not be sufficient. We cannot be sure that our pending patent applications will result in the issuance of patents to us, that patents issued to or licensed by us in the past or in the future will not be challenged or circumvented by competitors or that these patents will remain valid or sufficiently broad to preclude our competitors from introducing technologies similar to those covered by our patents and patent


applications. In addition, our ability to enforce and protect our intellectual property rights may be limited in certain countries outside the U.S., which could make it easier for competitors to capture market position in such countries by utilizing technologies that are similar to those developed or licensed by us. Competitors also may harm our sales by designing products that mirror the capabilities of our products or technology without infringing on our intellectual property rights. If we do not obtain sufficient protection for our intellectual property, or if we are unable to effectively enforce our intellectual property rights, our competitiveness could be impaired, which would limit our growth and future revenue.
We may be harmed by intellectual property infringement claims.
We may become subject to claims from our employees or third parties who assert that software and other forms of intellectual property that we use in delivering services and solutions to our customers infringe upon intellectual property rights of such employees or third parties. Our employees develop some of the software and other forms of intellectual property that we use to provide our services and solutions to our customers, but we also license technology from other vendors. If our employees, vendors, or other third parties assert claims that we or our customers are infringing on their intellectual property rights, we could incur substantial costs to defend those claims. If any such infringement claims were ultimately successful, we could be required to cease selling or using products or services that incorporate the challenged software or technology, obtain a license or additional licenses from our employees, vendors, or other third parties, or redesign our products and services that rely on the challenged software or technology.
Disclosure of trade secrets could cause harm to our business.
We attempt to protect our trade secrets by entering into confidentiality and intellectual property assignment agreements with third parties, our employees and consultants. However, these agreements can be breached and, if they are, there may not be an adequate remedy available to us. In addition, others may independently discover our trade secrets and proprietary information, and in such cases we could not assert any trade secret rights against such party. Enforcing a claim that a party illegally obtained and is using our trade secret is difficult, expensive and time consuming, and the outcome is unpredictable. If we are unable to protect our intellectual property, our competitors could market services or products similar to our services and products, which could reduce demand for our offerings. Any litigation to enforce our intellectual property rights, protect our trade secrets or determine the validity and scope of the proprietary rights of others could result in substantial costs and diversion of resources, with no assurance of success.
Risks Related to Regulatory, Environmental and Legal Issues
Our failure to comply with complex procurement laws and regulations could cause us to lose business and subject us to a variety of penalties.
We must comply with laws and regulations relating to the formation, administration and performance of U.S. Government contracts, which affect how we do business with our customers, prime contractors, subcontractors and vendors and

27


may impose added costs on us. New regulations or procurement requirements (including, for example regulations regarding counterfeit and corrupt parts, supply chain diligence and cyber security) or changes to current requirements could increase our costs and risk of non-compliance. Our role as a contractor to agencies and departments of the U.S. Government results in our being routinely subject to investigations and reviews relating to compliance with various laws and regulations, including those associated with organizational conflicts of interest, procurement integrity, bid integrity and claim presentation, among others. These investigations may be conducted without our knowledge. Adverse findings in these investigations or reviews can lead to criminal, civil or administrative proceedings, and we could face civil and criminal penalties and administrative sanctions, including termination of contracts, forfeiture of profits, suspension of payments, fines and suspension or debarment from doing business with U.S. Government agencies. In addition, we could suffer serious harm to our reputation and competitive position if allegations of impropriety were made against us, whether or not true. If our reputation or relationship with U.S. Government agencies were impaired, or if the U.S. Government otherwise ceased doing business with us or significantly decreased the amount of business it does with us, our revenue and operating profit would decline.
Our contracts and administrative processes and systems are subject to audits and cost adjustments by the U.S. Government, which could reduce our revenue, disrupt our business or otherwise adversely affect our results of operations.
U.S. Government agencies, including the Defense Contract Audit Agency (“DCAA”), routinely audit and investigate government contracts and government contractors’ administrative processes and systems. These agencies review our performance on contracts, pricing practices, cost structure and compliance with applicable laws, regulations and standards. They also review the adequacy of our compliance with government standards for our accounting and management of internal control systems, including our: control environment and overall accounting system,system; general IT system,system; budget and planning system,


system; purchasing system,system; material management and accounting system,system; compensation system,system; labor system,system; indirect and other direct costs system, andsystem; billing systemsystem; and estimating system used for pricing on government contracts. Both contractors and the U.S. Government agencies conducting these audits and reviews have come under increased scrutiny. The current audits and reviews have become more rigorous, and the standards to which contractors are being held are being more strictly interpreted, increasing the likelihood of an audit or review resulting in an adverse outcome. During the course of its current audits, the DCAA is closely examining and questioning several of our established and disclosed practices that it had previously audited and accepted, increasing the uncertainty as to the ultimate conclusion that will be reached.
A finding of significant control deficiencies in our system audits or other reviews can result in decremented billing rates to our U.S. Government customers until the control deficiencies are corrected and our corrections are accepted by Defense Contract Management Agency (“DCMA”). Government audits and reviews may conclude that our practices are not consistent with applicable laws and regulations and result in adjustments to contract costs and mandatory customer refunds. Such adjustments can be applied retroactively, which could result in significant customer refunds. Our receipt of adverse audit findings or the failure to obtain an “approved” determination of our various accounting and management internal control systems, including our changes to indirect cost and direct labor estimating systems, from the responsible U.S. Government agency could significantly and adversely affect our business, including our ability to bid on new contracts and our competitive position in the bidding process. A determination of non-compliance with applicable contracting and procurement laws, regulations and standards could also result in the U.S. Government imposing penalties and sanctions against us, including withholding of payments, suspension of payments and increased government scrutiny that could delay or adversely affect our ability to invoice and receive timely payment on contracts, perform contracts or compete for contracts with the U.S. Government.


We have submitted incurred cost claims through 2015.fiscal year 2018. The actual indirect cost audits by the DCAA have been completed for our subsidiaries forthrough fiscal 2010.year 2017. Although we have recorded contract revenues subsequent to fiscal 2010year 2017 based upon costs that we believe will be approved upon final audit or review, we do not know the outcome of any ongoing or future audits or reviews and, if future adjustments exceed our estimates, our profitability would be adversely affected.


Our employees or others acting on our behalf may engage in misconduct or other improper activities, which could cause us to lose contracts or cause us to incur costs.


We are exposed to the risk that employee fraud or other misconduct from our employees or others acting on our behalf could occur. Misconduct by employees or others could include intentional failures to comply with U.S. Government procurement regulations, engaging in unauthorized activities, insider threats to our cybersecurity, or falsifying time records. Misconduct by our employees or others acting on our behalf could also involve the improper use of our customers’ sensitive or classified information, which could result in regulatory sanctions against us, serious harm to our reputation, a loss of contracts and a reduction in revenues, or cause us to incur costs to respond to any related governmental inquiries. It is not always possible to deter misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in controlling unknown or unmanaged risks or losses, which could cause us to lose contracts or cause a reduction in revenues. In addition, alleged or actual misconduct by

28


employees or others acting on our behalf could result in investigations or prosecutions of persons engaged in the subject activities, which could result in unanticipated consequences or expenses and management distraction for us regardless of whether we are alleged to have any responsibility.
We have in the past experienced and may in the future experience such misconduct, despite our various compliance programs. Misconduct or improper actions by our employees, agents, subcontractors, suppliers, business partners and/or joint ventures could subject us to administrative, civil or criminal investigations and enforcement actions; monetary and non-monetary penalties; liabilities; and the loss of privileges and other sanctions, including suspension and debarment, which could negatively impact our reputation and ability to conduct business and could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flows.

If we fail to maintain an effective system of internal controls, we may not be able to accurately report our financial results or prevent fraud.
Effective internal controls are necessary for us to provide reliable financial reports. If we cannot provide reliable financial reports, our operating results could be misstated, our reputation may be harmed and the trading price of our stock could be negatively affected. Our management has concluded that there are no material weaknesses in our internal controls over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017.29, 2019. However, although we continue to devote substantial time and resources to the documentation and testing of our controls, there can be no assurance that our controls over financial processes and reporting


will be effective in the future or that material weaknesses or significant deficiencies in our internal controls will not be discovered in the future. Any failure to remediate any future material weaknesses or implement required new or improved controls, or difficulties encountered in their implementation, could harm our operating results, cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations or result in material misstatements in our Consolidated Financial Statementsconsolidated financial statements or other public disclosures. Inferior internal controls could also cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information, which could have a negative effect on the trading price of our stock.
We are subject to environmental laws and potential exposure to environmental liabilities. This may affect our ability to develop, sell or rent our property or to borrow money where such property is required to be used as collateral.
We use hazardous materials common to the industries in which we operate. We are required to follow federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations regarding the handling, storage and disposal of these materials, including the Clean Air Act, the Clean Water Act, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation and Liability Act (“CERCLA”), and the Toxic Substances Control Act. We could be subject to fines, suspensions of production, alteration of our manufacturing processes or interruption or cessation of our operations if we fail to comply with present or future laws or regulations related to the use, storage, handling, discharge or disposal of toxic, volatile or otherwise hazardous chemicals used in our manufacturing processes. These regulations could require us to acquire expensive remediation equipment or to incur significant other expenses to comply with environmental regulations. Our failure to control the handling, use, storage or disposal of, or adequately restrict the discharge of, hazardous substances could subject us to liabilities and production delays, which could cause us to miss our customers’ delivery schedules, thereby reducing our sales for a given period. We may also have to pay regulatory fines, penalties or other costs (including remediation costs), which could materially reduce our profits and adversely affect our financial condition. Permits are required for our operations, and these permits are subject to renewal, modification and, in some cases, revocation.
In addition, under environmental laws, ordinances or regulations, a current or previous owner or operator of property may be liable for the costs of removal or remediation of some kinds of petroleum products or other hazardous substances on, under, or in its property, adjacent or nearby property, or offsite disposal locations, without regard to whether the owner or operator knew of, or caused, the presence of the contaminants, and regardless of whether the practices that resulted in the contamination were legal at the time they occurred. We have incurred, and may incur in the future, liabilities under CERCLA and other environmental laws at our current or former facilities, adjacent or nearby properties or offsite disposal locations. The costs associated with future cleanup activities that we may be required to conduct or finance may be material. The presence of, or failure to remediate properly, hazardous substances may adversely affect the ability to sell or rent the property or to borrow funds using the property as collateral. Additionally, we may become subject to claims by third parties based on damages, including personal injury and property damage, and costs resulting from the disposal or release of hazardous substances into the environment.


Regulations related to “conflict minerals” may cause us to incur additional expenses and could limit the supply and increase the cost of certain metals used in manufacturing our products.


We are subject to regulations requiring disclosures of specified minerals, known as conflict minerals, that are necessary to the functionality or production of products manufactured or contracted to be manufactured by public companies. The rule requires companies to perform due diligence, disclose and report whether or not such minerals originate from the Democratic Republic of the Congo or an adjoining country. The rule can affect sourcing at competitive prices and availability in sufficient quantities of certain minerals used in the manufacture of our products, including tantalum, tin, gold and tungsten. The number of suppliers who provide conflict-free minerals is limited. In addition, there are costs associated with complying with the disclosure requirements, such as costs related to determining the source of certain minerals used in our products, as well as costs of changes to products, processes, or sources of supply as a consequence of such verification activities. Since our

29


supply chain is complex, we are not always able to sufficiently verify the origins of the relevant minerals used in our products through the due diligence procedures we implemented, which may harm our reputation. In addition, we may encounter challenges to satisfy those customers who require that all of the components of our products be certified as conflict-free, which could place us at a competitive disadvantage if we are unable to do so.


Litigation may distract us from operating our business, and adverse judgments or settlements could adversely affect our financial results and operations.
Litigation that may be brought by or against us could cause us to incur significant expenditures and distract our management from the operation of our business. Furthermore, there can be no assurance that we would prevail in such litigation or resolve such litigation on terms favorable to us, which may adversely affect our financial results and operations. See Note 14 15


of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of our legal proceedings.


Natural disasters or severe weather conditions could disrupt our business and result in loss of revenue or higher expenses.
Our business depends on maintaining operations at our facilities and being able to operate at our customer facilities and project locations. A serious, prolonged interruption or damage due to power outage, telecommunications outage, terrorist attack, earthquake, hurricane, fire, flood or other natural disaster, or other interruption could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial results. While we insure against certain business interruption risks, such insurance may not adequately compensate us for any losses incurred as a result of natural or other disasters.


Risks Related to Our Common Stock
Some of our contracts with the U.S. Government are classified, which may limit investor insight into portions of our business.
We derive a portion of our revenues from programs with the U.S. Government that are subject to security restrictions (classified programs) that preclude the dissemination of information that is classified for national security purposes. We are limited in our ability to provide details about these classified programs, their risks or any disputes or claims relating to such programs. As a result, investors and others might have less insight into our classified programs than our other businesses and, therefore, less ability to fully evaluate the risks related to our classified business.


The market price of our common stock may be volatile.
The price of our stock has been in the past, and will continue to be, subject to fluctuations as a result of a number of factors, most of which we cannot control, including: failure of our operating results to meet market or analysts’ expectations; general fluctuations in the stock market; actual or anticipated fluctuations in our operating results based on reduced and/or delayed government spending or the threat thereof; fluctuations in the stock prices of companies in our industry; changes in earnings estimated by securities analysts or our ability to meet those estimates; rumors or dissemination of false information; litigation and government inquiries; political and/or military events associated with current worldwide conflicts; and domestic and foreign economic conditions. Such volatility has had a significant effect on the market prices of many companies’ securities for reasons unrelated to their operating performance and, in the past, has led to securities class action litigation. Securities litigation against us could result in substantial costs and a diversion of our management’s attention and resources, which could have an adverse effect on our business.


Your percentage of ownership in us may be diluted in the future.
As with any publicly traded company, your percentage ownership in us may be diluted in the future because of equity issuances for acquisitions, capital market transactions or otherwise, including equity awards that we expect will be granted to our directors, officers and employees.
Future sales of our common stock could cause the market price for our common stock to decline.
We cannot predict the effect, if any, that market sales of shares of our common stock or the availability of shares of our common stock for sale will have on the market price of our common stock prevailing from time to time. Sales of substantial amounts of shares of our common stock in the public market, or the perception that those sales will occur, could cause the market price of our common stock to decline or be depressed.

30


In the future, we may issue our securities if we need to raise capital in connection with a capital expenditure, working capital requirement or acquisition. The amount of shares of our common stock issued in connection with a capital expenditure, working capital requirement or acquisition could constitute a material portion of our then-outstanding shares of common stock. Any perceived excess in the supply of our shares in the market could negatively impact our share price and any issuance of additional securities in connection with investments or acquisitions may result in additional dilution to you.
We do not expect to pay any cash dividends or buyback any Kratos stock for the foreseeable future.
We have not declared any cash dividends since becoming a public company. We currently intend to retain any future earnings to finance the growth and development of the business and, therefore, we do not anticipate that we will pay any cash dividends on shares of our common stock in the foreseeable future. In addition, our ability to pay dividends and buyback Kratos stock is restricted by both the Indenture and the Credit Agreement. Any determination to pay dividends or stock buybacks in the


future will be at the discretion of our board of directors and will be dependent upon our future financial condition, results of operations and capital requirements, general business conditions and other relevant factors as determined by our board.board of directors. See “Dividend policy.Policy.


Certain provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and second amended and restated bylaws, as amended, and of Delaware law, may prevent or delay an acquisition of our Company, which could decrease the trading price of our common stock.


Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, our second amended and restated bylaws, as amended, and Delaware law contain provisions that are intended to deter coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids by making such practices or bids unacceptably expensive to the raider and to encourage prospective acquirers to negotiate with our board of directors rather than to attempt a hostile takeover. These provisions include, among others:


the inability of our stockholders to call a special meeting;
rules regarding how stockholders may present proposals or nominate directors for election at stockholder meetings;
meetings;
the right of our board of directors to issue preferred stock without stockholder approval;
a super-majority requirement to amend our certificate of incorporation or bylaws; and
the ability of our directors, and not stockholders, to fill vacancies on our board of directors.


Delaware law also imposes some restrictions on mergers and other business combinations between us and any holder of 15% or more of our outstanding common stock.


We believe these provisions may help protect our stockholders from coercive or otherwise unfair takeover tactics by requiring potential acquirers to negotiate with our board of directors and by providing our board of directors with more time to assess any acquisition proposal. These provisions are not intended to make our Company immune from takeovers. In addition, although we believe these provisions collectively provide for an opportunity to receive higher bids by requiring potential acquirers to negotiate with our board, they would apply even if the offer may be considered beneficial by some stockholders. These provisions may also frustrate or prevent any attempts by our stockholders to replace or remove our current management team by making it more difficult for stockholders to replace members of our board, which is responsible for appointing the members of our management.


Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments.


None.


Item 2. Properties.


At December 31, 201729, 2019, we owned or leased approximately 1.61.7 million square feet of floor space at 5842 separate locations, primarily in the U.S., for manufacturing, warehousing, research and development, administration and various other uses. At December 31, 201729, 2019, we leased to third parties 141,451131,451 square feet of our leased facilities, and had no vacant floor space of 23,991 square feet.space. We continually evaluate our current and future space capacity in relation to current and projected future staffing levels. We maintain our properties in good operating condition and believe that the productive capacity of our properties is adequate to meet current contractual requirements and those for the foreseeable future.

31


We have major operations at the following locations:
Kratos Government Solutions: Huntsville, AL; San Diego, CA; Colorado Springs, CO; Jupiter and Orlando, FL; Baltimore and Lanham, MD; Bristow, OK; Dallastown, PA; and Alexandria and Chantilly, VA. Locations outside the U.S. include Australia, Canada, England, France, Germany, Israel, Norway, and the United Kingdom.
Unmanned Systems: Roseville and Sacramento, CA; and Fort Walton Beach, FL.FL, and Oklahoma City, OK.
Public Safety and Security: Fullerton, CA; Newport, DE; Chicago, IL; Indianapolis, IN; Fairlawn, NJ; and Houston, TX.
Corporate and other locations: San Diego, CA.


The following is a summary of our floor space at December 31, 2017:29, 2019:
Square feet (in thousands)  Owned Leased Total  Owned Leased Total
Kratos Government SolutionsKratos Government Solutions 417
 724
 1,141
Kratos Government Solutions 417
 814
 1,231
Unmanned SystemsUnmanned Systems 20
 204
 224
Unmanned Systems 20
 388
 408
Public Safety and Security 
 153
 153
Corporate (includes San Diego operations of KGS, US and PSS segments) 
 34
 34
Corporate (includes San Diego, operations of KGS and US segments)Corporate (includes San Diego, operations of KGS and US segments) 
 26
 26
Total Total 437
 1,115
 1,552
Total 437
 1,228
 1,665


See Note 56 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report on Form 10-K for information regarding commitments under leases.


Item 3.  Legal Proceedings.
 
See Note 1415 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of our legal proceedings.
 
Item 4.  Mine Safety Disclosures.


None.


PART II


Item 5. Market For Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities.


Market Information
Our common stock is listed on the NASDAQ Global Select Market and is traded under the symbol “KTOS”.

32

Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the high and low intraday sales prices for our common stock for the periods indicated, as reported by NASDAQ:
 HighLow
Year Ended December 31, 2017:  
Fourth Quarter$13.75
$9.71
Third Quarter$13.93
$10.64
Second Quarter$11.63
$7.37
First Quarter$9.19
$6.83
Year Ended December 25, 2016:  
Fourth Quarter$8.22
$5.23
Third Quarter$7.58
$3.75
Second Quarter$5.58
$3.87
First Quarter$4.70
$2.80
Holders of Record
On February 23, 2018, the closing sale price of our common stock as reported by the NASDAQ Global Select Market was $12.31 per share. On February 23, 2018,20, 2020, there were 373350 shareholders of record of our common stock.


Dividend Policy


We have not declared any cash dividends since becoming a public company. We currently intend to retain any future earnings to finance the growth and development of the business and, therefore, do not anticipate paying any cash dividends in the foreseeable future. In addition, our ability to pay dividends is restricted by both the Indenture and the Credit Agreement, each as discussed in the section entitled “Liquidity and Capital Resources” in Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and Note 45 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report. Any future determination to pay cash dividends will be at the discretion of our board of directors and will be dependent upon our future financial condition, results of operations and capital requirements, general business conditions and other relevant factors as determined by our board of directors.






33

Table of Contents



Performance Graph
The following performance graph and related information shall not be deemed “soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC, nor shall such information be incorporated by reference into any future filing under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), or the Exchange Act of 1934 as amended (the “Exchange Act”), except to the extent that we specifically incorporate it by reference into such filing.
The following performance graph presents a comparison of the five year cumulative stockholder return on our common stock against the cumulative total return of a broad equity market index, the Russell 2000 Stock Index, and twoone customized peer groupsgroup consisting of the companies listed below, for the period commencing December 31, 20122014 and ending December 31, 2017.2019. The performance graph assumes an initial investment of $100 in our common stock and in each of the Russell 2000 Stock Index and the peer groups,group, and further assumes that all dividends were reinvested and all returns are market-cap weighted. The historical information set forth below is not necessarily indicative of future stock price performance.
 COMPARISON OF 5 YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN* 
 
Among Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc., the Russell 2000 Index,
Oldand Peer Group (1), and New Peer Group (2)
 
chart-55fe09ef4e4652698fb.jpg
 *$100 invested on 12/31/1214 in stock or index, including reinvestment of dividends.

Fiscal year ending December 31.
 
   
   

(1)The companies included in the Company’s Old Peer Group are: AAR Corp., AeroVironment Inc., Arotech Corp., Comtech Telecommunications Corp., CPI Aerostructures Inc., Ducommun Inc., Frequency Electronics Inc., and Sparton Corp. IRobot Corp., which was included in the peer group used in preparing the Performance Graph contained in the Company’s 2016 annual report on Form 10-K, has been excluded because full year standalone performance is not available for such company through 2017.
(2)The companies included in the Company’s New Peer Group are: AAR Corp., Aerojet Rocketdyne Holdings Inc., AeroVironment Inc., Arotech Corp., Comtech Telecommunications Corp., CPI Aerostructures Inc., Ducommun Inc., Frequency Electronics Inc. and Sparton Corp.


34

Table of Contents

The companies included in the Company’s Peer Group are: AAR Corp., Aerojet Rocketdyne Holdings, Inc., AeroVironment Inc., Comtech Telecommunications Corp., CPI Aerostructures Inc., Ducommun Inc., Frequency Electronics Inc., and Mercury Systems Inc. Arotech Corp., which was included in the 2018 Peer Group has been excluded from the current Peer Group as it is no longer publicly traded.
Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities; Use of Proceeds
None.


Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers
None.


Item 6. Selected Financial Data.


The following selected consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with our Consolidated Financial Statements and related notes thereto and with Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” contained within this Annual Report. Our historical results are not necessarily indicative of operating results to be expected in the future.
Amounts in millions except per share amounts        
Amounts in millions except per share amounts.Amounts in millions except per share amounts.        
December 31,
2017
 December 25,
2016
 December 27,
2015
 December 28,
2014
 December 29,
2013
December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Consolidated Statements of Operations Data:                  
Revenues$751.9
 $668.7
 $657.1
 $763.0
 $844.1
$717.5
 $618.0
 $603.3
 $541.9
 $512.5
Gross profit197.3
 153.6
 161.8
 179.4
 204.5
190.0
 169.7
 157.6
 120.5
 124.2
Operating income (loss)(5.8) (18.6) (4.5) 5.3
 18.2
38.0
 30.5
 (12.0) (18.0) (9.6)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes(8.2) 8.1
 (11.4) 3.9
 1.1
4.8
 4.6
 (10.2) 5.8
 (13.8)
Loss from continuing operations(42.6) (60.4) (33.2) (75.7) (29.5)
Income (loss) from continuing operations10.9
 4.1
 (46.9) (57.6) (35.8)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations(0.1) (0.1) 53.0
 (2.3) (7.7)1.7
 (7.6) 4.2
 (2.9) 55.6
Net income (loss)$(42.7) $(60.5) $19.8
 $(78.0) $(37.2)12.6
 (3.5) (42.7) (60.5) 19.8
Loss from continuing operations per common share:         
Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interest0.1
 
 
 
 
Net income (loss) attributable to Kratos$12.5
 $(3.5) $(42.7) $(60.5) $19.8
Income (loss) from continuing operations per common share attributable to Kratos:Income (loss) from continuing operations per common share attributable to Kratos:      
Basic$(0.48) $(0.99) $(0.56) $(1.31) $(0.52)$0.10
 $0.04
 $(0.52) $(0.94) $(0.61)
Diluted$(0.48) $(0.99) $(0.56) $(1.31) $(0.52)$0.10
 $0.04
 $(0.52) $(0.94) $(0.61)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations per common share:         Income (loss) from discontinued operations per common share:      
Basic$
 $
 $0.90
 $(0.04) $(0.13)$0.02
 $(0.07) $0.04
 $(0.05) $0.95
Diluted$
 $
 $0.90
 $(0.04) $(0.13)$0.01
 $(0.07) $0.04
 $(0.05) $0.95
Net income (loss) per common share:         
Net income (loss) per common share attributable to Kratos:Net income (loss) per common share attributable to Kratos:      
Basic$(0.48) $(0.99) $0.34
 $(1.35) $(0.65)$0.12
 $(0.03) $(0.48) $(0.99) $0.34
Diluted$(0.48) $(0.99) $0.34
 $(1.35) $(0.65)$0.11
 $(0.03) $(0.48) $(0.99) $0.34
Weighted average shares:                  
Basic89.5
 61.3
 58.7
 57.6
 56.8
106.0
 103.8
 89.5
 61.3
 58.7
Diluted89.5
 61.3
 58.7
 57.6
 56.8
109.2
 106.1
 89.5
 61.3
 58.7
                  
December 31,
2017
 December 25,
2016
 December 27,
2015
 December 28,
2014
 December 29,
2013
December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Consolidated Balance Sheet Data:                  
Cash and cash equivalents$129.6
 $69.1
 $28.5
 $33.5
 $54.2
$172.6
 $182.7
 $130.5
 $70.2
 $30.4
Working capital282.4
 176.6
 148.0
 147.1
 174.9
339.5
 330.0
 282.5
 176.5
 148.0
Total assets1,024.0
 948.6
 903.3
 1,131.2
 1,201.6
1,186.0
 1,010.1
 1,024.0
 948.6
 903.3
Short-term debt0.8
 1.0
 1.0
 1.1
 1.3

 
 0.8
 1.0
 1.0
Long-term debt293.5
 431.0
 444.1
 655.4
 613.9
295.1
 294.2
 293.5
 431.0
 444.1
Long-term debt premium
 
 
 
 14.5
Total stockholders’ equity$511.5
 $276.4
 $254.2
 $224.3
 $295.8
$574.1
 $519.3
 $511.5
 $276.4
 $254.2


35

Table of Contents

We incurred acquisition-related expenses of $0.2 million for fiscal 2014 and a benefit of $3.8 million related to acquisition items for fiscal 2013. The 2014 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data includes a loss on extinguishment of debt of $39.1 million related to the refinance of the $625.0 million 10% Senior Secured Notes due in 2017 (the “10% Notes”) with the $625.0 million 7.00% Senior Secured Notes due in 2019 (the “7% Notes”). The 2014 Consolidated Balance Sheet Data reflects the refinancing of the 10% Notes with the 7% Notes. The net proceeds of the 7% Notes was $618.5 million after an original issue discount of $6.5 million. We utilized the net proceeds from the 7% Notes, a $41.0 million draw on the Credit Agreement, as well as cash from operations to extinguish the 10% Notes.


The 2015 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data includes an $80.8 million gain on the disposal of discontinued operations before taxes and a loss of $3.4 million on extinguishment of debt. The 2015 Consolidated Balance Sheet Data


includes repayment of $41.0 million outstanding on our Credit Agreement and the repurchase of $175.0 million of our 7%previously outstanding 7.00% Senior Secured Notes due 2019 (the “7% Notes”) at par.


The 2016 Consolidated Balance Sheet Data includes our equity offering of 13.4 million shares of common stock, which generated net proceeds of $76.2 million and our use of $14.1 million of the net proceeds from the offering to buy back and redeem approximately $14.5 million of our 7% Notes. The 2016 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data and Consolidated Balance Sheet Data were impacted by an $18.7 million loss accrual recorded in 2016 on the LCASD cost share contract, which is expected to be incurred by us over the period of performance of the contract, and was incurred in order to retain the intellectual property rights for the new LCASD platform.


The 2017 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data and Consolidated Balance Sheet Data includes a $24.2 million impairment of the carrying value of the goodwill of our Defense Rocket Support ServicesDRSS reporting unit within itsour KGS Segmentsegment and a $17.3 million loss on extinguishment of debt related to the refinancing of the remaining $372.8 million outstanding balance of the 7% Notes. The 2017 Consolidated Balance Sheet Data also includes our equity offerings of approximately 28.0 million shares of common stock, which generated net proceeds of $269.1 million and our use of $64.0 million of the net proceeds from the offering to buy back and redeem approximately $62.7 million of our 7% Notes. The 2017 Consolidated Balance Sheet Data also reflects the refinancing of the remaining $372.8 million of our 7% Notes with $300.0 million of 6.5% Notes. We incurred debt issuance costs of $6.6 million associated with the new 6.5% Notes. We utilized the net proceeds from the 6.5% Notes, along with cash of $89.7 million to extinguish the 7% Notes.



The 2018 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data and Consolidated Balance Sheet Data includes the disposition of the PSS business which was disposed of on June 11, 2018 and is reflected as a discontinued operation. The 2018 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data and Consolidated Balance Sheet Data also reflects the adoption of FASB ASC 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“ASC 606”), effective January 1, 2018.

The 2019 Consolidated Statement of Operations Data and Consolidated Balance Sheet Data includes the February 2019 acquisition of FTT as well as the adoption of FASB ASC 842, Leases, on December 31, 2018.

Item 7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.
 
In addition to historical information, the following discussion contains forward-looking statements that are subject to risks and uncertainties. Our actual results may differ substantially from those expressed in or implied by any forward-looking statements herein due to a number of factors, including but not limited to the risks and uncertainties described in this Item 7, in Item 1A Risk Factors and elsewhere in this Annual Report. These forward-looking statements reflect our views and assumptions only as of the date such forward-looking statements are made. Except as required by law, we assume no responsibility for updating any forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.


The following discussion should be read in conjunction with our audited Consolidated Financial Statements and the related notes and other financial information appearing elsewhere in this Annual Report and other reports and filings made with the SEC.


Overview


Kratos is a government contractor at the forefront of the DoD’s Third Offset Strategyrecapitalization of strategic weapon systems to address peer and near peer threats and its related Rapid Innovation Initiatives. Kratos is a leading technology, intellectual property, proprietary product and system company focused on the U.S. and its allies’ national security. Kratos is a recognized industry leader in the rapid development, demonstration and fielding of high technology systems and products at an affordable cost. Kratos’ primary focus areas are unmanned systems, space and satellite communications, microwave electronics, cyber security/warfare, training systems, missile defense, turbine technologies, C5ISR and combattraining systems. We believe that our technology, intellectual property, proprietary products and designed-in positions on our customers’ programs, platforms and systems, providingand our ability to rapidly develop, demonstrate and field affordable leading technology systems gives us with sole and single source positions with our offerings is a competitive advantage and creates a high barrier to entry into our markets. Our work force is primarily technically oriented and highly skilled with a significant number of employees holding national security clearances. Our entire organization is focused on executing our strategy of becoming the leading technology and intellectual property based company in our industry.


Our primary end customers are U.S. Government agencies, including the DoD, intelligence agencies, and other national and homeland security related agencies. We also conduct business with local, state and foreign governments and

36

Table of Contents

domestic and international commercial customers. In fiscal 2017, 20162019, 2018 and 2015,2017, we generated 60%71%, 60%72% and 61%75%, respectively, of our total revenues from contracts with the U.S. Government (including all branches of the U.S. military)military and


including FMS), either as a prime contractor or a subcontractor. We believe our stable customer base, strong customer relationships, intellectual property, specialized and differentiated products, broad array of contract vehicles, “designed in” positions on strategic national security platforms, our targeted investments in strategic growth areas, large employee base possessing specialized skills, security clearances, specialized manufacturing facilities and equipment, extensive list of past performance qualifications, and significant management and operational capabilities position us for success.


We were incorporated in the state of New York on December 19, 1994 and began operations in March 1995. We reincorporated in the state of Delaware in 1998.


Industry Background


In May 2017,On December 18, 2019, President Trump signed two 2020 spending bills totaling $1.4 trillion. The bills allocate $738 billion to the President signed into law the FY 2017 Consolidated Appropriations Act. In total for FY 2017, Congress appropriated $524military and $632 billion in base discretionary funding for the DoD, consistent with the BCA. Congress also appropriated approximately $68 billion in OCO funding and approximately $15 billion in additional DoD appropriations.

In May 2017, the President released a revised FY 2018 budget request, which seeks $575to non-defense agencies, representing increases over fiscal 2019 of $22 billion for the DoD’sPentagon and $27 billion for non-defense agencies. The NDAA grants a base budget of approximately $52$666.5 billion above(including the statutory caps providedestablishment of a new, sixth armed service for in the BCA. The President’s budget request also seeksspace) and an additional $65$71.5 billion in OCOfor overseas contingency operations funding, for expeditionary needs, not capped bya.k.a. the BCA. On September 8, 2017, the President signed a continuing resolution which generally funded the government at FY 2017 levels through December 8, 2017. The continuing resolution was extended to December 22, 2017 and further extended to January 19, 2018. As Congress did not enact appropriations legislation or a new continuing resolution by January 19, 2018, on January 20, 2018, the U.S. Government temporarily shut down. On January 22, 2018, a fourth continuing resolution was enacted, which funds the government through February 8, 2018.

On February 9, 2018, the Congress approved and the President signed the Bipartisan Budget Act of 2018, which provides that:
spending limits created by the BCA will be increased by approximately $300 billion over the next two years;
defense spending will be increased by $80 billion in the current FY and by $85 billion next year, to approximately $700 billion and $705 billion, respectively;
domestic spending will be increased by $63 billion this year and by $68 billion next year; and
Congress will suspend the debt limit through March 2019, putting the next debt limit vote past the 2018 midterm elections.

The Congress and the President also executed a fifth continuing resolution authorization through March 23, 2018, to provide congressional appropriators the time required to appropriately document and allocate the authorized spending.

war budget. The federal budget and debt ceiling are expected to continue to be the subject of considerable debate, which could have a significant impact on defense spending broadly and the company’sCompany’s programs in particular inparticular.
The budget environment, including budget caps mandated by the future.

BCA for fiscal years 2020 and 2021, and uncertainty surrounding the debt ceiling and the appropriations process, remain significant short and long-term risks. Considerable uncertainty exists regarding how future budget and program decisions will unfold, including the defense spending priorities of the Administration and Congress and what challenges budget reductions (required by the BCA and otherwise) will present for the defense industry. If annual appropriations bills are not timely enacted for FY 2021 or beyond, the U.S. Government may again operate under a continuing resolution, restricting new contract or program starts, presenting resource allocation challenges and placing limitations on some planned program budgets, and we may face another government shutdown of unknown duration. If a prolonged government shutdown of the DoD were to occur, it could result in program cancellations, disruptions and/or stop work orders and could limit the U.S. Government’s ability to effectively progress programs and to make timely payments, and our ability to perform on our U.S. Government contracts and successfully compete for new work.
We believe continued budget pressures would have serious negative consequences for the U.S. Government’s ability to make timely payments.security of our country, the defense industrial base, including the Company and the customers, employees, suppliers, investors, and communities that rely on companies in the defense industrial base. It is likely budget and program decisions made in this environment would have long-term implications for our Company and the entire defense industry.

Additionally, funding for certain programs in which we participate may be reduced, delayed or cancelled, and budget cuts globally could adversely affect the viability of our subcontractors and suppliers, and our employee base. While we believe that our business is well-positioned in areas that the DoD and other customers have indicated are areas of focus for future defense spending, the long-term impact of the BCA, other defense spending cuts, challenges in the appropriations process, the debt ceiling and the ongoing fiscal debates remain uncertain.

Significant delays or reductions in appropriations; long-term funding under a continuing resolution; an extended debt ceiling breach or government shutdown; and/or future budget and program decisions, among other items, may negatively impact our business and programs and could have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations and/or cash flows.
Current Reporting Segments


We operate in threetwo reportable segments. The KGS reportable segment is comprised of an aggregation of KGS operating segments, including microwave electronic products, satellite communications,space, training and cybersecurity, training systems, modular systems, turbine technologies, and defense and rocket support services. The US reportable segment consists of our unmanned aerial, unmanned ground and unmanned seaborne system businesses. The PSS reportable segment provides independent integratedproducts. Our KGS and US segments provide products, solutions and services for advanced homelandmission critical national security public safety, critical infrastructure,programs. KGS and US customers primarily include national security related agencies, the DoD, intelligence agencies and surveillance systems forclassified agencies, and to a lesser degree, international government agencies and domestic and international commercial applications.customers. We organize our businessoperating segments based primarily on the nature of the products, solutions and services offered. For additional information regarding our reportable segments, see Note 1314 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. From a customer and solutions perspective, we view our business as an integrated whole, leveraging skills and assets wherever possible.


37

Table of Contents


Discontinued Operations


On August 21, 2015,February 28, 2018, the Company entered into a Stock Purchase Agreement to sell the operations of Kratos Public


Safety & Security Solutions, Inc., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (“PSS”), to Securitas Electronic Security, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“Buyer”). On June 11, 2018, we completed the sale of the U.S. and U.K. operations of our Electronic Products Division to Ultra Electronics Holdings plc (“Ultra”), a public limited company formed under the laws of England and Wales and traded on the London Stock Exchange, and Ultra Electronics Defense Inc. (the “Buyer”), a Delaware corporation ultimately owned by Ultra (the “Transaction”). Pursuant to the terms of that certain Stock Purchase Agreement dated May 31, 2015, by and among the Company, Ultra and the Buyer, we sold to the Buyer all of the issued and outstanding capital stock of our wholly owned subsidiary Herley Industries, Inc. (“Herley”) and certain of Herley’s subsidiaries, including Herley-CTI, Inc., EW Simulation Technology, Ltd. and Stapor Research, Inc. (collectively, the “Herley Entities”),PSS to Buyer for $260.0 million and $5.0 million for taxes incurred as part of the Transaction, less a $2.0 million escrow to satisfy any purchase price adjustments andof $69 million in cash, subject to a closing net working capital adjustment (the “Transaction”). We currently expect to receive approximately $70 million of aggregate net cash proceeds from the Transaction, after taking into account amounts to be paid by us pursuant to a negotiated transaction services agreement between us and the Buyer, receipt of approximately $8.3 million.

In November 2015,$7.0 million in net working capital retained by the Company, and Ultra settledassociated transaction fees and expenses, excluding the impact of the final settlement and determination of the closing net working capital adjustment at $8.1adjustment. To date, we have collected approximately $3.7 million of the retained net working capital. We currently expect that the remaining net working capital retained by the Company will be collected during 2020 once certain legacy projects are completed and the project close-out process has been completed. We are currently in dispute with the Buyer regarding the closing net cash position at closing, resultingworking capital adjustment. The amount in dispute is approximately $8 million. The Company currently expects to recognize a net paymentbreak-even on the sale of the PSS business once the aggregate net proceeds described above have been collected, excluding the impact of the final settlement and determination of the closing net working capital adjustment. Any changes or adjustments to the Company of $2.7 million. This represents the payment from escrow to us of $2.0 million, as well as the payment from Ultra of $0.7 million, reflecting the differenceexpected net proceeds will be reflected in the estimated working capital and actual working capital and the net cash position at the close of the Transaction. In December 2015, we submitted to Ultra for reimbursement the maximum $5.0 million for taxes incurred as part of the Transaction, which was reimbursed in January 2016.future periods.


For additional information regarding discontinued operations, see Note 89 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.Statements contained within this Annual Report.


Key Financial Statement Concepts


As of December 31, 201729, 2019, we consider the following factors to be important in understanding our financial statements.


KGS’ and US’The Company’s business with the U.S. Government and prime contractors is generally performed under fixed-price, cost reimbursable, or time and materials contracts. Cost reimbursable contracts for the U.S. Government provide for reimbursement of costs plus the payment of a fee. Some cost reimbursable contracts include incentive fees that are awarded based on performance on the contract. Under time and materials contracts, we are reimbursed for labor hours at negotiated hourly billing rates and reimbursed for travel and other direct expenses at actual costs plus applied general and administrative expenses. Effective January 1, 2018, we adopted the requirements of ASC 606, utilizing the modified retrospective method as discussed in Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report

The reported results for 2018 and 2019 reflect the application of ASC 606 guidance while the reported results for periods prior to January 1, 2018 were prepared under the guidance of Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) ASC 605, Revenue Recognition (“ASC 605”). The adoption of ASC 606 represents a change in accounting principle. In accountingaccordance with ASC 606, revenue is recognized when a customer obtains control of promised services and products. The amount of revenue recognized reflects the consideration that we expect to be entitled to receive in exchange for our long-term contracts for production of productsthese services and services providedproducts.

Prior to the U.S. Government and provided toadoption of ASC 606, we recognized the majority of our PSS segment customers under fixed-price contracts, we utilize both cost-to-cost and units delivered measures underrevenues using the percentage-of-completion method of accountingaccounting. Based on the nature of products provided or services performed, revenue was recorded as costs were incurred (the “percentage-of-completion cost-to-cost method”) or as units were delivered (the “percentage-of-completion units-of-delivery method”). For the majority of contracts, we satisfy the underlying performance obligations over time as the customer obtains control or receives benefits as work is performed on the contract. As a result, under ASC 606 revenue is recognized over a period of time utilizing the percentage-of-completion cost-to-cost method. This change generally results in an acceleration of revenue for contracts that were historically accounted for using the percentage-of-completion units-of-delivery method as revenues are now recognized earlier in the performance period as costs are incurred rather than as the products are delivered.

In accordance with the provisions of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 605, Revenue Recognition (“Topic 605”). Under the units delivered measure of the percentage-of-completion method of accounting, sales are recognized as the units are accepted by the customer generally using sales values for units in accordance with the contract terms. We estimate profit as the difference between total estimated revenue and total estimated cost ofASC 606, we evaluate whether a contract and recognize that profit over the lifewith a customer exists by evaluating a number of the contract based on deliveries or as computed on the basis of the estimated final average unit costs plus profit. We classify contract revenues as product sales or service revenues depending upon the predominant attributes of the relevant underlying contracts.

We consider the following factors when determining ifcriteria including whether collection of a receivableconsideration is reasonably assured:assured; comprehensive collection history; results of our communications with customers; the current financial position of the customer; and the relevant economic conditions in the customer’s country. If we have had no prior experience with the customer, we may review reports from various credit organizations to ensure that the customer has a history of paying its creditors in a reliable and effective manner. If the financial condition of our customers were to deteriorate and adversely affect their financial ability to make payments, additional allowances would be required. Additionally, on certain contracts whereby we perform services for a prime/general contractor, a specified percentage of the invoiced trade accounts receivable may be retained by the customer until we complete the project. We periodically review all retainages for collectability and record allowances for doubtful accounts when deemed appropriate, based on our assessment of the associated risks.


We monitor our policies and procedures with respect to our contracts on a regular basis to ensure consistent application under similar terms and conditions as well as compliance with all applicable government regulations. In addition, costs incurred and allocated to contracts with the U.S. Government are routinely audited by the DCAA.



We manage and assess the performance of our businesses based on our performance on individual contracts and programs obtained generally from government organizations with consideration given to our Critical“Critical Accounting Principles and EstimatesEstimates” discussed below. Due to the Federal Acquisition Regulation rules that govern our business, most types of costs are allowable, and we do not focus on individual cost groupings (such as cost of sales or general and administrative costs) as much

38

Table of Contents

as we do on total contract costs, which are a key factor in determining contract operating income. As a result, in evaluating our operating performance, we look primarily at changes in sales and service revenues and operating income, including the effects of significant changes in operating income. Changes in contract estimates are reviewed on a contract-by-contract basis and are revised periodically throughout the life of the contract such that adjustments to profit resulting from revisions are made cumulative to the date of the revision in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“GAAP”). Significant management judgments and estimates, including the estimated costs to complete the project, which determine the project’s percentage complete, must be made and used in connection with the revenue recognized in any accounting period. Material differences may result in the amount and timing of our revenue for any period if management makes different judgments or utilizes different estimates.


Effective December 31, 2018, we adopted the requirements of ASU 2016-02, Leases, also referred to as
“ASC 842”, utilizing the optional transition method, as discussed in Note 1 to the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements. ASC 842 requires that lessees recognize assets and liabilities for the rights and obligations underlying leases with a lease term of more than one year. The reported results for 2019 reflect the application of ASC 842 guidance while the reported results for periods prior to December 31, 2018 were prepared under the guidance of FASB Topic 840, Leases. The adoption of ASC 842 represents a change in accounting principle.

Results of Operations


Comparison of Results for the Year Ended December 31, 201729, 2019 to the Year Ended December 25, 201630, 2018


Revenues. Revenues by reportable segment for the years ended December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 201630, 2018 are as follows (in millions):


2017 2016 $ Change % Change2019 2018 $ Change % Change
Kratos Government Solutions              
Service revenues$196.5
 $221.0
 $(24.5) (11.1)%$272.6
 $200.7
 $71.9
 35.8 %
Product sales283.8
 244.8
 39.0
 15.9 %283.5
 284.4
 (0.9) (0.3)%
Total Kratos Government Solutions480.3
 465.8
 14.5
 3.1 %556.1
 485.1
 71.0
 14.6 %
Public Safety & Security - service revenues149.9
 127.1
 22.8
 17.9 %
Unmanned Systems - product sales121.7
 75.8
 45.9
 60.6 %161.4
 132.9
 28.5
 21.4 %
Total revenues$751.9
 $668.7
 $83.2
 12.4 %$717.5
 $618.0
 $99.5
 16.1 %
              
Total service revenues$346.4
 $348.1
 $(1.7) (0.5)%$272.6
 $200.7
 $71.9
 35.8 %
Total product sales405.5
 320.6
 84.9
 26.5 %444.9
 417.3
 27.6
 6.6 %
Total revenues$751.9
 $668.7
 $83.2
 12.4 %$717.5
 $618.0
 $99.5
 16.1 %


Revenues increased $83.2$99.5 million to $751.9$717.5 million in 2017for the year ended December 29, 2019 from $668.7$618.0 million in 2016. The increase in revenues wasfor the result of increased revenues of $14.5 millionyear ended December 30, 2018. Revenues in our KGS segment primarily resulting from increased shipments and work performed$71.0 million due to the FTT acquisition which contributed $52.5 million in revenues, along with increases in our satellite communications, businessmodular systems, training systems, microwave products, and our ballistic missile target businesses which contributed increased revenues of $30.5 million, partially offset by reductions of approximately $14.1$7.7 million our simulation and training systems business of approximately $16.1 million and our specialized ground equipment products business of $4.4 million. These increases were offset by a reductionresulting from reduced revenues in our legacy government services business of approximately $19.2 million, which has been impacted by continued commoditization and price competivenesscompetitiveness in the government services industry due to contract awards on a LPTAlowest price technically acceptable basis rather than on a best value basis. Increased revenues of $45.9 millionRevenues in our US segment resulted from recent contract awards in unmanned combat aerial systems which includes the commencement in July 2017 ofincreased due to increased execution on low rate initial production of our SSAT/177 aerial targets for the U.S. Navy, as well as an increaseand production on our AFSAT 167 aerial targets for the U.S. Air Force, which resulted in shipmentsincreased revenues of other unmanned aerial target systems. Increased revenues in our PSS segment of $22.8 million were driven by security system and related communication equipment integration under a security system deployment for a mass transit authority in a large metropolitan area.$23.3 million.


Product sales increased $84.9$27.6 million to $405.5$444.9 million for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019 from $320.6$417.3 million for the year ended December 25, 2016,30, 2018, primarily as a result of the increase in product shipments due to the factors discussed aboveincreased production activity in our KGSUS segment and US segments.our modular systems business. As a percentage of total revenue, product sales were 53.9%62.0% for the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, as compared to 47.9%67.5% for the year ended December 25, 2016.30, 2018. Service revenues decreasedincreased by $1.7$71.9 million to $346.4$272.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, from $348.1$200.7 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, primarily due to the decline in our legacy government services business discussed previously, offset for the most part by the increase in the PSS segment discussed previously.30, 2018.


As described in our “Critical Accounting Principles and Estimates” below and in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report, we utilize both the cost-to-cost and units delivered measures under the percentage-of-completion method of accounting for recognizing revenue as provided for in Topic 605. When revenue is calculated using the percentage-of-completion method, total costs incurred to date are compared to total estimated costs to complete the contract. These estimates are reviewed monthly on a contract-by-contract basis, and are revised periodically

39

Table of Contents

throughout the life of the contract such that adjustments to profit resulting from revisions are made cumulative to the date of the revision. Significant management judgments and estimates, including the estimated costs to complete projects, which determine the project’s percentage of completion, must be made and used in connection with the revenue recognized in any accounting period. Material differences may result in the amount and timing of our revenue for any period if management makes different judgments or utilizes different estimates. During the reporting periods contained herein, we did experience revenue and margin adjustments on certain projects based on the aforementioned factors, but the effect of such adjustments, both positive and negative, when evaluated in total were determined to be immaterial to our Consolidated Financial Statements.

Cost of revenues.  Cost of revenues increased to $554.6$527.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, from $515.1$448.3 million for the year ended December 25, 2016.30, 2018. The $39.5$79.2 million increase in cost of revenues was primarily a result of increased revenue discussed above.


Gross margin percentage increaseddecreased to 26.2% for the year ended December 31, 2017, compared to 23.0% for the year ended December 25, 2016. Margins on services increased to 28.6% for the year ended December 31, 2017 from 26.5% for the year ended December 25, 2016, due primarily29, 2019, compared to a more favorable mix of revenues and due to the impact of cost reduction actions that we took in 2016 in our modular systems business. Margins on product sales increased27.5% for the year ended December 31, 2017,30, 2018. Margins on services decreased to 29.6% for the year ended December 29, 2019 from 31.3% for the year ended December 30, 2018. Margins on product sales decreased for the year ended December 29, 2019, as compared to December 25, 201630, 2018 to 24.3%24.6% from 19.1%25.6%, respectively, primarily as a result of a change in the mix of products sold, and the ramp in production in our US segment as we have commenced low rate initial production on our SSAT/177 program for the U.S. Navy. In addition, the 2016 gross profit and gross margin included an $18.7 million loss accrual recorded on the LCASD cost share contract incurred in order to retain the intellectual property rights for the new LCASD platform.products. Margins in the KGS segment increaseddecreased to 27.6%28.3% for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019 from 26.3%29.1% for the year ended December 25, 2016, primarily as a result of change in the mix of products sold.30, 2018. Margins in the US segment increaseddecreased to 20.5%20.4% for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019 from (2.9)%21.3% for the year ended December 25, 2016, which reflects the ramp in low rate initial production, the increase in revenues and the effect from the $18.7 million loss accrual recorded on the LCASD cost share contract during 2016. Margins30, 2018, primarily due to a less favorable mix of products sold in the PSS segmentyear ended December 29, 2019.

Selling, general and administrative expenses (SG&A).  SG&A increased $11.0 million to 26.6%$130.8 million for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019, from 26.1%$119.8 million for the year ended December 25, 201630, 2018. As a percentage of revenues, SG&A decreased to 18.2% for the year ended December 29, 2019 from 19.4% for the year ended December 30, 2018. Excluding amortization of intangibles of $7.4 million for the year ended December 29, 2019, and amortization of intangibles of $5.9 million for the year ended December 30, 2018, SG&A decreased as a result of a more favorable mixpercentage of revenues resultingto 17.2% from 18.4% for the strategic shift in focusyear ended December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018, respectively, which is primarily due to the leverage on smaller sized, higher margin projects and only selectively bidding on larger sized lower margin projects, the completion of certain lower margin projects,fixed SG&A infrastructure as revenues have increased, as well as the impact of cost reduction actions thattaken by us.

Research and development (R&D) expenses.  R&D expenses were taken during the year ended December 31, 2017, offset partially by the impact of approximately $4.1 million in unexpected cost growth recorded during 2016 on several large long-term security integration projects which are either completed or nearing completion.

Selling, general and administrative expenses (SG&A).  SG&A increased $14.3 million to $160.6$18.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, from $146.329, 2019 and $15.6 million for the year ended December 25, 2016. The increase was primarily the result of the increase in revenues described previously.30, 2018. As a percentage of revenues, SG&A decreased to 21.4% for fiscal 2017 from 21.9% for fiscal 2016. Excluding amortization of intangibles of $10.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, and amortization of intangibles of $10.5 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, SG&A decreased slightly as a percentage of revenues to 20.0% from 20.3% for the year ended December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016, respectively.

Internal research and development (IR&D) expenses.  IRR&D expenses increased to $17.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 from $13.9 million for the year ended December 25, 2016. As a percentage of revenues, IR&D increased to 2.4%remained consistent at 2.5% of revenues for the yearyears ended December 31, 2017 from 2.1% of revenues for the year ended29, 2019 and December 25, 2016. IR30, 2018. R&D expenditures are primarily related to investments we are making in conjunctioncoordination with our customers, and prospective customers, with theas we work towards our objectives ofwhich include having our products beingdesignated as the new platform for, or “designed in”“designed-in” to, certain new long termlong-term program opportunities and, our owningownership of certain intellectual property rights for products that support these programs, primarily in our unmanned systems and microwave electronic businesses as well as technology upgrades and refresh activities that are necessary for the next generation of our existing product lines primarilyspecifically in our space and satellite communications business.


MergerRestructuring Expenses and acquisition related items. Merger and acquisition related items decreased to $0.0Other. The expense of $0.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, from $1.929, 2019, primarily consisted of approximately $0.6 million in the year ended December 25, 2016. The decrease was primarily as a result of a $1.9 million chargelegal costs related to the settlement of a contractan ongoing dispute in our PSS business during the first quarter of 2016.

Unused office spacewith an international aerial targets customer and other restructuring. The expense of $0.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, was related to employee termination costs of approximately $0.3 million associated with personalpersonnel reduction actions taken during the year. The expense of $10.1$3.8 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, was due to30, 2018, consisted primarily of a $9.2litigation settlement and related legal costs of approximately $2.8 million, charge that was recorded in the Company’s modular systems business as a result of the closure of one of its manufacturing facilities, as well as, the exit from certain lower margin product business lines and employee termination costs of approximately $1.0 million related to personnel reduction actions taken in the first quarter of 2016. The restructuring charge recorded in our modular systems business was comprised of $4.9 million related to fixed and2018.


40

Table of Contents

intangible assets, of which $1.4 million was recorded in the fourth quarter of 2016 reflecting the write-down to estimated fair value of one of its facilities, $3.0 million related to exited product lines and $1.3 million related to excess facilities.

Impairment of goodwill. Impairment of goodwill includes a charge of $24.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 resulting from the annual impairment test of the carrying value of the goodwill balance of our DRSS reporting unit within the KGS segment. The majority of this business includes our legacy government services business, which we deemphasized and no longer considered a core business area in 2010. The expected future performance for the DRSS reporting unit has been adversely impacted by competitive pressures and commoditization resulting from lower priced technically acceptable awards rather than awards based on best value. Specifically, we were recently notified of losses on two sizable five year contract opportunities, which has significantly impacted the expected future financial performance of the DRSS business.

Other expense, net.Other expense, net, increased to $45.0$22.3 million from $33.7$21.8 million for the years ended December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016, respectively. The increase in expense of $11.3 million was30, 2018, respectively, primarily related to a $17.3 million loss on the extinguishment of the 7% Notes in 2017, a reduction in net interest of $6.1 million to $28.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 from $34.7 million for the year ended December 25, 2016 as a result of the Company’s repurchase and extinguishmenta net increase in interest expense of approximately $77.2$0.8 million of our 7% Notes since the fourth quarter of 2016.related to finance type lease liabilities.


Provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations.The provision for income taxes from continuing operations changedincreased to a benefit of $8.2$4.8 million on a lossincome from continuing operations before income taxes of $50.8$15.7 million for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019 from an expense of $8.1a provision $4.6 million on a loss of $52.3 million from continuing operations before income taxes for the year ended December 25, 2016. The tax benefit for the year ended December 31, 2017 was primarily comprised of foreign and state taxes offset by a decrease in the indefinite life deferred tax liability as a result of enactment of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act of 2017 (the “2017 Tax Act”). We have not completed our accounting for the tax effects of enactment of the 2017 Tax Act. We have made a reasonable estimate of the effects on our existing deferred tax balances and the one-time transition tax for certain foreign earnings and recognized a provisional tax benefit of $13.2 million in accordance with Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 118. The benefit is included as a component of income tax expense from continuing operations. Taxable income from the one-time transition tax was offset by taxable operating losses generated in the tax year ended December 31, 2017.

Effective January 1, 2018, the 2017 Tax Act requires the acceleration of revenue for tax purposes for certain types of revenue. The new rules require that we do not defer revenue on our unbilled accounts receivable later than the amounts are recognized in revenue for book purposes. This change impacts several accounting methods previously used by us and is expected to result in an acceleration of taxability of such revenue beginning in 2018 as compared with prior U.S. tax laws. Additionally, future interest deductions of the company will be limited to 30% of tax adjusted EBITDA through 2021.

Income (loss) from discontinued operations. There was no significant activity for the year ended December 31, 2017. The loss from discontinued operations was $0.1 million for each of the years ended December 31, 2017, and December 25, 2016.


41

Table of Contents

Comparison of Results for the Year Ended December 25, 2016 to the Year Ended December 27, 2015

Revenues. Revenues by reportable segment for the years ended December 25, 2016 and December 27, 2015 are as follows (in millions):

 2016 2015 $ Change % Change
Kratos Government Solutions       
Service revenues$221.0
 $209.5
 $11.5
 5.5 %
Product sales244.8
 236.6
 8.2
 3.5 %
Total Kratos Government Solutions465.8
 446.1
 19.7
 4.4 %
Public Safety & Security - service revenues127.1
 144.7

(17.6) (12.2)%
Unmanned Systems - product sales75.8
 66.3
 9.5
 14.3 %
Total revenues$668.7
 $657.1
 $11.6
 1.8 %
        
Total service revenues$348.1
 $354.2
 $(6.1) (1.7)%
Total product sales320.6
 302.9
 17.7
 5.8 %
Total revenues$668.7
 $657.1
 $11.6
 1.8 %

Revenues increased $11.6 million to $668.7 million in 2016 from $657.1 million in 2015. The increase in revenues was the result of increased revenues of $19.7 million in our KGS segment primarily resulting from increased shipments and work performed in our satellite communications business of approximately $21.1 million, our simulation and training business of approximately $6.7 million and our ballistic missile target businesses of approximately $8.6 million, offset by a reduction in shipments of our specialized ground equipment products resulting primarily from delays in contract awards of $11.8 million and other reductions primarily in our government services business, which includes our weapons reset business, of approximately $4.9 million. Increased revenues of $9.5 million in our US segment resulted from recent contract awards in unmanned combat aerial systems and unmanned aerial target systems as well as an increase in shipments of unmanned aerial target systems. Declines in our PSS segment of $17.6 million were primarily the result of our change in strategic direction in the fourth quarter of 2014 to capture higher margin work and only selectively bid on larger security integration projects that traditionally generate lower margins, coupled with the impact of approximately $4.1 million in unexpected cost growth recorded during 2016 which negatively impacted our revenues. This unexpected cost growth is primarily related to several large long-term security integration projects which are nearing completion in 2017.

Product sales increased $17.7 million to $320.6 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, from $302.9 million for the year ended December 27, 2015, primarily as a result of the increase in product shipments due to the factors discussed above in our KGS and US segments. As a percentage of total revenue, product revenues were 47.9% for the year ended December 25, 2016 as compared to 46.1% for the year ended December 27, 2015. Service revenues decreased by $6.1 million to $348.1 million for the year ended December 25, 2016 from $354.2 million for the year ended December 27, 2015. The decrease was primarily related to the change in strategic direction and the completion of larger security installation projects in our PSS segment, offset partially by increases in our KGS segment as discussed above.

As described in our “Critical Accounting Principles and Estimates” below and in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report, we utilize both the cost-to-cost and units delivered measures under the percentage-of-completion method of accounting for recognizing revenue as provided for in Topic 605. When revenue is calculated using the percentage-of-completion method, total costs incurred to date are compared to total estimated costs to complete the contract. These estimates are reviewed monthly on a contract-by-contract basis, and are revised periodically throughout the life of the contract such that adjustments to profit resulting from revisions are made cumulative to the date of the revision. Significant management judgments and estimates, including the estimated costs to complete projects, which determine the project’s percentage of completion, must be made and used in connection with the revenue recognized in any accounting period. Material differences may result in the amount and timing of our revenue for any period if management makes different judgments or utilizes different estimates. During the reporting periods contained herein, we did experience revenue and margin adjustments on certain projects based on the aforementioned factors, but the effect of such adjustments, both positive and negative, when evaluated in total, were determined to be immaterial to our Consolidated Financial Statements.

Cost of revenues. Cost of revenues increased to $515.1 million for the year ended December 25, 2016 from $495.3 million for the year ended December 27, 2015. The $19.8 million increase in cost of revenues was primarily a result of

42

Table of Contents

increased revenue discussed above, as well as an $18.7 million loss accrual recorded in 2016 on the LCASD cost share contract, which is expected to be incurred by us over the period of performance of the contract, and was incurred in order to retain the intellectual property rights for the new LCASD platform. Cost of revenues was also impacted by approximately $4.1 million in unexpected cost growth on PSS projects recorded during 2016 which negatively impacted our revenues. This unexpected cost growth is primarily related to several large long-term security integration projects which are nearing completion in 2017.

Gross margin percentage decreased to 23.0% for the year ended December 25, 2016 compared to 24.6% for the year ended December 27, 2015. Margins on services increased to 26.5% for the year ended December 25, 2016 from 24.8% for the year ended December 27, 2015, due primarily to a more favorable mix of revenues. Margins on product sales decreased for the year ended December 25, 2016 as compared to December 27, 2015 to 19.1% from 24.5%, respectively, primarily as a result of a change in the mix of products sold. Margins in the KGS segment increased to 26.3% for the year ended December 25, 2016 from 25.4% for the year ended December 27, 2015, primarily as a result of change in the mix of products sold. Margins in the US segment decreased to (2.9)% for the year ended December 25, 2016, from 16.3% for the year ended December 27, 2015, reflecting an $18.7 million loss accrual recorded on the LCASD cost share contract, which is expected to be incurred by the Company over the period of performance of the contract, and was incurred in order to retain the intellectual property rights for the new LCASD platform. Margins in the PSS segment increased slightly to 26.1% for the year ended December 25, 2016, from 26.0% for the year ended December 27, 2015, as a result of a more favorable mix of revenues, resulting from the strategic shift in focus on smaller sized, higher margin projects and only selectively bidding on larger sized lower margin projects, the completion of certain lower margin projects, as well as the impact of cost reduction actions that were taken during the year ended December 25, 2016, offset partially by the impact of approximately $4.1 million in unexpected cost growth recorded during 2016 on several large long-term security integration projects, which are nearing completion.

Selling, general and administrative expenses (SG&A). SG&A decreased $4.4 million to $146.3 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, from $150.7 million for the year ended December 27, 2015. The decrease was primarily the result of a $2.5 million reduction of amortization of intangibles in 2016, as a result of certain intangible assets being fully amortized, as well as cost reduction actions taken by us, offset partially by increased discretionary investments to pursue business opportunities in the unmanned tactical aircraft market. As a percentage of revenues, SG&A decreased to 21.9% for fiscal 2016 from 22.9% for fiscal 2015. Excluding amortization of intangibles of $10.5 million for the year ended December 25, 2016 and amortization of intangibles of $13.0 million for the year ended December 27, 2015, SG&A decreased as a percentage of revenues to 20.3% from 21.0% for the year ended December 25, 2016 and December 27, 2015, respectively, due primarily to the cost reduction actions we have taken and the increased leverage on our public company infrastructure costs as revenues expand.

Internal research and development (IR&D) expenses. IR&D expenses decreased to $13.9 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, from $16.2 million for the year ended December 27, 2015. As a percentage of revenues, IR&D decreased to 2.1% of revenues for the year ended December 25, 2016, from 2.5% of revenues for the year ended December 27, 2015. IR&D expenditures are primarily related to investments we are making in conjunction with our customers and prospective customers, with the objectives of our products being the new platform for, or “designed-in” to, certain new long term program opportunities and our owning certain intellectual property rights for products that support these programs primarily in our unmanned systems and microwave electronic businesses, as well as technology upgrades and refresh activities that are necessary for the next generation of our existing product lines primarily in our satellite communications business.

Merger and acquisition related items. Merger and acquisition related items increased to $1.9 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, from $0.1 million in the year ended December 27, 2015. The increase was primarily a result of a $1.9 million charge related to the settlement of a contract dispute in our PSS business during the first quarter of 2016.

Unused office space and other restructuring. The expense of $10.1 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, was due to a $9.2 million charge that was recorded in our modular systems business as a result of the closure of one of its manufacturing facilities, as well as, the exit from certain lower margin product business lines and employee termination costs related to personnel reduction actions taken in the first quarter of 2016. The restructuring charge recorded in our modular systems business was comprised of $4.9 million related to fixed and intangible assets, of which $1.4 million was recorded in the fourth quarter of 2016 reflecting the write-down to estimated fair value of one of its facilities, $3.0 million related to exited product lines and $1.3 million related to excess facilities. The benefit of $0.7 million for the year ended December 27, 2015 was due to a reduction in the liability for unused office space at our Columbia, Maryland facility resulting from the execution of a recent sublease arrangement, partially offset by an impairment of leasehold improvements, office furniture and equipment at that location, and employee termination costs related to personnel reduction actions taken during the year.


43

Table of Contents

Other expense, net. Other expense, net decreased to $33.7 million from $40.1 million for the years ended December 25, 2016 and December 27, 2015, respectively. The decrease in expense of $6.4 million was primarily related to a $3.4 million loss on the extinguishment of the 10% Notes in the third quarter of 2015, a reduction in interest expense of $1.3 million as a result of the redemption of $175.0 million of our 7% Notes and the repayment of $41.0 million of outstanding borrowings under our Credit Agreement in the third quarter of 2015 which both occurred as a result of our divestiture of the Herley Entities.

Provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations. The provision for income taxes from continuing operations changed to an expense of $8.1 million on a loss from continuing operations before income taxes of $52.3$8.7 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, from a benefit of $11.4 million on a loss of $44.6 million from continuing operations before income taxes30, 2018. The tax provision for the year ended December 27, 2015. The expense29, 2019 was primarily comprised of an increase in uncertain tax positions of $7.5 million, in addition to current state and foreign taxes of $2.5 million, and partially offset by a benefit of $5.2 million related to the release of a valuation allowance due to the FTT acquisition. In accordance with ASC 805, we established deferred tax liabilities for the increase in the financial statement basis of the acquired assets of FTT. As a result of our ability to recognize deferred tax assets for some of these deferred tax liabilities, we released the valuation allowance against our deferred tax assets and recognized an income tax benefit of $5.2 million for the year ended December 25, 2016 was primarily comprised of a29, 2019. The tax provision for foreign and state taxes increased by the change in the indefinite life deferred tax liability. The benefit for the year ended December 27, 201530, 2018 was primarily duecomprised of an increase in uncertain tax positions of $4.0 million, in addition to the intra-period allocation rules in ASC Topic 740, Income Taxes. Intra-period allocation rules require us to allocate its provision for income taxes between continuing operationsstate and other categories of earnings, such as discontinued operations. In periods in which there is a pre-tax loss from continuing operations and pre-tax income in other categories of earnings, such as discontinued operations, the Company must allocate the tax provision to other categories of earnings. A related tax benefit is then recorded in continuing operations. See Note 7 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements for a further discussion of our incomeforeign taxes.


Income (loss) from discontinued operations.There The income from discontinued operations was no significant activity$1.7 million for the year ended December 25, 2016.29, 2019 and includes a $3.6 million gain as a result of the release of an indemnification liability following the lapse of the statute of limitations associated with a potential tax liability that was recorded in 2015 as part of the previous sale of our Electronics Products Division. This gain was offset by a loss of $1.7 million from operating activities primarily reflecting the work performed in relation to outstanding tasks on legacy projects retained by us following the sale of the PSS business and legal expenses related to the closing net working capital dispute with the buyer of the PSS business. The loss from discontinued operations was $0.1$7.6 million for the year ended December 25, 2016, compared30, 2018, which includes a loss of $6.7 million from


operating activities through the completion of the divestiture of our PSS subsidiary in June 2018 and approximately $2.7 million of transaction-related expenses offset by related tax benefits of $1.8 million.

For a comparison of the Company’s results of operations for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2017 to incomethe fiscal year ended December 30, 2018, see Item 7, Management’s Discussion and Analysis of $53.0 millionFinancial Condition and Results of Operations in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 27, 2015,30, 2018, which includedwas filed with the gainU.S. Securities and Exchange Commission on sale of the Herley Entities of $80.8 million which occurred on August 21, 2015. The income for the year ended December 27, 2015 also reflects interest expense allocated to discontinued operations of $9.1 million. For additional information, see Note 8 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.February 28, 2019.



Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, we had cash and cash equivalents of $129.6$172.6 million compared with cash and cash equivalents of $69.1$182.7 million as of December 25, 201630, 2018, which includes $10.7$24.6 million and $5.2$12.0 million, respectively, of cash and cash equivalents held by our foreign subsidiaries. We are not presently aware of any restrictions on the repatriation of these funds, however, earnings of these foreign subsidiaries are essentially considered permanently invested in these foreign subsidiaries. If these funds were needed to fund our operations or satisfy obligations in the U.S. they could be repatriated, and their repatriation into the U.S. may cause us to incur additional foreign withholding taxes. We do not currently intend to repatriate these earnings.

During 2017, we sold approximately 28.0 million shares of our common stock in underwritten public offerings, raising net proceeds of approximately $269.1 million, after deducting underwriting fees and other offering expenses. During the quarter ended March 26, 2017, we repurchased and extinguished $62.7 million of the outstanding 7% Notes, which resulted in a loss of $1.4 million and the realization of $0.4 million of unamortized issuance cost and $0.3 million of unamortized discount resulting in a net loss of $2.1 million.

On November 20, 2017, we issued and sold $300 million aggregate principal amount of 6.5% Notes in a private placement pursuant to Rule 144A and Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. The proceeds from the 6.5% Notes were used to redeem our existing 7% Senior Secured Notes due 2019 (“7% Notes”) and to pay all fees and expenses, including premium and unpaid interest, if any, related thereto. We incurred debt issuance costs of $6.6 million associated with the new 6.5% Notes. We utilized the net proceeds from the sale of the 6.5% Notes, as well as cash from our recent equity offering to extinguish the outstanding 7% Notes.

The total reacquisition price of the 7% Notes was $385.2 million, including a $12.0 million call premium, and $0.3 million of accrued interest. During 2017, we decreased long term indebtedness by $135.5 million utilizing cash on hand and the proceeds from the 6.5% Notes, resulting in a loss on extinguishment of debt of $17.3 million during 2017.


Our total debt, including principal due on the 6.5% Notes, other term debt, andnet of debt issuance costs of $6.5$4.9 million, decreasedincreased by $137.7$0.9 million to $294.3$295.1 million as of December 31, 201729, 2019 from $432.0$294.2 million as of December 25, 2016.30, 2018. The decreaseincrease in total debt was due to the buy back, redemption and retirement of approximately $435.5 million of 7% Notes which occurred during 2017, offset by the issuance of $300 million of 6.5% Notes, in addition to the principal payment required on

44

Table of Contents

our ten-year term loan with a bank in Israel, offset partially by the amortization of the discount on our 7% Notes and the amortization of deferred financingdebt issuance costs.


We use our operating cash flow to finance trade accounts receivable, fund necessary increases in inventory, which may include leaning forward to procure long-lead materials for certain of our unmanned systems programs at our customer’s requests,customers’ request, prior to receipt of customer contractual funding documents, fund capital expenditures, our IR&D investments, other product investments, and our ongoing operations, service our debt and make strategic acquisitions. Financing trade accounts receivable is necessary because, on average, our customers do not pay us as quickly as we pay our vendors and employees for their goods and services since a number of our receivables are contractually billable and due to us only when certain contractual milestones are achieved.achieved, certain of which are not achieved until final shipment and acceptance of our products. Financing increases in inventory balances is necessary to fulfill shipment requirements to meet delivery schedules of our customers. Cash from continuing operations is primarily derived from our customer contracts in progress and associated changes in working capital components. Our days sales outstanding (“DSO”) have increaseddecreased to 121134 days as of December 31, 201729, 2019 from 115140 days as of December 25, 2016.30, 2018. Our DSOs can fluctuate from period to period, primarily as a result of certain contractual billing milestones that have not yet been attained, such as equipment shipments and deliveries on certain products, and for certain flight requirements that must be fulfilled on certain aerial target programs, or final billings which are not due until completion on certain of our large critical infrastructure deployment projects and large training systems deliveries, and therefore we are unable to contractually bill for amounts outstanding related to those milestones at this time. For instance, many of our programs, including in our training solutions business, include progress payments for which the last 10 to 20 percent of our costs incurred are withheld, and not payable until the acceptance and delivery of the system. In November 2019, a large training solutions program was terminated for convenience (“T for C”) by the customer. Under a T for C, a contractor is entitled to seek specified costs through a termination settlement process including (1) the contract price for completed supplies and services accepted by the government but not previously paid for; (2) the cost incurred in the performance of work terminated plus a reasonable profit on those costs; and (3) and its costs incurred in settling with subcontractors and preparing and settling the termination proposal. However, we will not be able to collect the total withheld amounts until the settlement terms of the T for C have been negotiated and agreed to with the customer. At December 29, 2019, approximately $11.5 million in unbilled receivables remain outstanding on this project. In addition, we are currently in dispute with an international customer in our US segment over approximately $10.0 million in unbilled receivables outstanding as of December 29, 2019. The dispute concerns the completion of certain system requirements and contractual milestones. Although there could be a delay in billing and collecting amounts due to us under the aforementioned contracts, we have evaluated the present facts of the matters and performed a reassessment of the contractual amounts due and have determined that no adjustment to previously recognized revenue, or the corresponding unbilled receivables, is necessary at December 29, 2019.



A summary of our net cash used inprovided by operating activities from continuing operations from our Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows is as follows (in millions):
 
 Year Ended
 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Net cash used in operating activities from continuing operations$(27.0) $(12.4) $(29.7)
 Year Ended
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Net cash provided by operating activities from continuing operations$28.9
 $18.1
 
Our cash used inprovided by operating activities from continuing operations for the year ended December 29, 2019 was positively impacted by increased operating income as compared to the year ended December 30, 2018. Net cash provided by operating activities from continuing operations was also impacted by interest expense we paid related to our senior secured notes.6.5% Notes. We paid $28.3 million, $32.4$19.9 million and $43.8$20.5 million in interest expense in 2017, 2016,2019 and 2015,2018, respectively. Cash used inprovided by operating activities in 20172019 and 20162018 was also negatively impacted by reduced operating income which reflected discretionary investments we have made in internally funded research and development of $17.8$18.0 million in 2017, $13.92019 and $15.6 million in 2016 and $16.2 million in 2015,2018, contract development costs on new platforms in our US segment, and increased SG&A expenditures primarily related to business capture pursuits in the tactical unmanned aircraft systems initiatives, as well as changes in working capital accounts. The net use in working capital accounts for 20172019 and 2018 includes approximately $7.7$0.9 and $3.6 million, respectively, of internal development product development investments that are non-capital expenditures we are making related to the LCASD or “Valkyrie”.


Our cash used inprovided by (used in) investing activities from continuing operations is summarized as follows (in millions):
 
Year EndedYear Ended
December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Investing activities: 
  
   
  
Cash paid for acquisitions, net of cash acquired$
 $(5.1) $
$(17.7) $(2.9)
Proceeds from sale of assets0.7
 0.1
 0.9
0.3
 66.0
Change in restricted cash
 0.3
 4.7
Capital expenditures(26.5) (9.2) (11.3)(26.3) (22.6)
Net cash used in investing activities from continuing operations$(25.8) $(13.9) $(5.7)
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities from continuing operations$(43.7) $40.5
 
Net cash used in investing activities from continuing operations for year ended December 29, 2019 is comprised of the acquisition of FTT and capital expenditures which consist primarily of investments in machinery, computer hardware and software and improvement of our physical properties in order to maintain suitable conditions in which to conduct our business. Net cash provided by investing activities from continuing operations for year ended December 30, 2018 was primarily drivenpositively impacted by the approximately $66.0 million net proceeds, net of related transaction expenses, received from the sale of PSS. These proceeds were partially offset by capital expenditures of $22.6 million, which consist of investments in 2017, 2016,machinery, computer hardware and 2015,software and improvement of our physical properties in order to maintain suitable conditions in which reflects investments we made for certain machinery, test equipment, demonstration units and Company-owned aircraft into conduct our unmanned aerial systems business, and to a lesser degree, investments we made in our microwave electronic products business, and our satellite communications business. The 2017During the year ended December 29, 2019, capital expenditures includedof approximately $13.2$13.9 million related to investments we are makingwere incurred in our US segment to build Company-owned tactical aircraft and related equipmentbusiness, primarily related to the LCASD and UTAP-22 or Mako platforms. In addition, we used $5.1 million during the fourth quarter of 2016 to fund a strategic initial investment in a satellite signal monitoring, signal intelligence and location identification technology andour unmanned combat target initiative.

45

Table of Contents

product line to enhance our existing satellite communications business offering. An initial purchase price holdback of $0.9 million to provide security for potential indemnification obligations, less any indemnification claims, will be payable in July 2018, in cash or shares of common stock, at our option. In addition, an earn-out of $2.0 million, payable in cash or shares of common stock, at our option, will be payable in July 2018. As of December 31, 2017, the earn-out criteria had been achieved.


Cash provided by (used in) financing activities from continuing operations is summarized as follows (in millions):
 
 Year Ended
 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Financing activities:     
Proceeds from the issuance of long-term debt$300.0
 $
 $
  Extinguishment of long-term debt(448.8) (14.1) (175.0)
Proceeds from the issuance of common stock269.1
 76.2
 
Cash paid for contingent acquisition consideration
 
 (1.1)
Repayment under credit facility(1.0) (1.0) (42.0)
Debt issuance costs(6.6) 
 
Proceeds from the exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, and employee stock purchase plan1.5
 2.0
 3.4
Other(0.8) 
 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities from continuing operations$113.4
 $63.1
 $(214.7)
 Year Ended
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Financing activities:   
Expenses from the issuance of common stock$
 $(1.1)
Repayment under credit facility and debt
 (0.8)
Debt issuance costs
 (0.1)
Payments under finance leases(0.5) 
Proceeds from exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, and employee stock purchase plan4.0
 3.7
Net cash provided by financing activities from continuing operations$3.5
 $1.7
    


Net cash provided by financing activities from continuing operations was $3.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 included $269.1 million in net proceeds from the equity offerings we completed in the first and fourth quarters of 2017 and $300.0 million in proceeds from the issuance of our 6.5% Notes. The net proceeds from the issuance of our 6.5% Notes along with approximately $155.1 million from the proceeds from the equity offerings was used to buy back and redeem approximately $435.5 million of our 7% Notes.29, 2019. Net cash flows provided by financing activities for the year ended December 25, 2016 included $76.2 million in net proceeds from the equity offering we completed in the fourth quarter of 2016, $14.1 million of which was used to buy back and redeem approximately $14.5 million of our Notes. Net cash flows used in financing activities from continuing operations was $1.7 million for the year ended


December 27, 2015 was primarily due30, 2018, which includes $1.1 million of fees paid in the beginning of 2018 related to the repurchaseequity offerings that were completed in 2017.

The net operating cash flows of $175.0 million of our 7% Notes and the repayment of $41.0 million outstanding on our Credit Agreement.

Cash provided by (used in) discontinued operations is summarized as follows (in millions):
 
 Year Ended
 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Net operating cash flows provided by discontinued operations$
 $0.1
 $2.8
Net investing cash flows provided by (used in) discontinued operations(0.6) 4.0
 242.5
 Year Ended
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Net operating cash flows of discontinued operations$1.1
 $(7.7)
 
The net operating cash flow provided byof discontinued operations for the year ended December 27, 201529, 2019 is substantially related to Herley Industries, Inc.the discontinued operations of our PSS business unit. During 2019, approximately $3.7 million was collected on amounts due related to the legacy projects retained by us, less costs incurred to complete the legacy projects and certainlegal costs related to the ongoing working capital dispute with the buyer of Herley’s subsidiaries.PSS. This was also partially offset by a reduction in other current liabilities of $1.8 million. The investingnet operating cash flow provided byof discontinued operations for the year ended December 25, 2016 reflects30, 2018 is substantially related to the reimbursementdiscontinued operations of taxes fromour PSS business unit, which includes the payment of $3.5 million to the Buyer of the Herley Entities received in 2016. The investing cash flow provided by discontinued operations for the year ended December 27, 2015 reflects cash provided of $243.2 million which is relatedPSS business pursuant to the sale of the Herley Entities, net of relateda negotiated transaction expenses.services agreement.


6.5% Senior Secured Notes due 2025


In November 2017, we issued and sold $300 million aggregate principal amount of 6.5% Senior Secured Notes due 2025 (the “6.5% Notes”) in a private placement conducted pursuant to Rule 144A and Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Act”). The net proceeds from the issuance of the 6.5% Notes were $295.5 million after expenses of $4.5 million. We utilized the net proceeds from the sale of the 6.5% Notes, as well as cash from our recent equity offering to extinguish our previously outstanding 7% Notes. The total reacquisition price of the 7% Notes was $385.2 million, including a $12.0 million call premium, and $0.3 million of accrued interest.

46

Table of Contents



The 6.5% Notes are governed by the Indenture, dated as of November 20, 2017 (the “Indenture”), among the Company, our existing and future domestic subsidiaries parties thereto (the “Subsidiary Guarantors”) and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as trustee and collateral agent (in such capacity, the “2017 Trustee and Collateral Agent”). A Subsidiary Guarantor can be released from its guarantee if (a) all of the capital stock issued by such Subsidiary Guarantor or all or substantially all of the assets of such Subsidiary Guarantor are sold or otherwise disposed of; (b) we designate such Subsidiary Guarantor as an Unrestricted Subsidiary; (c) we exercise our legal defeasance option or our covenant defeasance option; or (d) upon satisfaction and discharge of the Indenture or payment in full in cash of the principal of, premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest on the 6.5% Notes.


The 6.5% Notes bear interest at a rate of 6.5% per year from the date of original issuance or from the most recent payment date on which interest has been paid or provided for. Interest on the 6.5% Notes is payable in arrears on May 30 and November 30 of each year, beginning on May 30, 2018. The 6.5% Notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the Subsidiary Guarantors.


The 6.5% Notes and the guarantees (as set forth in the Indenture, the “Guarantees”) are our senior secured obligations and are equal in right of payment with all other senior obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantors’ existing and future secured debt to the extent of the assets securing that secured debt. Our obligations under the 6.5% Notes are secured by a first priority lien on substantially all of our assets and the assets of the Subsidiary Guarantors, except with respect to accounts receivable, inventory, deposit accounts, securities accounts, cash, securities and general intangibles (other than intellectual property), on which the holders of the 6.5% Notes have a second priority lien, junior to the lien securing our obligations under the Credit Agreement.


The 6.5% Notes will be redeemable, in whole or in part, at any time on or after November 30, 2020 at the respective redemption prices specified in the Indenture. In addition, we may redeem up to 40% of the 6.5% Notes before November 30, 2020 with the net proceeds of certain equity offerings. We may also redeem some or all of the 6.5% Notes before November 30, 2020 at a redemption price of 100% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest, to, but excluding, the redemption date, if any, plus a “make whole” premium. In addition, during each 12-month period commencing on the issue date and ending on or prior to November 30, 2020, we may redeem up to 10% of the original aggregate principal amount of the 6.5% Notes issued under the Indenture at a redemption price of 103.000% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, to, but excluding, the date of redemption, if any. We may also be required to make an offer to purchase the 6.5% Notes upon a change of control and certain sales of our assets.


The Indenture contains covenants limiting, among other things, our ability and the Subsidiary Guarantors’ ability to: (a) pay dividends on or make distributions or repurchase or redeem the Company’s capital stock or make other restricted payments;


(b) incur additional debt and guarantee debt; (c) prepay, redeem or repurchase certain debt; (d) issue certain preferred stock or similar equity securities; (e) make loans and investments; (f) sell assets; (g) incur liens; (h) consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our assets; (i) enter into transactions with affiliates; and (j) enter into agreements restricting our ability and certain of our subsidiaries’ ability to pay dividends. These covenants are subject to a number of exceptions. As of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, we were in compliance with the covenants contained in the Indenture governing the 6.5% Notes.


The terms of the Indenture require that the net cash proceeds from asset dispositions be either utilized to (i) repay or prepay amounts outstanding under the Credit Agreement unless such amounts are reinvested in similar collateral, (ii) permanently reduce other indebtedness, (iii) make an investment in assets that replace the collateral of the 6.5% Notes or (iii) a combination of (i), (ii) and (iii). To the extent there are any remaining net proceeds from the asset disposition after application of (i), (ii) and (iii), such amounts are required to be utilized to repurchase 6.5% Notes at par.


The Indenture also provides for events of default which, if any of them occurs, would permit or require the principal, premium, if any, interest, if any, and any other monetary obligations on all the then-outstanding 6.5% Notes to become or to be declared due and payable immediately.

7% Senior Secured Notes due 2019

In May 2014, we refinanced our $625.0 million in outstanding 10% Notes with $625.0 million of newly issued 7% Notes. The net proceeds from the issuance of the 7% Notes was $618.5 million after an original issue discount of $6.5 million. We incurred debt issuance costs of $8.8 million associated with the new 7% Notes. We utilized the net proceeds from the 7% Notes, a $41.0 million draw on our Credit Agreement discussed below, as well as cash from operations to extinguish the 10% Notes. The total reacquisition price of the 10% Notes was $661.5 million, including a $31.2 million early termination fee, the write-off of $15.5 million of unamortized issue costs, $12.9 million of unamortized premium, along with $5.3 million of additional interest while in escrow, which resulted in a loss on extinguishment of $39.1 million. On October 16, 2014, we exchanged the outstanding 7% Notes for an equal amount of 7% Notes that had been registered under the Act.

47

Table of Contents


The 7% Notes were governed by the Indenture, dated May 14, 2014, among the Company, all of the Company’s 100% owned domestic subsidiaries, as the Subsidiary Guarantors and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as Trustee and Collateral Agent. We paid interest on the 7%Notes semi-annually, in arrears, on May 15 and November 15 of each year. The 7% Notes included customary covenants and events of default as well as a consolidated fixed charge ratio of 2.0:1 for the incurrence of additional indebtedness. Negative covenants include, among other things, limitations on additional debt, liens, negative pledges, investments, dividends, stock repurchases, asset sales and affiliate transactions. Events of default include, among other events, non-performance of covenants, breach of representations, cross-default to other material debt, bankruptcy, insolvency, material judgments and changes in control.

Following the sale of the U.S. and U.K. Electronic Products Division (see Note 8 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements), on September 22, 2015, we repurchased $175.0 million of the 7% Notes at par, in accordance with the Indenture and on August 21, 2015 paid down the $41.0 million outstanding on the $110.0 million Credit Agreement. The total reacquisition price of the 7% Notes was $178.4 million including the write off of $1.8 million of unamortized issue costs, $1.4 million of unamortized discount, along with $0.2 million of legal fees, which resulted in a loss on extinguishment of $3.4 million. The Company reinvested all net proceeds remaining after the repurchase of the $175.0 million of 7% Notes in replacement collateral under the Indenture within 360 days following the asset disposition, in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.

During the year ended December 25, 2016, we repurchased and extinguished $14.5 million of the outstanding 7% Notes which resulted in a gain of $0.4 million offset by $0.1 million of unamortized issuance cost and $0.1 million of unamortized discount resulting in a net gain of $0.2 million, in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.

During the year ended December 31, 2017, we redeemed and extinguished the remaining $435.5 million of outstanding 7% Notes as of December 25, 2016, which resulted in a loss on extinguishment of debt of $13.4 million and the realization of $2.3 million of unamortized issuance cost and $1.6 million of unamortized discount, resulting in a loss on extinguishment of debt of $17.3 million..


Other Indebtedness


Credit and Security Agreement


On May 14, 2014, we entered into a $110.0 million Credit and Security Agreement, dated May 14, 2014 (as amended from time to time, the “Credit Agreement”), with the lenders from time to time party thereto, SunTrust Bank, as Agent (the “Agent”), PNC Bank, National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger and Documentation Agent, and SunTrust Robinson Humphrey, Inc., as Joint Lead Arranger and Sole Book Runner. The Credit Agreement established a five-year senior secured revolving credit facility in the maximum amount of $110.0 million (subject to a potential increase of the maximum principal amount to $135.0 million, subject to the Agent’s and applicable lenders’ approval as described therein), consisting of a subline for letters of credit in an amount not to exceed $50.0 million, as well as a swingline loan in an aggregate principal amount at any time outstanding not to exceed $10.0 million. The obligations under the Credit Agreement are secured by a first priority lien on our accounts receivable, inventory, deposit accounts, securities accounts, cash, securities and general intangibles (other than intellectual property). The obligations under the Credit Agreement are secured by a second priority lien, junior to the lien securing our senior secured notes, on all of our other assets.

The Credit Agreement contains certain covenants, which include, but are not limited to, restrictions on indebtedness, liens, and investments, and limits on other various payments, as well as a financial covenant relating to a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio. Events of default under the terms of the Credit Agreement include, but are not limited to: failure of the Company to pay any principal of any loans in full when due and payable; failure of the Company to pay any interest on any loan or any fee or other amount payable under the Credit Agreement within three business days after the date when due and payable; failure of the Company or any of its subsidiaries to comply with certain covenants and agreements, subject to applicable grace periods and/or notice requirements; any representation, warranty or statement made in or pursuant to the Credit Agreement or any related writing or any other material information furnished by us or any of our subsidiaries to the Agent or the lenders proving to be false or erroneous; and the occurrence of an event or condition having or reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect, which includes a material adverse effect on the business, operations, condition (financial or otherwise) or our prospects or our ability to repay our obligations. Where an event of default arises from certain bankruptcy events, the commitments will automatically and immediately terminate and the principal of, and interest then outstanding on, all of the loans will become immediately due and payable. Subject to certain notice requirements and other conditions, upon the occurrence of an event of default, including the occurrence of a condition having or reasonably likely to have a material

48

Table of Contents

adverse effect, commitments may be terminated and the principal of, and interest then outstanding on, all of the loans may become immediately due and payable. As of December 31, 2017, no event of default had occurred and we believe that events or conditions having a material adverse effect, giving rise to an acceleration of any amounts outstanding under the Credit Agreement, have not occurred and the likelihood of such events or conditions occurring is remote.

On May 31, 2015, we entered into a third amendment (the “Third Amendment”) to the Credit Agreement. Under the terms of the Third Amendment, the definitions of certain terms of the Credit Agreement were modified, the disposition of the Herley Entities was approved by the lenders, a minimum $175.0 million repurchase of the 7% Notes by the Company was required, and the payment in full of the outstanding balance of the Credit Agreement was required. Additionally, the measurement of the fixed charge coverage ratio of 1.15:1 was modified as follows: (i) the fixed charge coverage ratio will not be measured as of the end of any quarterly reporting period ending after June 30, 2015, if on such date (a) there are no outstanding revolving loans or swingline loans and (b) the aggregate amount outstanding under letters of credit is less than or equal to $17.0 million; and (ii) as to any subsequent quarterly reporting period ending after June 30, 2015, and not covered by (i) above, a fixed charge coverage ratio of at least 1.05:1 must be maintained if the percentage of (a) outstanding revolving loans plus the sum of the outstanding swingline loans and outstanding letters of credit that are in excess of $17.0 million, to (b) the revolving credit commitment, minus the Herley Disposition Proceeds Reinvestment Reserve, as defined below, is greater than 0.00% but less than 15.00% or a fixed charge coverage ratio of at least 1.10:1 must be maintained if the aforementioned percentage is equal to or greater than 15.00% but less than 25.00%. In all other instances, a fixed charge coverage ratio of 1.15:1 must be maintained. For purposes of computing the fixed charge coverage ratio, the associated reduction in consolidated interest expense in connection with the repurchase of 7% Notes with proceeds from the sale of the Herley Entities shall be deemed to have occurred on the first day of the most recently completed four quarterly reporting periods prior to the sale.

On August 20, 2015, we entered into a fourth amendment (the “Fourth Amendment”) to the Credit Agreement. Among other things, the Fourth Amendment provides for a modification of the Third Amendment as it relates to when the minimum fixed charge coverage ratio will be measured based upon outstanding borrowings. Outstanding borrowings for purposes of computing the applicable minimum fixed charge coverage ratio exclude any letter of credit exposure outstanding of $17.0 million plus the amount of letters of credit outstanding for the divested Herley Entities for which a cash deposit was placed in escrow by the Buyer to cover the amount of such outstanding letters of credit, should the letters of credit be pulled.


On November 20, 2017, we entered into an amended and restated Credit Agreement with the lenders from time to time party thereto, the Agent, PNC Bank, National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger and Documentation Agent, and SunTrust Robinson Humphrey, Inc., as Joint Lead Arranger and Sole Book Runner. As amended and restated, the Credit Agreement establishes a five year senior secured revolving credit facility in the aggregate principal amount of $90.0 million (subject to a potential increase of the aggregate principal amount to $115.0 million, subject to SunTrust’s and applicable lenders’ approval), consisting of a subline for letters of credit in an amount not to exceed $50.0 million, as well as a swingline loan in an aggregate principal amount at any time outstanding not to exceed $10.0 million.


Borrowings under the revolving credit facility may take the form of a base rate revolving loan, Eurodollar revolving loan or swing line loan. Base rate revolving loans and swing line loans will bear interest at a rate per annum equal to the sum of the Applicable Margin (as defined in the Credit Agreement) from time to time in effect plus the highest of (i) the Agent’s prime lending rate, as in effect at such time, (ii) the federal funds rate, as in effect at such time, plus 0.50% per annum and (iii) the Adjusted LIBOLIBOR Rate (as defined in the Credit Agreement) determined at such time for an interest period of one month, plus 1.00% per annum. Eurodollar revolving loans will bear interest a rate per annum equal to the sum of the Applicable Margin from time to time in effect plus the Adjusted LIBOLIBOR Rate. The Applicable Margin varies between 1.00%-1.50% for base rate revolving loans and swing line loans and 2.00%-2.50% for Eurodollar loans, and is based on several factors including our then-existing borrowing base and the lenders’ total commitment amount and revolving credit exposure. The calculation of our borrowing base takes into account several items relating to us and our subsidiaries, including amounts due and owing under billed and unbilled accounts receivables, then held eligible raw materials inventory, work-in-process inventory, and applicable reserves.


The measurement of a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio was modified in the November 2017 amended and restated Credit Agreement to beis required to be measured if Excess Availability, as defined in the Credit Agreement, is less than fifty percent of the lesser of the Borrowing Base or the Total Commitment Amount.Amount, each as defined in the Credit Agreement.



As of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, there were no borrowings outstanding on the Credit Agreement and $9.5$5.4 million was outstanding on letters of credit, resulting in net borrowing base availability of $65.8$69.3 million. We were in compliance with the financial covenants of the Credit Agreement as of December 31, 2017.29, 2019.


49

Table of Contents

Debt Acquired in Acquisition of Herley

We assumed a $10.0 million ten-year term loan with a bank in Israel that Herley entered into on September 16, 2008 in connection with the acquisition of one of its wholly owned subsidiaries. The balance as of December 31, 2017 was $0.8 million, and the loan is payable in quarterly installments of $0.3 million plus interest at LIBOR plus a margin of 1.5%. The loan agreement governing the term loan contains various covenants including a minimum net equity covenant as defined in the loan agreement. We were in compliance with all covenants contained in the loan agreement as of December 31, 2017.


Off Balance Sheet Arrangements


We have no off-balance sheet arrangements as defined in Regulation S-K, Item 303(a)(4)(ii).


Contractual Obligations and Commitments


The following table summarizes our contractual obligations and other commitments at December 31, 2017,29, 2019, and the effect such obligations could have on our liquidity and cash flow in future periods (in millions):


Payments due/forecast by PeriodPayments Due/Forecast by Period
Total 2018 2019 - 2020 2021 - 2022 2023 and AfterTotal 2020 2021 - 2022 2023 - 2024 2025 and After
Debt, net of interest(1)$300.8
 $0.8
 $
 $
 $300.0
$300.0
 $
 $
 $
 $300.0
Estimated interest on debt(2)156.0
 19.5
 39.0
 39.0
 58.5
136.5
 19.5
 39.0
 39.0
 39.0
Purchase orders(3)138.2
 92.6
 45.6
 
 
153.1
 112.4
 40.6
 0.1
 
Operating leases(4)127.8
 18.0
 33.8
 20.7
 55.3
57.2
 12.6
 18.6
 14.4
 11.6
Finance leases(4)70.2
 3.1
 6.5
 6.6
 54.0
Unrecognized tax benefits, including interest and penalties(5)
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
Total commitments and recorded liabilities$722.8
 $130.9
 $118.4
 $59.7
 $413.8
$717.0
 $147.6
 $104.7
 $60.1
 $404.6


(1)The 6.5% Notes in the aggregate outstanding principal amount of $300.0 million are due November 30, 2025. See Note 45 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report for further details.


(2)Includes interest payments based on current interest rates for variable rate debt and the 6.5% Notes. See Note 45 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within in this Annual Report for further details.


(3)Purchase orders include commitments in which a written purchase order has been issued to a vendor, but the goods have not been received or services have not been performed.


(4)We have entered into or acquired various non-cancelable operating and finance lease agreements that expire on various dates through 2033. The amounts include $3.3 million in excess facility costs and exclude expected sublease income.2038. See Note 56 in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report for further details.


(5)
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, we have a $6.8$15.7 million noncurrent liability for uncertain tax positions and a $3.8$2.8 million guarantor liability, all of which may result in cash payments. The future payments related to uncertain tax positions have not been presented in the table above due to the uncertainty of the amounts and timing of cash settlements with the taxing authorities.


As of December 31, 201729, 2019, we have $9.5$5.4 million of standby letters of credit outstanding. Our letters of credit are primarily related to milestone payments received from foreign customers for which the customer has not yet received the product. Additional information regarding our financial commitments at December 31, 201729, 2019 is provided in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained in this Annual Report, specifically Note 14.15.


Other Liquidity Matters


We believe our cash on hand, together with funds available under the Credit Agreement and cash expected to be generated from operating activities will be sufficient to fund our anticipated working capital and other cash needs for at least the next 12 months. As discussed in Item 1A “Risk Factors” contained within this Annual Report, our quarterly and annual

50

Table of Contents

operating results have fluctuated in the past and may vary in the future due to a variety of factors, many of which are external to our control. If the conditions in our industry deteriorate, our customers cancel or postpone projects or if we are unable to sufficiently increase our revenues or further reduce our expenses, we may experience, in the future, a significant long-term


negative impact to our financial results and cash flows from operations. In such a situation, we could fall out of compliance with our financial and other covenants which, if not waived, could limit our liquidity and capital resources.


Critical Accounting Principles and Estimates
 
We have identified the following critical accounting policies that affect our more significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation of our Consolidated Financial Statements. The preparation of our Consolidated Financial Statements in conformity with GAAP requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, stockholders’ equity, revenues and expenses, and related disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities. On a periodic basis, as deemed necessary, we evaluate our estimates, including those related to revenue recognition, allowance for doubtful accounts, valuation of inventory including the reserves for excess and obsolete inventory, valuation of long-lived assets including identifiable intangibles and goodwill, accounting for income taxes including the related valuation allowance, warranties, contingencies and litigation, contingent acquisition consideration, stock-based compensation, and losses on unused office space. We explain these accounting policies in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report and at relevant sections in this discussion and analysis. These estimates are based on the information that is currently available and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could vary from those estimates under different assumptions or conditions and such differences may be material.


Revenue recognition. We generate our revenue primarily Effective January 1, 2018, we adopted the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) ASU 2014-09, Revenue from three different types of contractual arrangements: cost-plus-feeContracts with Customers, and the related amendments, which are codified into Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 606 (“ASC 606”), which establishes a broad principle that requires entities to assess the products or services promised in contracts time-and-materials contracts, and fixed-price contracts.with customers at contract inception to determine the appropriate unit at which to record revenues, which is referred to as a performance obligation. Revenue on cost-plus-fee contracts is recognized to the extent of allowable costs incurred plus an estimatewhen control of the applicable fees earned. We consider fixed fees under cost-plus-fee contractspromised products or services is transferred to customers, at an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be earnedentitled in proportion to the allowable costs incurred in performanceexchange for those products or services. The new standard requires disclosure of the contract.nature, amount, timing, and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows arising from contracts with customers. We recognizeadopted the relevant portionrequirements of ASC 606, utilizing the modified retrospective method as discussed in Note 1 of the expected feeNotes to be awarded byConsolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report.

The reported results for 2018 and 2019 reflect the customer atapplication of ASC 606 guidance while the time such fee can be reasonably estimated, based on factors such as ourreported results for periods prior award experience and communications withto January 1, 2018 were prepared under the customer regarding performance, including any interim performance evaluations rendered by the customer. Revenue on time-and-materials contracts is recognized to the extentguidance of billable rates times hours deliveredASC 605. The adoption of ASC 606 represents a change in accounting principle.

To determine revenue recognition for services provided, to the extent of material cost for products delivered to customers, and to the extent of expenses incurred on behalf of the customers.

We have three primary basic categories of fixed-price contracts: fixed unit price, fixed-price level of effort, and fixed-price completion. Revenue recognition methods on fixed-price contracts will vary depending on the nature of the work and the contract terms. Revenues on fixed-price service contracts are recorded as work is performed in accordance with Topic 605. Topic 605 generally requires revenue to be deferred until all of the following have occurred: (1) there is a contract in place, (2) delivery has occurred or services have been provided, (3) the price is fixed or determinable, and (4) collectability is reasonably assured. Revenues on fixed-price contractsarrangements that require delivery of specific items may be recorded based on a price per unit basis as units are delivered. Revenue for fixed-price contracts in which we are paid a specific amount to provide services for a stated period of time is recognized ratably over the service period.

A portion of our fixed-price completion contractsdetermine are within the scope of Topic 605.ASC 606, we perform the following five steps: (i) identify the contract(s) with a customer; (ii) identify the performance obligation(s) in the contract; (iii) determine the transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligation(s) in the contract; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the entity satisfies a performance obligation. Once the contract is identified and determined to be within the scope of ASC 606, we assess the goods or services promised within each contract and determine those that are performance obligations, and assess whether each promised good or service is distinct. We then recognize as revenue the amount of the transaction price that is allocated to the respective performance obligation when (or as) the performance obligation is satisfied.

A performance obligation is a promise in a contract to transfer a distinct good or service to the customer and is the unit of account under ASC 606. The majority of our contracts have a single performance obligation as the promise to transfer the individual goods or services is not separately identifiable from other promises in the contracts and, therefore, not distinct. For these contracts revenuewith multiple performance obligations, we allocate the contract’s transaction price to each performance obligation using the best estimate of the standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the contract. The primary method used to estimate standalone selling price is the expected-cost-plus-margin approach, under which we forecast the expected costs of satisfying a performance obligation and then add an appropriate margin for that distinct good or service.

Prior to the adoption of ASC 606, we recognized the majority of our revenues using the percentage-of-completion method basedof accounting. Based on the ratio of total costs incurred to date compared to estimated total costs to complete the contract. Estimates of costs to complete include material, direct labor, overhead, and allowable indirect expenses for our government contracts. These cost estimates are reviewed and, if necessary, revised monthly on a contract-by-contract basis. If, as a result of this review, we determine that a loss on a contract is probable, then the full amount of estimated loss is charged to operations in the period it is determined that it is probable a loss will be realized from the full performance of the contract.

In accounting for our long-term contracts for productionnature of products provided toor services performed, revenue was recorded as costs were incurred (the “percentage-of-completion cost-to-cost method”) or as units were delivered (the “percentage-of-completion units-of-delivery method”). For the U.S. Government,majority of contracts, we utilize both cost-to-cost and units delivered measuressatisfy the underlying performance obligations over time as the customer obtains control or receives benefits as work is performed on the contract. As a result, under ASC 606 revenue is recognized over a period of time utilizing the percentage-of-completion methodcost-to-cost method. This change generally results in an acceleration of accounting under the provisions of Topic 605. Under the units delivered measure of the percentage-of-completion method of accounting, sales are recognized as the units are accepted by the customer generally using sales valuesrevenue for units in accordance with the contract terms. We estimate profit as the difference between total estimated revenue and total estimated cost of a contract and recognizecontracts that profit over the life of the contract based on units delivered or as computed on the basis of the estimated final average unit costs plus profit. We classify contract revenues as product sales or service revenues depending upon the predominant attributes of the relevant underlying contracts. Significant management judgments and estimates, including but not limited to the estimated costs to complete projects, must be made and used in connection with the revenue recognized in any accounting period. A cancellation, schedule delay, or modification of a fixed-price contract that iswere historically accounted for using the percentage-of-completion units-of-delivery method may adversely affect our gross margins foras revenues are now recognized earlier in the performance period in which the contract is modified or canceled. Under certain circumstances, aas costs are incurred.


51

Table of Contents

cancellation or negative modification could result in us having to reverse revenue that we recognized in a prior period, thus significantly reducing the amount of revenues we recognize for the period in which the adjustment is made. Correspondingly, a positive modification may positively affect our gross margins. In addition, a schedule delay or modification can result in an increase in estimated cost to complete the project, which would also result in an impact to our gross margin. Material differences may result in the amount and timing of our revenue for any period if management made different judgments or utilized different estimates.

It is our policy to review any arrangement containing software or software deliverables and services against the criteria contained in FASB ASC Topic 985, Software (“Topic 985”) and related technical practice aids. Under the provisions of Topic 985, we review the contract value of software deliverables and services and determine allocations of the contract value based on Vendor Specific Objective Evidence (“VSOE”). All software arrangements requiring significant production, modification, or customization of the software are accounted for in conformity with Topic 605.

Our contracts may include the provision of more than one of our services (“multiple element arrangements”). In these situations, we apply the guidance of Topic 605. Accordingly, for applicable arrangements, revenue recognition includes the proper identification of separate units of accounting and the allocation of revenue across all elements based on relative fair values, with proper consideration given to the guidance provided by other authoritative literature.

For multiple element arrangements that include hardware products containing software essential to the hardware products’ functionality and undelivered non-software services, we allocate revenue to all deliverables based on their relative selling prices. In such circumstances, we use a hierarchy to determine the selling price to be used for allocating revenue to deliverables: (i) VSOE, (ii) third-party evidence of selling price (“TPE”), and (iii) best estimate of the selling price (“ESP”).

VSOE generally exists only when we sell the deliverable separately and is the price actually charged by us for that deliverable. TPE is determined based on competitor prices for similar deliverables when sold separately. Generally, our offerings contain significant differentiation such that comparable pricing of products with similar functionality cannot be obtained. Furthermore, we are unable to reliably determine what similar competitor products’ selling prices are on a stand-alone basis. Therefore, we typically are not able to obtain TPE of selling price. ESP reflects our best estimates of what the selling prices of elements would be if they were sold regularly on a stand-alone basis. We determine ESP for a product or service by considering multiple factors including, but not limited to major product groupings, geographies, market conditions, competitive landscape, internal costs, gross margin objectives and pricing practices. The determination of ESP is made through consultation with our management, taking into consideration our marketing strategy.

We account for multiple element arrangements that consist only of software or software-related products, including the sale of upgrades to previously sold software, in accordance with industry specific software accounting guidance. For such transactions, revenue on arrangements that include multiple elements is allocated to each element based on the relative fair value of each element, and fair value is determined by VSOE. If we cannot objectively determine the fair value of any undelivered element included in such multiple element arrangements, we defer revenue until all elements are delivered and services have been performed, or until fair value can objectively be determined for any remaining undelivered elements. Under certain of our contractual arrangements, we may also recognize revenue for out-of-pocket expenses in accordance with Topic 605. Depending on the contractual arrangement, these expenses may be reimbursed with or without a fee.

Under certain of our contracts, we provide supplier procurement services and materials for our customers. We record revenue on these arrangements on a gross or net basis in accordance with Topic 605. Depending on the specific circumstances of the arrangement we consider the following criteria, among others, for recording revenue on a gross or net basis:

(1)whether we act as a principal in the transaction;

(2)whether we take title to the products;

(3)whether we assume risks and rewards of ownership, such as risk of loss for collection, delivery or returns;

(4)whether we serve as an agent or broker, with compensation on a commission or fee basis; and

(5)whether we assume the credit risk for the amount billed to the customer subsequent to delivery.

52

Table of Contents



For our federal contracts, we followapply U.S. Government procurement and accounting standards in assessing the allowability and the allocability of costs to contracts. Due to the significance of the judgments and estimation processes, it is likely that materially different amounts could be recorded if we used different assumptions or if the underlying circumstances were to change. We closely monitor compliance with, and the consistent application of, our critical accounting policies related to contract accounting. Business operations personnel conduct periodic contract status and performance reviews. When adjustments in estimated contract revenues or costs are required, any significant changes from prior estimates are included in earnings in the current period. Also, regular and recurring evaluations of contract cost, scheduling and technical matters are performed by management personnel who are independent from the business operations personnel performing work under the contract. Costs incurred and allocated to contracts with the U.S. Government are scrutinized for compliance with regulatory standards by our personnel, and are subject to audit by the DCAA.


From time to time, we may proceed with work based on customer direction prior to the completion and signing of formal contract documents. We have a formal review process for approving any such work. Revenue associated with such work is recognized only when it can be reliably estimated and realization is probable. We base our estimates on previous experiences with the customer, communications with the customer regarding funding status, and our knowledge of available funding for the contract or program.

Allowance for doubtful accounts. We maintain an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses resulting from the potential inability of certain customers to make required future payments on amounts due to us. Management determines the adequacy of this allowance by periodically evaluating the aging and past due nature of individual customer accounts receivable balances and considering the customer’s current financial situation as well as the existing industry economic conditions and other relevant factors that would be useful towards assessing the risk of collectability. If the future financial condition of our customers were to deteriorate, resulting in their inability to make specific required payments, additions to the allowance for doubtful accounts may be required. In addition, if the financial condition of our customers improves and collections of amounts outstanding commence or are reasonably assured, then we may reverse previously established allowances for doubtful accounts. Changes to estimates of contract value are recorded as adjustments to revenue and not as a component of the allowance for doubtful accounts. We write off accounts receivable when they become uncollectible and payments subsequently received on such receivables are credited to the allowance for doubtful accounts.

Long-lived and Intangible Assets. We account for long-lived assets in accordance with the provisions of FASB ASC Topic 360 Property, Plant, and Equipment (“Topic 360). Topic 360 addresses financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets and requires that long-lived assets be reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability is measured by comparing the carrying amount of an asset to the expected future net cash flows generated by the asset. If it is determined that the asset may not be recoverable and if the carrying amount of an asset exceeds its estimated fair value, an impairment charge is recognized to the extent of the difference. Topic 360 requires companies to separately report discontinued operations, including components of an entity that either have been disposed of (by sale, abandonment or in a distribution to owners) or classified as held for sale. Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.


In accordance with Topic 360,, we assess the impairment of identifiable intangibles and long-lived assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Factors we consider important which could individually or in combination trigger an impairment review, include the following:


significant underperformance relative to expected historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of our use of the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business;
significant negative industry or economic trends;
significant decline in our stock price for a sustained period; and
our market capitalization relative to net book value.


If we determined that the carrying value of intangibles and long-lived assets may not be recoverable based upon the existence of one or more of the above indicators of impairment, we would record an impairment equal to the excess of the carrying amount of the asset over its estimated fair value.


Goodwill and Purchased Intangibles.Goodwill. The purchase price of an acquired business is allocated to the underlying tangible and intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based upon their respective fair values, with the excess recorded as goodwill. Such fair value assessments require judgments and estimates that can be affected by contract performance and other factors over time, which may cause final amounts to differ materially from original estimates.

53

Table of Contents



We have established certain accruals in connection with indemnities and other contingencies from our acquisitions. These accruals and subsequent adjustments have been recorded during the purchase price allocation period for acquisitions. The accruals were determined based upon the terms of the purchase or sales agreements and, in most cases, involve a significant degree of judgment. Management has recorded these accruals in accordance with its interpretation of the terms of the purchase or sale agreements, known facts, and an estimation of probable future events based on management’s experience. Any changes to recorded estimates will be recognized through earnings.


We perform our impairment test for goodwill in accordance with ASC Topic 350, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other (“(Topic 350”). We assess goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level, which is defined as an operating segment or one level below an operating segment, referred to as a component. We determine our reporting units by first identifying our operating segments, and then assessing whether any components of these segments constitute a business for which discrete financial information is available and where segment management regularly reviews the operating results of that component. We aggregate components within an operating segment that have similar economic characteristics.


KGS has fourfive operating segments: Defense Rocket Support Services (“DRSS”), Microwave Electronics Division (“ME”), TechnicalSpace, Training and TrainingCybersecurity Solutions (“TTS”ST&C”), and Modular Systems (“MS”), and Kratos Turbine Technologies (“KTT”), that provide technology based defense solutions, involving products and services, primarily for mission critical U.S. National Securitynational security priorities, with the primary focus relating to the nation’s Command, Control, Communications, Computing, Combat


Systems, Intelligence, Surveillance (“C5ISR”) and Reconnaissance requirements. The PSS operating segment provides integrated solutions for advanced homeland security, public safety, critical infrastructure security, and security and surveillance systems for government, industrial and commercial customers. The US reportable segment provides unmanned aerial systems, unmanned ground, and unmanned seaborne systems. We have identified our reporting units to be the DRSS, ME, TTS,ST&C, MS, and MSKTT operating segments, within itsthe KGS reportable segment, and the US reportable segment, each of which has been assessed and the PSS business to be testedevaluated for potential impairment in itsour fiscal year 20172019 annual test.
We alsotest goodwill for impairment by performing a qualitative assessment or using a two-step impairment process. If we choose to perform impairment tests for goodwill whenever evidence of potential impairment exists. Whena qualitative assessment and determine it is more likely than not that an impairment may exist, the two-step impairment process is then performed. For operations where the two-step process is used, the identification and measurement of impairment involves the estimation of the fair value of reporting units. If the fair value is determined thatto be less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to determine the amount of the impairment. When any impairment has occurred, a charge to operations is recorded. In order to test for potential impairment, we estimate the fair value of each of ourthe impacted reporting units based on a comparison and weighting of the income approach, specifically the discounted cash flow (“DCF”) method and the market approach, which estimates the fair value of our reporting units based upon comparable market prices and recent transactions and also validates the reasonableness of the implied multiples from the income approach. We reconcile the fair value of our reporting units to our market capitalization on the last business day of fiscal October and assume a control premium.


In testing for impairment of our goodwill using a two-step impairment process at a particular reporting unit, we make assumptions about the amount and timing of future expected cash flows, terminal growth rates, appropriate discount rates, market multiples, and the control premium a controlling shareholder could be expected to pay:


The timing of future cash flows within our DCF analysis is based on our most recent forecasts and other estimates. Our historical growth rates and operating results are not indicative of our projected growth rates and operating results as a consequence of our acquisitions and divestitures.
The terminal growth rate is used to calculate the value of cash flows beyond the last projected period in our DCF analysis and reflects our best estimates for stable, perpetual growth of our reporting units.
We use estimates of market participant weighted average cost of capital (“WACC”) as a basis for determining the discount rates to apply to our reporting units’ future expected cash flows. The significant assumptions within our WACC are: (a) equity risk premium, (b) beta, (c) size premium adjustments, (d) cost of debt and (e) capital structure assumptions. In addition, we use a company specific risk adjustment which is a subjective adjustment that, by its very nature does not include market related data, but instead examines the prospects of the reporting unit relative to the broader industry to determine if there are specific factors, which may make it more “risky” relative to the industry.
Recent historical market multiples are used to estimate future market pricing.
We use an estimated control premium in reconciling the aggregate value of our reporting units to our market capitalization. As discussed in Topic 350, control premiums may effectively cause a company’s aggregate fair value of its reporting unit(s) to exceed its current market capitalization due to the ability of a controlling shareholder to benefit from synergies and other intangible assets that arise from such control. As a result, the measurement of fair value of an entity with a collection of assets and liabilities that operate together to produce cash flows is different from the fair value measurement of that entity’s individual securities, hence, the reason a control premium is paid.


54

Table of Contents

We review intangible assets subject to amortization for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the asset may not be recoverable. Impairment losses, where identified, are determined as the excess of the carrying value over the estimated fair value of the long-lived asset. We assess the recoverability of the carrying value of assets held for use based on a review of projected undiscounted cash flows.


During the fourth quarter of 2017, as a result of our annual impairment test of the carrying value of itsour goodwill balances, we recorded a non-cash impairment charge of $24.2 million ofagainst the carrying value of the goodwill of our DRSS reporting unit within the KGS segment, which the majority of this business and revenues includes our legacy government services business. In 2010, we changed our strategy to focus on being a systems, product, technology and intellectual property based company and deemphasized the legacy government services businesses. Over the past several years, similar to other businesses operating in the federal government technical services space, this business has been adversely impacted by competitive pressures and commoditization resulting from lower priced technically acceptableLPTA awards rather than awards based on best value or that are technologically or performance differentiated. Specifically, we were recently notified of losses onlost two new sizable five yearfive-year contract opportunities where Kratos was underbid on cost, which significantly impacted the expected future financial performance of this business.


The carrying value of goodwill of the PSS, US and KGS reportable segments, after the impact of the impairment recorded during the fourth quarter of 2017, are $35.6 million,was $97.3 million and $328.3$358.3 million, respectively, at December 31, 2017.29, 2019.


In determining the fair value of our reporting units, there are key assumptions related to our future operating performance and revenue growth. If the actual operating performance and financial results are not consistent with our assumptions, a further impairment in our $461.2$455.6 million goodwill and $22.0$39.5 million long-lived intangibles could occur in future periods. In particular, the US reporting unit fair value includes assumptions that the development of the high performance UCAS product is successful and we are awarded future contracts for the UCAS product and other new tactical unmanned aircraft systems. Additionally, the US reporting unit fair value assumes that the U.S. Navy will exercise options under the existing current contract and we will commencecontinue low rate initial production and commence full rate production for the Sub-Sonic Aerial Target. For certain of our reporting units, the fair valueOur goodwill impairment assessment includes assumptions of the entry to new international markets for which we have not yet penetrated. Additional risks for goodwill across all reporting units include, but are not limited to, the risks discussed in Item 1A “Risk Factors” contained within this Annual Report and:


a decline in our stock price and resulting market capitalization, if we determine the decline is sustained and is indicative of a reduction in the fair value below the carrying value of our reporting units;


a decrease in available government funding, including budgetary constraints affecting U.S. Government spending generally, or specific departments or agencies;
changes in U.S. Government programs or requirements, including the increased use of small business providers;
our failure to reach our internal forecasts could impact our ability to achieve our forecasted levels of cash flows and reduce the estimated discounted value of our reporting units;
volatility in equity and debt markets resulting in higher discount rates; and
market and political factors that could impact the success of new products, especially related to new unmanned systems platforms.


It is not possible at this time to determine if an impairment charge would result from these factors, or, if it does, whether such charge would be material. We will continue to monitor our goodwill for potential impairment indicators.

Accounting for income taxes and tax contingencies. FASB ASC Topic 740 Income Taxes (“Topic 740”) provides the accounting treatment for uncertainty in income taxes recognized in an enterprise’s financial statements. Topic 740 prescribes a recognition threshold and measurement attribute for the financial statement recognition and measurement of a tax position taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. Topic 740 also provides guidance on derecognizing, classification, interest and penalties, accounting in interim periods, disclosure and transition.


As part of the process of preparing our Consolidated Financial Statements, we are required to estimate our provision for income taxes in each of the tax jurisdictions in which we conduct business. This process involves estimating our actual current tax expense in conjunction with the evaluation and measurement of temporary differences resulting from differing treatment of certain items for tax and accounting purposes. These temporary differences result in the establishment of deferred tax assets and liabilities, which are recorded on a net basis. We then assess on a periodic basis the probability that our net deferred tax assets will be recovered and therefore realized from future taxable income and to the extent we believe that recovery is not more likely than not, a valuation allowance is established to address such risk resulting in an additional related provision for income taxes during the period.


55

Table of Contents


Significant management judgment is required in determining our provision for income taxes, our deferred tax assets and liabilities, tax contingencies, unrecognized tax benefits, and any required valuation allowance, including taking into consideration the probability of the tax contingencies being incurred. Management assesses this probability based upon information provided to us by our tax advisers, our legal advisers and similar tax cases. If at a later time our assessment of the probability of these tax contingencies changes, our accrual for such tax uncertainties may increase or decrease.


We have a valuation allowance at December 31, 201729, 2019 due to management’s overall assessment of risks and uncertainties related to our future ability to realize and, hence, utilize certain deferred tax assets, primarily consisting of net operating losses, carry forward temporary differences and future tax deductions resulting from certain types of stock option exercises, before they expire.


The 20172019 effective tax rate at December 31, 201729, 2019 for annual and interim reporting periods could be impacted if uncertain tax positions that are not recognized at December 31, 201729, 2019 are settled at an amount which differs from our estimate. Finally, during 20172019 and thereafter, if we are impacted by a change in the valuation allowance as of December 31, 201729, 2019 resulting from a change in judgment regarding the realizability of deferred tax assets beyond December 31, 201729, 2019, such effect will be recognized in the interim period in which the change occurs.


Contingencies and litigation. We are currently involved in certain legal proceedings. We estimate a range of liability related to pending litigation where the amount and range of loss can be estimated. We record our estimate of a loss when the loss is considered probable and reasonably estimable. Where a liability is probable and there is a range of estimated loss and no amount in the range is more likely than any other number in the range, we record the minimum estimated liability related to the claim in accordance with FASB ASCTopic 450, Contingencies.Contingencies. As additional information becomes available, we assess the potential liability related to our pending litigation and revise our estimates. Revisions in our estimates of potential liability could materially impact our results of operations. See Item 3 “Legal Proceedings”Note 15 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report for additional information.

Stock-based Compensation. We account for stock-based compensation arrangements in accordance with the provisions of FASB ASC Topic 718, Compensation-Stock Compensation (“Topic 718”), which requires the measurement and recognition of compensation expense for all stock-based payment awards to employees and directors based on estimated fair values.

The valuation provisions of Topic 718 apply to new awards and to awards that are outstanding on the effective date and subsequently modified or canceled. We use the Black-Scholes option pricing model and a lattice options pricing model for market condition options to estimate the fair valuefurther discussion of our stock options at the grant date. The Black-Scholes option pricing model was developed for use in estimating the fair value of traded options which have no vesting restrictions and are fully transferable. The lattice options pricing model breaks down the time to expiration into potentially a very large number of time intervals, or steps, which makes it possible to check at every point in an option’s life for the possibility of early exercise. Our employee stock options are generally subject to vesting restrictions and are generally not transferable.legal proceedings.


Valuing options requires highly subjective assumptions including the expected stock price volatility over the term of the award, the expected life of an option and the number of awards ultimately expected to vest. Changes in these assumptions can materially affect the fair value estimates of an option. Furthermore, the estimated fair value of an option does not necessarily represent the value that will ultimately be realized by an employee. We used historical data to estimate the expected forfeiture rate, intrinsic and historical data to estimate the expected price volatility, and a weighted-average expected life formula to estimate the expected option life. The risk-free rate is based on the U.S. Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of grant for the estimated life of the option.

Estimates of stock-based compensation expenses are significant to our Consolidated Financial Statements, but these expenses are based on option valuation models and will never result in the payment of cash by us. For this reason, and because we do not view stock-based compensation to be significant as related to our operational performance, we exclude estimated stock-based compensation expense when evaluating the business performance of our operating segments.

Recent Accounting Pronouncements
 
See Note 1 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements contained within this Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of recent accounting pronouncements.



56

Table of Contents


Item 7A.  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.
 
 Interest Rate and Foreign Currency Risks


We are exposed to market risk, primarily related to interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates.


Exposure to market risk for changes in interest rates relates to our outstanding debt. We are exposed to interest rate risk, primarily through our borrowing activities under the Credit Agreement discussed underLiquidity and Capital Resources” above. Based on our current outstanding balances, a 1% change in the LIBOR rate would not materially impact our financial position. We manage exposure to these risks through our operating and financing activities and, when deemed appropriate, through the use of derivative financial instruments. Derivative financial instruments are viewed as risk management tools and are not used for speculation or for trading purposes. Derivative financial instruments were contracted with investment grade counterparties to reduce exposure to interest rate risk on our prior credit facilities. We had no outstanding derivative financial instruments as of December 29, 2019.


Exposure to market risk for foreign currency exchange rate risk is related to receipts from customers, payments to suppliers and intercompany loans denominated in foreign currencies. Accordingly, a strengthening of the U.S. dollar (“USD”) or a strengthening of certain foreign currencies, such as the Israeli Shekel, will negatively impact revenues and gross margins expressed in consolidated USD terms. We currently enter into limited foreign currency forward contracts to manage foreign currency exchange rate risk because exchange rate fluctuations have had, and we expect will have, minimal impact on our operating results and cash flows.


Our cash and cash equivalents as of December 31, 201729, 2019 were $129.6172.6 million and are primarily invested in money market interest bearing accounts. A hypothetical 10% adverse change in the average interest rate on our money market cash investments and short-term investments would have had no material effect on our net lossincome for the year ended December 31, 201729, 2019.


Commodity Price Risk Management


We purchase commodities for use in our manufacturing processes. We typically purchase these commodities at market prices, and as a result are affected by market price fluctuations. We have decided not to hedge these exposures as they are deemed immaterial.
 
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.


Our Consolidated Financial Statements and supplementary data required by this item are set forth at the pages indicated in Item 15(a) (1) and 15(a) (2), respectively.


Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure.
None.


Item 9A.  Controls and Procedures.
 
Disclosure Controls and Procedures


We maintain disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) promulgated under the Exchange Act, designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in our reports filed under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Principal Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. In designing and evaluating the disclosure controls and procedures, management recognized that any controls and procedures, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving the desired control objectives, and management necessarily was required to apply its judgment in evaluating the cost benefit relationship of possible controls and procedures.


As required by Rule 13a-15(b) and 15d-15(b) promulgated under the Exchange Act, we carried out an evaluation, under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Principal Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures as of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report. Based on the foregoing, our Principal Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer

57

Table of Contents


concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective at the reasonable assurance level as of December 31, 201729, 2019.


Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting


Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as such term is defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f), designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that internal controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or because the degree of compliance with the policies and procedures may deteriorate.


Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Principal Executive Officer and Principal Financial Officer, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based on the framework in the 2013 Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. BasedManagement's assessment of and conclusion on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 29, 2019 did not include the internal controls of FTT, more fully described in Part 1 of this Form 10-K, of which 80.1% of the ownership was acquired by the Company on February 27, 2019. The total assets of FTT, which is now the KTT Division, in aggregate, are approximately 4.2% of the total assets of the Company, and the revenues of FTT comprise approximately 7.3% of the revenues of the Company, as such amounts for the Company are reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements as of and for the fiscal year ended December 29, 2019 included in this Form 10-K. Management will perform an assessment of the effectiveness of FTT’s internal control over financial reporting within one year of the date of acquisition. Aside from this exclusion and based on the results of our evaluation, our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective at the reasonable assurance level as of December 31, 201729, 2019.


Our internal control over financial reporting has been audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing below, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 201729, 2019.


Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting


There were no changes in our internal control over financial accounting and reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) of the Exchange Act) during the fourth quarter of the fiscal year ended December 31, 201729, 2019 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.


Item 9B. Other Information.
None.

PART III


Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance.
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement filed in connection with our 20182020 Annual Meeting of Stockholders or an amendment to this Annual Report to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after the close of our fiscal year ended December 31, 201729, 2019.


Item 11. Executive Compensation.
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement filed in connection with our 20182020 Annual Meeting of Stockholders or an amendment to this Annual Report to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after the close of our fiscal year ended December 31, 201729, 2019.




Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters.
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement filed in connection with our 20182020 Annual Meeting of Stockholders or an amendment to this Annual Report to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after the close of our fiscal year ended December 31, 201729, 2019.



58

Table of Contents

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence.
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement filed in connection with our 20182020 Annual Meeting of Stockholders or an amendment to this Annual Report to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after the close of our fiscal year ended December 31, 2017.29, 2019.


Item 14. Principal AccountantAccounting Fees and Services.
The information required by this item is incorporated by reference to our definitive proxy statement filed in connection with our 20182020 Annual Meeting of Stockholders or an amendment to this Annual Report to be filed with the SEC within 120 days after the close of our fiscal year ended December 31, 201729, 2019.



PART IV


Item 15. Exhibits, and Financial StatementsStatement Schedules.


(a)(1)Financial Statements
The Consolidated Financial Statements of Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. and Report of Deloitte & Touche LLP, Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, are included in a separate section of this Annual Report beginning on page F-1.


(a)(2)Financial Statement Schedules
All schedules have been omitted because they are not applicable or are not required or the information required to be set forth therein is included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or the notes thereto.




(a) (3)  Exhibits
 
Incorporated by
Reference
  
Incorporated by
Reference
 
Exhibit
Number
 Exhibit Description Form Filing Date (File No.) Exhibit 
Filed-
Furnished
Herewith
 Exhibit Description Form Filing Date (File No.) Exhibit 
Filed-
Furnished
Herewith
2.1+*  10-Q 
08/06/2015
(001-34460)
 2.4   10-Q 
08/06/2015
(001-34460)
 2.4 
2.2+  10-Q 
5/10/2018
(001-34460)
 2.2 
2.3+**  10-Q 
5/08/2019
(001-34460)
 2.3 
3.1  10-K 
2/27/2017
(001-34460)
 3.1   10-K 
2/27/2017
(001-34460)
 3.1 
3.2  10-K 
2/27/2017
(001-34460)
 3.2   10-K 
2/27/2017
(001-34460)
 3.2 
4.1  10-K 
2/27/2017
(001-34460)
 4.1   10-K 
2/27/2017
(001-34460)
 4.1 
4.2  8-K 
05/15/2014
(001-34460)
 4.1   8-K 
11/21/2017
(001-34460)
 4.1 
4.3  10-K 
02/28/2018
(001-34460)
 4.5 
4.4 

 *
10.1#  10-Q 
08/04/2011
(001-34460)
 10.8 
10.2#  S-8 
07/31/2017
(001-34460)
 99.1 
10.3#  10-Q 
11/14/2000
(000-27231)
 10.2 
10.4#  10-Q 
11/14/2000
(000-27231)
 10.3 
10.5#  S-8 
08/01/2005
(333-127060)
 99.2 
10.6#  S-8 
08/01/2005
(333-127060)
 99.1 

59

Table of Contents


4.3  8-K 
05/15/2014
(001-34460)
 10.1 
4.4  8-K 
11/21/2017
(001-34460)
 4.1 
4.5  *
10.1#  10-Q 
08/04/2011
(001-34460)
 10.8 
10.2#  S-8 
07/31/2017
(001-34460)
 99.1 
10.3#  10-Q 
11/14/2000
(000-27231)
 10.2 
10.4#  10-Q 
11/14/2000
(000-27231)
 10.3 
10.5#  S-8 
08/01/2005
(333-127060)
 99.2 
10.6#  S-8 
08/01/2005
(333-127060)
 99.1 
10.7#  8-K 
01/17/2007
(000-27231)
 99.3   8-K 
01/17/2007
(000-27231)
 99.3 
10.8#  S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.11   S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.11 
10.9#  S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.13   S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.13 
10.10#  S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.14   S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.14 
10.11#  S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.15   S-8 
04/08/2011
(333-173383)
 4.15 
10.12#  DEF 14A 
04/15/2011
(001-34460)
 n/a   DEF 14A 
04/15/2011
(001-34460)
 n/a 
10.13#  8-K 
11/18/2011
(001-34460)
 10.2   8-K 
11/18/2011
(001-34460)
 10.2 
10.14#  S-8 
07/31/2017
(001-34460)
 99.2   S-8 
07/31/2017
(001-34460)
 99.2 
10.15#  10-Q 
11/07/2014
(001-34460)
 10.1   *
10.16#  10-Q 
08/04/2011
(001-34460)
 10.3   10-Q 
08/04/2011
(001-34460)
 10.3 
10.17#  10-Q 
08/04/2011
(001-34460)
 10.4 
10.18  10-K 
03/11/2010
(001-34460)
 10.26 
10.19#  S-8 
03/08/2012
(333-179977)
 4.10 
10.20#  S-8 
03/08/2012
(333-179977)
 4.11 
10.21#  S-8 
07/27/2012
(333-182910)
 4.12 
10.22#  8-K 
03/12/2015
(001-34460)
 10.1 

60

Table of Contents


10.17#  10-Q 
08/04/2011
(001-34460)
 10.4  
10.18  10-K 
03/11/2010
(001-34460)
 10.26  
10.19#  S-8 
03/08/2012
(333-179977)
 4.10  
10.20#  S-8 
03/08/2012
(333-179977)
 4.11  
10.21  8-K 
05/15/2012
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.22#  S-8 
07/27/2012
(333-182910)
 4.12  
10.23#  8-K 
03/12/2015
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.24#  8-K 
06/02/2015
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.25#  8-K 
08/09/2016
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.26#  8-K 
12/08/2016
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.27  8-K 
05/15/2014
(001-34460)
 10.2  
10.28  10-Q 
08/06/2015
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.23#  8-K 
06/02/2015
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.24#  8-K 
12/08/2016
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.25  8-K 
11/21/2017
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.26  8-K 
06/13/2018
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.27  10-Q 
05/04/2017
(001-34460)
 10.2  
10.28  10-K 
02/28/2019
(001-34460)
 10.34  
10.29  10-Q 
05/08/2019
(001-34460)
 10.2  
10.30# 

 10-Q 
07/31/2019
(001-34460)
 10.1  
21.1        *
23.1        *
31.1        *
31.2        *
32.1        *
32.2        *

61

Table of Contents


10.29  8-K 
08/24/2015
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.30  8-K 
11/21/2017
(001-34460)
 10.1  
10.31  10-Q 
5/04/2017
(001-34460)
 10.2  
10.32  10-Q 
07/27/2017
(001-34460)
 10.2  
10.33  10-Q 
07/27/2017
(001-34460)
 10.3  
10.34        *
21.1        *
23.1        *
31.1        *
31.2        *
32.1        *
32.2        *
101 Financial statements from the Annual Report on Form 10-K of Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. for the year ended December 31, 2017, formatted in XBRL: (i) the Consolidated Balance Sheets, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Loss, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, (iv) the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.       *
101Financial statements from the Annual Report on Form 10-K of Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. for the year ended December 29, 2019, formatted in XBRL: (i) the Consolidated Balance Sheets, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Operations, (iii) the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Loss, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows, (v) the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.*
104Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101)*


 
+    Certain schedules and exhibits referenced in this document have been omitted in accordance with Item 601(b)(2) of Regulation S-K. A copy of any omitted schedule and/or exhibit will be furnished supplementally to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request.

62

Table of Contents



*    Certain portions have been omitted pursuant to a confidential treatment request. Omitted information has been filed separately with the SEC.


**    Certain confidential information contained in this Exhibit has been omitted because it is both (i) not material and (ii)
would be competitively harmful if publicly disclosed.

#    Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.


(b) Exhibits
See Item 15(a)(3) above.


(c) Financial Statement Schedules
See Item 15(a)(2) above.


Item 16. Form 10-K Summary.
None.




SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
Date: February 28, 201824, 2020
 Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc.
  
 By:/s/ Eric M. DeMarco
 By:
Eric M. DeMarco
President and Chief Executive Officer (Principal
Executive Officer)
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated:


63

Table of Contents


SignatureTitleDate
   
/s/ Eric M. DeMarco
Eric M. DeMarco
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)February 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Deanna H. Lund
Deanna H. Lund
Executive Vice President, Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)February 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Maria Cervantes de Burgreen
Maria Cervantes de Burgreen
Vice President and Corporate Controller
(Principal Accounting Officer)
February 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Scott Anderson
Scott Anderson
DirectorFebruary 28, 2018
/s/ Bandel Carano
Bandel Carano
DirectorFebruary 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ William Hoglund
William Hoglund
DirectorFebruary 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Scot Jarvis
Scot Jarvis
DirectorFebruary 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Jane E. Judd
Jane E. Judd
DirectorFebruary 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Sam Liberatore
Sam Liberatore
DirectorFebruary 28, 201824, 2020
   
/s/ Amy Zegart
Amy Zegart
DirectorFebruary 28, 201824, 2020
 



64

Table of Contents




INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.


 
 
 
 
 



F-1

Table of Contents


REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the stockholders and the Board of Directors of Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc.
Opinions on the Consolidated Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”"Company") as of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss), stockholders’ equity, and cash flows, for each of the three fiscal years in the period ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “financial statements”"financial statements"). We also have audited the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three fiscal years in the period ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also, in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO.
As described in Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting, management excluded from its assessment the internal control over financial reporting at the KTT Division, which was acquired on February 27, 2019, and whose financial statements constitute approximately 4.2% of total assets, and approximately 7.3% of revenues of the consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 29, 2019. Accordingly, our audit did not include the internal control over financial reporting at the KTT Division.
Adoption of New Accounting PronouncementPronouncements
As discussed in Note 21 to the financial statements, the Company adopted ASU 2016-02, Leases, and has changed its method of accounting for leases using the impairment of goodwill and intangible assets prospectivelyoptional transition method beginning December 26, 2016,31, 2018, relating to the manner in which it recognizes assets and liabilities for the rights and obligations underlying leases.
As discussed in Note 1 to the financial statements, the Company previously adopted ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, and changed its method of accounting for revenue using the adoption of Accounting Standards Update No. 2017-04, Intangibles - Goodwill and Other (Topic 350): Simplifyingmodified retrospective transition approach beginning January 1, 2018, relating to the Testmanner in which it accounts for Goodwill Impairment.revenues from contracts with customers.
Basis for Opinions
The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.
Our audits of the financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures to respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

F-2

Table of Contents


Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

Critical Audit Matter
The critical audit matter communicated below is a matter arising from the current-period audit of the financial statements that was communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (1) relates to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matter below, providing a separate opinion on the critical audit matter or on the accounts or disclosures to which it relates.
Cost Estimates for Fixed-Price Contracts - Refer to Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements
Critical Audit Matter Description
The Company recognizes revenue over time using the cost-to-cost method (cost incurred relative to total estimated cost at completion) for most of its fixed-price contracts. Management must make various assumptions and estimates regarding technical, schedule and cost aspects of these contracts to develop estimates of cost at completion. A significant change in cost estimates could affect the overall profitability and timing of revenue recognition related to one or more of its fixed price contracts.

Given the complexity of certain of the Company’s fixed-price contracts, the limited amount of historical activity in certain instances, and significant judgment and estimates necessary to estimate future costs and margin at completion, auditing these estimates involved especially subjective judgment.
How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit
Our auditing procedures related to the cost estimates for fixed-price contracts included the following:
We tested the effectiveness of internal controls over the development of cost estimates, including the underlying assumptions and key inputs into the development of the estimated cost at completion.
We selected certain contracts for testing and performed the following procedures:
- Tested management’s identification of distinct performance obligations by evaluating whether the underlying goods and services were highly interdependent and interrelated.
- Evaluated the reasonableness of management’s estimates of cost at completion to actual costs and profits of similar previously completed contracts, when applicable.
- Performed inquiries of the Company’s project managers and others directly involved with the contracts to evaluate project status and project challenges, which may affect total estimated costs to complete.
We performed retrospective reviews on selected contracts, comparing actual performance to estimated performance, when evaluating management’s ability to estimate costs.

/s/ DELOITTE Deloitte & TOUCHETouche LLP


San Diego, CACalifornia
February 28, 201824, 2020


We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2013.



F-3

Table of Contents


KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 201630, 2018
(in millions, except par value and number of shares)
2017 20162019 2018
Assets 
  
 
  
Current assets: 
  
 
  
Cash and cash equivalents$129.6
 $69.1
$172.6
 $182.7
Restricted cash0.4
 0.5

 0.3
Accounts receivable, net268.4
 229.4
85.0
 64.6
Unbilled receivables, net179.4
 172.8
Inventoried costs50.4
 55.4
61.1
 46.8
Income taxes receivable2.4
 4.6
Prepaid expenses12.9
 8.9
9.4
 8.9
Other current assets7.2
 5.2
11.4
 10.3
Current assets of discontinued operations3.3
 8.3
Total current assets471.3

373.1
522.2

494.7
Property, plant and equipment, net61.2
 49.8
116.9
 67.1
Operating lease right-of-use assets42.1
 
Goodwill461.2
 485.4
455.6
 425.7
Intangible assets, net22.0
 32.6
39.5
 16.1
Other assets8.3
 7.7
9.7
 6.5
Total assets$1,024.0

$948.6
$1,186.0

$1,010.1
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity 
  
 
  
Current liabilities: 
  
 
  
Accounts payable$48.8
 $52.7
$53.8
 $46.6
Accrued expenses45.6
 50.0
32.7
 38.1
Accrued compensation34.8
 39.1
37.1
 33.5
Accrued interest1.7
 3.6
1.6
 1.6
Billings in excess of costs and earnings on uncompleted contracts47.2
 41.8
34.3
 34.9
Current portion of operating lease liabilities9.9
 
Other current liabilities8.9
 6.7
10.0
 4.7
Current portion of long-term debt0.8
 1.0
Current liabilities of discontinued operations1.1
 1.6
3.3
 5.3
Total current liabilities188.9

196.5
182.7

164.7
Long-term debt principal, net of current portion293.5
 431.0
Deferred income tax liability7.0
 17.3
Long-term debt295.1
 294.2
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion37.6
 
Other long-term liabilities19.3
 23.7
78.7
 25.5
Long-term liabilities of discontinued operations3.8
 3.7
2.8
 6.4
Total liabilities512.5

672.2
596.9

490.8
Commitments and contingencies

 

Commitments and contingencies (Note 15)


 


Redeemable noncontrolling interest15.0
 
Stockholders’ equity: 
  
 
  
Preferred stock, $0.001 par value, 5,000,000 authorized, 0 shares outstanding at December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016
 
Common stock, $0.001 par value, 195,000,000 shares authorized; 103,297,525 and 73,945,533 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016, respectively
 
Preferred stock, $0.001 par value, 5,000,000 authorized, 0 shares outstanding at December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018
 
Common stock, $0.001 par value, 195,000,000 shares authorized; 106,635,508 and 103,766,899 shares issued and outstanding at December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018, respectively
 
Additional paid-in capital1,233.7
 956.2
1,286.5
 1,244.5
Accumulated other comprehensive loss(1.4) (1.7)(0.4) (0.7)
Accumulated deficit(720.8) (678.1)(712.0) (724.5)
Total stockholders’ equity511.5

276.4
574.1

519.3
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity$1,024.0

$948.6
$1,186.0

$1,010.1


The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.

F-4

Table of Contents


KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
Years ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and December 27, 201531, 2017
(in millions, except per share amounts)
          
2017 2016 20152019 2018 2017
Service revenues$346.4
 $348.1
 $354.2
$272.6
 $200.7
 $197.8
Product sales405.5
 320.6
 302.9
444.9
 417.3
 405.5
Total revenues751.9
 668.7
 657.1
717.5
 618.0
 603.3
Cost of service revenues247.5
 255.8
 266.5
192.0
 137.8
 138.6
Cost of product sales307.1
 259.3
 228.8
335.5
 310.5
 307.1
Total costs554.6
 515.1

495.3
527.5
 448.3

445.7
Gross profit197.3
 153.6

161.8
190.0
 169.7

157.6
Selling, general and administrative expenses160.6
 146.3
 150.7
130.8
 119.8
 127.3
Merger and acquisition related items
 1.9
 0.1
2.3
 
 
Research and development expenses17.8
 13.9
 16.2
18.0
 15.6
 17.8
Impairment of goodwill24.2
 
 

 
 24.2
Unused office space and other restructuring0.5
 10.1
 (0.7)
Operating loss from continuing operations(5.8) (18.6)
(4.5)
Restructuring expenses and other0.9
 3.8
 0.3
Operating income (loss)38.0
 30.5

(12.0)
Other income (expense):          
Interest expense, net(28.6) (34.7) (36.0)(21.6) (20.8) (28.6)
Gain (loss) on extinguishment of debt(17.3) 0.2
 (3.4)
Loss on extinguishment of debt
 
 (17.3)
Other income (expense), net0.9
 0.8
 (0.7)(0.7) (1.0) 0.8
Total other expense, net(45.0) (33.7)
(40.1)(22.3) (21.8)
(45.1)
Loss from continuing operations before income taxes(50.8) (52.3)
(44.6)
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes15.7
 8.7

(57.1)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations(8.2) 8.1
 (11.4)4.8
 4.6
 (10.2)
Loss from continuing operations(42.6) (60.4)
(33.2)
Discontinued operations (Note 8)     
Income (loss) from operations of discontinued component (including gain on disposal of $80.8 million for the year ended December 27, 2015)
 (0.1) 75.5
Income tax expense0.1
 
 22.5
Income (loss) from continuing operations10.9
 4.1

(46.9)
Discontinued operations     
Income (loss) from operations of discontinued component (including gain on disposal of $0.0 million for the year ended December 30, 2018)1.9
 (9.4) 6.3
Income tax expense (benefit)0.2
 (1.8) 2.1
Income (loss) from discontinued operations(0.1) (0.1)
53.0
1.7
 (7.6)
4.2
Net income (loss)$(42.7) $(60.5)
$19.8
$12.6
 $(3.5)
$(42.7)
Basic income and loss per common share:     
Loss from continuing operations$(0.48) $(0.99) $(0.56)
Income from discontinued operations
 
 0.90
Less: Net income attributable to noncontrolling interest0.1
 
 
Net income (loss) attributable to Kratos$12.5
 $(3.5) $(42.7)
Basic income and (loss) per common share attributable to Kratos:     
Income (loss) from continuing operations$0.10
 $0.04
 $(0.52)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations0.02
 (0.07) 0.04
Net income (loss) per common share$(0.48) $(0.99) $0.34
$0.12
 $(0.03) $(0.48)
Diluted income and loss per common share:     
Loss from continuing operations$(0.48) $(0.99) $(0.56)
Income from discontinued operations
 
 0.90
Diluted income and (loss) per common share attributable to Kratos:     
Income (loss) from continuing operations$0.10
 $0.04
 $(0.52)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations0.01
 (0.07) 0.04
Net income (loss) per common share$(0.48) $(0.99) $0.34
$0.11
 $(0.03) $(0.48)
Weighted average common shares outstanding:          
Basic89.5
 61.3
 58.7
106.0
 103.8
 89.5
Diluted89.5
 61.3
 58.7
109.2
 106.1
 89.5
Comprehensive Income (Loss)     
Net income (loss) from above$(42.7) $(60.5) $19.8
Other comprehensive income (loss):     
Change in cumulative translation adjustment0.1
 (0.5) 0.1
Postretirement benefit reserve adjustment net of tax expense0.2
 0.2
 0.2
Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax0.3
 (0.3)
0.3
Comprehensive income (loss)$(42.4) $(60.8)
$20.1
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.


F-5

Table of Contents


KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITYCOMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
Years ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and December 27, 201531, 2017
(in millions)millions, except per share amounts)

  Common Stock Additional Paid-In Capital Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) Accumulated Deficit Total Stockholders’ Equity
  Shares Amounts    
Balance, December 28, 2014 57.8
 $
 $863.4
 $(1.7) $(637.4) $224.3
Stock-based compensation 
 
 6.4
 
 
 6.4
Issuance of common stock for employee stock purchase plan, options and warrants 0.9
 
 4.0
 
 
 4.0
Restricted stock issued and related taxes 0.4
 
 (0.6) 
 
 (0.6)
Net income 
 
 
 
 19.8
 19.8
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
 
 
 0.3
 
 0.3
Balance, December 27, 2015 59.1
 
 873.2
 (1.4) (617.6) 254.2
Stock-based compensation 
 
 5.1
 
 
 5.1
Issuance of common stock for cash 13.4
 
 75.8
 
 
 75.8
Issuance of common stock for employee stock purchase plan, options and warrants 0.8
 
 2.6
 
 
 2.6
Restricted stock issued and related taxes 0.6
 
 (0.5) 
 
 (0.5)
Net loss 
 
 
 
 (60.5) (60.5)
Other comprehensive loss, net of tax 
 
 
 (0.3) 
 (0.3)
Balance, December 25, 2016 73.9
 
 956.2
 (1.7) (678.1) 276.4
Stock-based compensation 
 
 7.8
 
 
 7.8
Issuance of common stock for cash 28.0
 
 268.2
 
 
 268.2
Issuance of common stock for employee stock purchase plan, options and warrants 0.7
 
 3.5
 
 
 3.5
Restricted stock issued and related taxes 0.7
 
 (2.0) 
 
 (2.0)
Net loss 
 
 
 
 (42.7) (42.7)
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
 
 
 0.3
 
 0.3
Balance, December 31, 2017 103.3
 $
 $1,233.7
 $(1.4) $(720.8) $511.5
      
 2019 2018 2017
Net income (loss)$12.6
 $(3.5) $(42.7)
Other comprehensive income:     
Change in cumulative translation adjustment0.1
 0.4
 0.1
Postretirement benefit reserve adjustment net of tax expense0.2
 0.3
 0.2
Other comprehensive income, net of tax0.3
 0.7
 0.3
Comprehensive income (loss)12.9
 (2.8) (42.4)
Less: Comprehensive income attributable to noncontrolling interest0.1
 
 
Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to Kratos$12.8
 $(2.8) $(42.4)
      


The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.




F-6

Table of Contents


KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWSSTOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
Years ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and December 27, 201531, 2017
(in millions)

 2017 2016 2015
Operating activities: 
  
  
Net income (loss)$(42.7) $(60.5) $19.8
Income (loss) from discontinued operations(0.1) (0.1) 53.0
Loss from continuing operations(42.6) (60.4) (33.2)
Adjustments to reconcile loss from continuing operations to net cash used in operating activities from continuing operations: 
  
  
Depreciation and amortization22.5
 22.8
 25.5
Deferred income taxes(10.2) 4.7
 0.9
Stock-based compensation7.8
 5.1
 6.1
Goodwill impairment charge24.2
 
 
Loss (gain) on extinguishment of debt17.3
 (0.2) 3.4
Non-cash income tax benefit
 
 (18.7)
Amortization of deferred financing costs1.3
 1.5
 1.9
Amortization of premium and discount on Senior Secured Notes0.7
 0.9
 1.1
Provision for doubtful accounts0.1
 0.3
 0.4
Litigation related charges
 1.7
 
Provision for non-cash restructuring charges
 9.1
 
Change in accrual for excess facilities
 
 (2.3)
      
Changes in assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions: 
  
  
Accounts receivable(39.1) (24.7) 10.3
Inventoried costs7.1
 (2.7) (8.2)
Prepaid expenses(4.0) 1.8
 (3.5)
Other assets(2.6) 3.2
 (3.2)
Accounts payable(3.4) 2.9
 2.9
Accrued expenses(5.4) 16.5
 0.6
Accrued compensation(4.4) 2.3
 (4.4)
Accrued interest(1.9) (0.3) 1.5
Billings in excess of costs and earnings on uncompleted contracts5.4
 (0.4) (7.3)
Income tax receivable and payable1.7
 1.2
 (3.1)
Other liabilities(1.5) 2.3
 (0.4)
Net cash used in operating activities from continuing operations(27.0) (12.4) (29.7)
Investing activities: 
  
  
Cash paid for acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 (5.1) 
Proceeds from sale of assets0.7
 0.1
 0.9
Change in restricted cash
 0.3
 4.7
Capital expenditures(26.5) (9.2) (11.3)
Net cash used in investing activities from continuing operations(25.8) (13.9) (5.7)
Financing activities: 
  
  
Proceeds from the issuance of long-term debt300.0
 
 
  Extinguishment of long-term debt(448.8) (14.1) (175.0)
Proceeds from the issuance of common stock269.1
 76.2
 
   Repayments under credit facility(1.0) (1.0) (42.0)
   Cash paid for contingent acquisition consideration
 
 (1.1)
Debt issuance costs(6.6) 
 
Proceeds from exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, and employee stock purchase plan1.5
 2.0
 3.4
Other(0.8) 
 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities from continuing operations113.4
 63.1
 (214.7)
Net cash flows of continuing operations60.6
 36.8
 (250.1)
Net operating cash flows of discontinued operations
 0.1
 2.8
Net investing cash flows of discontinued operations(0.6) 4.0
 242.5
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents0.5
 (0.3) (0.2)
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents60.5
 40.6
 (5.0)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year69.1
 28.5
 33.5
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year$129.6
 $69.1
 $28.5
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:     
Cash paid during the year for interest$28.3
 $32.4
 $43.8
Net cash paid during the year for income taxes$(0.9) $
 $8.8
Non-cash financing and investing activities:     
Capital expenditures included in accounts payable and accrued expenses$1.6
 $2.1
 $
Liability for contingent consideration and goodwill related to acquisition$
 $5.1
 $
  Redeemable Noncontrolling Interest Common Stock Additional Paid-In Capital Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss Accumulated Deficit Total Stockholders’ Equity
   Shares Amounts    
Balance, December 25, 2016 
 73.9
 $
 $956.2
 $(1.7) $(678.1) $276.4
Stock-based compensation 
 
 
 7.8
 
 
 7.8
Issuance of common stock for cash 
 28.0
   268.2
     268.2
Issuance of common stock for employee stock purchase plan, options and warrants 
 0.7
 
 3.5
 
 
 3.5
Restricted stock issued and related taxes 
 0.7
 
 (2.0) 
 
 (2.0)
Net loss 
 
 
 
 
 (42.7) (42.7)
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
 
 
 
 0.3
 
 0.3
Balance, December 31, 2017 
 103.3
 
 1,233.7
 (1.4) (720.8) 511.5
Impact from the adoption of ASC 606 (Note 1) 
 
 
 
 
 (0.2) (0.2)
Stock-based compensation 
 
 
 7.2
 
 
 7.2
Issuance of common stock for employee stock purchase plan, options and warrants 
 0.4
 
 3.7
 
 
 3.7
Restricted stock issued and related taxes 
 0.1
 
 (0.1) 
 
 (0.1)
Net loss 
 
 
 
 
 (3.5) (3.5)
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
 
 
 
 0.7
 
 0.7
Balance, December 30, 2018 
 103.8
 
 1,244.5
 (0.7) (724.5) 519.3
Stock-based compensation 
 
 
 11.0
 
 
 11.0
Issuance of common stock for employee stock purchase plan, options and warrants 
 0.8
 
 4.9
 
 
 4.9
Restricted stock issued and related taxes 
 0.2
 
 (0.9) 
 
 (0.9)
Issuance of common stock for acquisitions 
 1.8
 
 27.0
 
 
 27.0
Net income 0.1
 
 
 
 
 12.5
 12.5
Other comprehensive income, net of tax 
 
 
 
 0.3
 
 0.3
Changes in noncontrolling interest 14.9
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, December 29, 2019 15.0
 106.6
 $
 $1,286.5
 $(0.4) $(712.0) $574.1


The accompanying notes are an integral part of these Consolidated Financial Statements.


F-7

Table

KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
Years ended December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018, and December 31, 2017
(in millions)

 2019 2018 2017
Operating activities: 
  
  
Net income (loss)$12.6
 $(3.5) $(42.7)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations1.7
 (7.6) 4.2
Income (loss) from continuing operations10.9
 4.1
 (46.9)
Adjustments to reconcile income (loss) from continuing operations to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities from continuing operations: 
  
  
Depreciation and amortization23.4
 17.9
 22.2
Deferred income taxes(4.9) (0.4) (9.5)
Amortization of lease right-of-use assets11.7
 
 
Stock-based compensation11.0
 7.2
 7.8
Goodwill impairment charge
 
 24.2
Loss on extinguishment of debt
 
 17.3
Amortization of deferred financing costs1.0
 1.0
 1.3
Amortization of premium and discount on Senior Secured Notes
 
 0.7
Provision for doubtful accounts(0.2) 1.8
 
Changes in assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions: 
  
  
Accounts receivable(11.6) 8.2
 0.5
Unbilled receivables(1.6) (35.9) (35.2)
Inventoried costs(4.6) 2.0
 7.2
Prepaid expenses0.3
 2.2
 (3.0)
Other assets(0.9) 1.2
 (2.7)
Operating lease liabilities(6.3) 
 
Accounts payable4.8
 12.2
 (8.3)
Accrued expenses(6.4) (1.7) (3.8)
Accrued compensation1.7
 3.3
 (2.9)
Accrued interest(0.1) (0.1) (1.9)
Billings in excess of costs and earnings on uncompleted contracts(2.4) (6.9) 6.3
Income tax receivable and payable1.8
 0.2
 1.4
Other liabilities1.3
 1.8
 (1.6)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities from continuing operations28.9
 18.1
 (26.9)
Investing activities: 
  
  
Cash paid for acquisitions, net of cash acquired(17.7) (2.9) 
Proceeds from sale of assets0.3
 66.0
 0.7
Capital expenditures(26.3) (22.6) (26.1)
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities from continuing operations(43.7) 40.5
 (25.4)
Financing activities: 
  
  
Proceeds from the issuance of long-term debt
 
 300.0
  Extinguishment of long-term debt
 
 (448.8)
Proceeds (expenses) from the issuance of common stock
 (1.1) 269.1
   Repayment under credit facility and debt
 (0.8) (1.0)
Debt issuance costs
 (0.1) (6.6)
  Payments under finance leases(0.5) 
 
Proceeds from exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, and employee stock purchase plan4.0
 3.7
 1.5
Other
 
 (0.8)
Net cash provided by financing activities from continuing operations3.5
 1.7
 113.4
Net cash flows of continuing operations(11.3) 60.3
 61.1
Net operating cash flows of discontinued operations1.1
 (7.7) (0.8)
Net investing cash flows of discontinued operations
 
 (0.6)
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash(0.2) (0.5) 0.5
Net increase (decrease) in cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash(10.4) 52.1
 60.2
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at beginning of year183.0
 130.9
 70.7
Cash, cash equivalents and restricted cash at end of year$172.6
 $183.0
 $130.9
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information:     
Cash paid during the year for interest$19.9
 $20.5
 $28.3
Net cash paid during the year for income taxes$0.6
 $1.5
 $(0.6)
Non-cash financing and investing activities:     
Capital expenditures included in accounts payable and accrued expenses$1.4
 $1.3
 $1.6
Liability for contingent consideration and goodwill related to acquisition$
 $
 $2.9

The accompanying notes are an integral part of Contentsthese Consolidated Financial Statements.



KRATOS DEFENSE & SECURITY SOLUTIONS, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS




Note 1.1.    Organization and Summary of Significant Accounting Policies


(a)Description of Business


Kratos is a mid-tier government contractor at the forefront of the U.S. Department of Defense’s (the “DoD”) Third Offset Strategy.recapitalization of strategic weapon systems to address peer and near peer threats and its related Rapid Innovation Initiatives. Kratos is a leading technology, intellectual property, and proprietary product and solutionsystem company focused on the U.S. and its allies’ national security. Kratos is a recognized industry leader in the rapid development, demonstration and fielding of high technology systems and products at an affordable cost. Kratos’ primary focus areas are unmanned systems, space and satellite communications, training solutions, microwave electronics, cyber security/warfare, missile defense, and hypersonic systems, turbine technologies, and combat systems. The Company believes that its technology, intellectual property, proprietary products and designed-in positions on its customers’ programs, platforms and systems, and the ability to rapidly develop, demonstrate and field affordable leading technology systems is a competitive advantage and high barrier to entry to the markets in which it operates. The Company’s work force is primarily engineering and technically oriented, highly skilled with a significant number holding national security clearances. The Company’s entire organization is focused on executing its strategy of becoming the leading technology and intellectual property based company in its industry.


The Company conducts most of its business with the U.S. Government (which includes foreign military sales) and performs work as the prime contractor, subcontractor, or preferred supplier. The Company also conducts business with local, state, and foreign governments and domestic and international commercial customers.


The Company operates in three2 reportable segments. The Kratos Government Solutions (“KGS”) reportable segment is comprised of an aggregation of KGS operating segments, including its microwave electronic products, satellite communications, space, training and cybersecurity, C5ISR/modular systems, turbine technologies and defense and rocket support services operating segments. The Unmanned Systems (“US”) reportable segment consists of its unmanned aerial system and unmanned ground and unmanned seaborne system businesses.products. The Public Safety & Security (“PSS”) reportable segment consists(which was divested in June 2018 and has been classified as discontinued operations - see Note 9 of its businesses that providethese notes to the consolidated financial statements) previously provided independent integrated solutions for advanced homeland security, public safety, critical infrastructure, and security and surveillance systems for government and commercial applications.

The Company organizes its businessoperating segments based primarily on the nature of the products, solutions and services offered. Transactions between segments are negotiated and accounted for under terms and conditions similar to other government and commercial contracts, and these intercompany transactions are eliminated in consolidation. For additional information regarding the Company’s operating segments, see Note 1314 of these notes to consolidated financial statements.


(b)Principles of Consolidation and Basis of Presentation


The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Kratos and its 100% owned subsidiaries, for which all intercompany transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.


(c)    Fiscal Year
 
The Company has a 52/53 week fiscal year ending on the last Sunday of the calendar year, with interim fiscal periods ending on the last Sunday of each calendar quarter. There were 52 calendar weeks in the fiscal years ending on December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018 and 53 calendar weeks in the fiscal year endingended on December 31, 2017, and 52 calendar weeks in the fiscal years ended on December 25, 2016 and December 27, 2015.2017.


(d)Use of Estimates


The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Such estimates include revenue recognition, valuation of long-lived assets including identifiable intangibles and goodwill, accounting for income taxes including the related valuation allowance on the deferred tax asset and uncertain tax positions, contingencies and litigation, contingent acquisition consideration, and stock-based compensation. In the future, the Company may realize actual results that differ from the current


reported estimates and if the estimates that the Company has used change in the future, such changes could have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial position, results of operations and cash flows.


F-8

Table of Contents


(e)Revenue Recognition


Effective January 1, 2018, the Company adopted the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) ASU 2014-09, Revenue from Contracts with Customers, and the related amendments, which are codified into Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 606 (“ASC 606”), which establishes a broad principle that requires entities to assess the products or services promised in contracts with customers at contract inception to determine the appropriate unit at which to record revenues, which is referred to as a performance obligation. Revenue is recognized when control of the promised products or services is transferred to customers, at an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those products or services. The new standard requires disclosure of the nature, amount, timing, and uncertainty of revenue and cash flows arising from contracts with customers.

The Company typically generates itsadopted ASC 606 on January 1, 2018, using the modified retrospective method and recognized and recorded a decrease in opening equity of $0.2 million as of January 1, 2018 due to the cumulative impact of adopting ASC 606. The impact of adopting ASC 606 for the year ended December 30, 2018 was an increase of $30.0 million to revenues and a corresponding increase in cost of revenues of $21.9 million. Total net cash provided by operating activities from continuing operations, total net cash provided by investing activities from continuing operations and total net cash provided by financing activities on the Company’s consolidated statements of cash flows were not impacted by the adoption of ASC 606. Discontinued operations were not affected by the adoption of ASC 606.

The reported results for 2018 and 2019 reflect the application of ASC 606 guidance while the reported results for periods prior to January 1, 2018 were prepared under the guidance of FASB ASC 605. The adoption of ASC 606 represents a change in accounting principle.

To determine revenue recognition for arrangements that the Company determines are within the scope of ASC 606, the Company performs the following five steps: (i) identify the contract(s) with a customer; (ii) identify the performance obligation(s) in the contract; (iii) determine the transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligation(s) in the contract; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the entity satisfies a performance obligation. Once the contract is identified and determined to be within the scope of ASC 606, the Company assesses the goods or services promised within each contract and determines those that are performance obligations, and assesses whether each promised good or service is distinct. The Company then recognizes as revenue the amount of the transaction price that is allocated to the respective performance obligation when (or as) the performance obligation is satisfied.

A performance obligation is a promise in a contract to transfer a distinct good or service to the customer and is the unit of account under ASC 606. The majority of the Company’s contracts have a single performance obligation as the promise to transfer the individual goods or services is not separately identifiable from three different types of contractual arrangements: cost-plus-fee contracts, time-and-materialsother promises in the contracts and, fixed-price contracts. Revenue on cost-plus-feetherefore, not distinct. For contracts is recognizedwith multiple performance obligations, the Company allocates the contract’s transaction price to each performance obligation using the extent of allowable costs incurred plus anbest estimate of the applicable fees earned.standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the contract. The primary method used to estimate standalone selling price is the expected-cost-plus-margin approach, under which the Company forecasts the expected costs of satisfying a performance obligation and then adds an appropriate margin for that distinct good or service.

Prior to the adoption of ASC 606, the Company recognized the majority of its revenues using the percentage-of completion method of accounting. Based on the nature of products provided or services performed, revenue was recorded as costs were incurred (the “percentage-of-completion cost-to-cost method”) or as units were delivered (the “percentage-of-completion units-of-delivery method”). For the majority of contracts, the Company satisfies the underlying performance obligations over time as the customer obtains control or receives benefits as work is performed on the contract. As a result, under ASC 606 revenue is recognized over a time using the cost-to-cost method (cost incurred relative to total estimated cost at completion). This change generally results in an acceleration of revenue for contracts that were historically accounted for using the percentage-of-completion units-of-delivery method as revenues are now recognized earlier in the performance period as costs are incurred rather than as units are delivered.

Remaining Performance Obligations

Since the Company’s adoption of ASC 606 on January 1, 2018, revenues from remaining performance obligations are now calculated as the dollar value of the remaining performance obligations on executed contracts. On December 29, 2019, the Company had approximately $601.2 million of remaining performance obligations. The Company considers fees under cost-plus-fee contractsexpects to be earned in proportion to the allowable costs incurred in performancerecognize


approximately 62.0% of the contractremaining performance obligations as revenue in 2020, an additional 21.0% in 2021, and recognizes the relevant portion of the expected feebalance thereafter.

Contract Estimates

Due to be awarded by the customer at the time such fee can be reasonably estimated, based on factors such as its prior award experience and communications with the customer regarding performance, including any interim performance evaluations rendered by the customer. Revenue on time-and-materials contracts is recognized to the extent of billable rates times hours delivered for services provided, to the extent of material cost for products delivered to customers, and to the extent of expenses incurred on behalf of the customers.

The Company has three basic categories of fixed-price contracts: fixed unit price, fixed-price-level of effort, and fixed-price-completion. Revenue recognition methods on fixed-price contracts will vary depending on the nature of the work required to be performed on many performance obligations, the estimation of total cost at completion is complex, subject to many variables and requires significant judgment. On a quarterly basis, the Company conducts its contract cost Estimate at Completion (“EAC”) process by reviewing the progress and execution of outstanding performance obligations within its contracts. As part of this process, management reviews information including, but not limited to, any outstanding key contract matters, progress towards completion and the related program schedule, identified risks and opportunities and the related changes in estimates of revenues and costs. The risks and opportunities include management’s judgment about the ability and cost to achieve the schedule (e.g., the number and type of milestone events), technical requirements (e.g., a newly-developed product versus a mature product) and other contract terms. Revenues on fixed-price service contracts are recorded asrequirements. Management must make assumptions and estimates regarding labor productivity and availability, the complexity of the work is performed in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 605, Revenue Recognition (“Topic 605”), specifically Topic 605-10-S99, which generally requires revenue to be deferred until allperformed, the availability of materials, the length of time to complete the performance obligation (e.g., to estimate increases in wages and prices for materials and related support cost allocations), execution by subcontractors, the availability and timing of funding from customers and overhead cost rates, among other variables.

In addition, certain of the following have occurred: (1) thereCompany’s long-term contracts contain award fees, incentive fees, or other provisions that can either increase or decrease the transaction price. These variable amounts generally are awarded upon achievement of certain performance metrics, program milestones or cost targets and can be based upon customer discretion. Variable consideration is a contract in place; (2) delivery has occurred or services have been provided; (3)estimated at the price is fixed or determinable; and (4) collectability is reasonably assured. Revenues on fixed-price contracts that require delivery of specific items may be recorded based on a price per unit as units are delivered. Revenue for fixed-price contracts inmost likely amount to which the Company is paidexpected to be entitled. Estimated amounts are included in the transaction price to the extent it is probable that a specific amountsignificant reversal of cumulative revenue recognized will not occur when the uncertainty associated with the variable consideration is resolved. Estimates of variable consideration and determination of whether to provideinclude estimated amounts in the transaction price are based largely on an assessment of the Company’s anticipated performance and all information (historical, current and forecasted) that is reasonably available.

Contracts are often modified to account for changes in contract specifications and requirements. Contract modifications are considered to exist when the modification either creates new or changes the existing enforceable rights and obligations. Most of the Company’s contract modifications are for goods or services that are not distinct from the existing contract due to the significant integration service provided in the context of the contract and are accounted for as if they were part of that existing contract. The effect of a stated periodcontract modification on the transaction price, and the measure of timeprogress for the performance obligation to which it relates, is recognized ratably over the service period.as an adjustment to revenue (either as an increase in or a reduction of revenue) on a cumulative catch-up basis.


OnAs a portionresult of the fixed price-completion contracts,EAC process, any quarterly adjustments to revenues, cost of sales, and the related impact to operating income are recognized as necessary in the period they become known. These adjustments may result from positive program performance, and may result in an increase in operating income during the performance of individual performance obligations, if it is determined the Company will be successful in mitigating risks surrounding the technical, schedule and cost aspects of those performance obligations or realizing related opportunities. Likewise, these adjustments may result in a decrease in operating income if it is determined the Company will not be successful in mitigating these risks or realizing related opportunities. Changes in estimates of net sales, cost of sales and the related impact to operating income are recognized quarterly on a cumulative catch-up basis, which recognizes in the current period the cumulative effect of the changes on current and prior periods. A significant change in one or more of these estimates could affect the profitability of one or more of the Company’s contracts. When estimates of total costs to be incurred on a performance obligation exceed total estimates of revenue to be earned, a provision for the entire loss on the performance obligation is recognized in accordance with Topic 605 using the percentage-of-completion method based onperiod the ratio of total costs incurred to date compared to estimated total costs to complete the contract. Estimates of costs to complete include material, direct labor, overhead, and allowable indirect expenses for government contracts. These cost estimates are reviewed and, if necessary, revised on a contract-by-contract basis. If, as a result of this review, management determines that a loss on a contract is probable, then the full amount of estimated loss is chargeddetermined. No cumulative catch-up adjustment on any one contract was material to operations in the period.Company’s consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018 and December 31, 2017. Likewise, total cumulative catch-up adjustments were not material for the years ended December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018 and December 31, 2017. As of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, accrued expenses included the accrual for losses on contracts of $10.3$3.1 million and $17.7$5.1 million, respectively.

Contract Assets and Liabilities

For each of the Company’s contracts, the timing of revenue recognition, customer billings, and cash collections results in a net contract asset or liability at the end of each reporting period. Fixed-price contracts are typically billed to the customer either using progress payments, whereby amounts are billed monthly as costs are incurred or work is completed, or performance based payments, which are based upon the achievement of specific, measurable events or accomplishments

In certain instances, when
defined and valued at contract inception. Cost-type contracts are typically billed to the customer on a monthly or semi-monthly basis.

Contract assets consist of unbilled receivables, primarily related to long-term contracts where revenue recognized under the cost-to-cost method exceeds amounts billed to customers. Unbilled receivables are classified as current assets and, in accordance with industry practice, include amounts that may be billed and collected beyond one year due to the long term nature of many of the Company’s contracts. Accumulated contract costs in unbilled receivables include direct production costs, factory and engineering overhead, production tooling costs, and, for government contracts, recovery of allowable general and administrative expenses. Unbilled receivables also include certain estimates of variable consideration described above. The Company’s contracts that give rise to contract assets are not considered to include a significant financing component as the payment terms are intended to protect the customer in the event the Company does not perform on its obligations under the contract.

Contract liabilities include advance payments and billings in excess of revenue recognized. Certain customers have requested that it commence workmake advance payments prior to receiptthe satisfaction of the Company’s performance obligations on the contract. These amounts are recorded as contract awardliabilities until such performance obligations are satisfied, either over time as costs are incurred or at a point in time when deliveries are made. The Company’s contracts that give rise to contract liabilities do not include a significant financing component as the underlying advance payments received are generally utilized to pay for contract costs within a one-year period or are used to ensure the customer meets contractual requirements.

Net contract assets and funding and it has incurred costsliabilities are as follows (in millions):
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018 Net Change
Contract assets$179.4
 $172.8
 $6.6
Contract liabilities$34.3
 $37.0
 $(2.7)
Net contract assets$145.1
 $135.8
 $9.3


Contract assets increased $6.6 million during the year ended December 29, 2019, primarily due to the recognition of revenue related to that specific anticipated contract, andthe satisfaction or partial satisfaction of performance obligations during the year ended December 29, 2019 for which the Company believes recoverabilityhas not yet billed the customers. There were no significant impairment losses related to any receivables or contract assets arising from the Company’s contracts with customers during the year ended December 29, 2019. Contract liabilities decreased $2.7 million during the year ended December 29, 2019, primarily due to revenue recognized in excess of payments received on these performance obligations. For the years ended December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018, the Company recognized revenue of $30.5 million and $35.5 million, respectively, that was previously included in the beginning balance of contract liabilities.

In November 2019, a large training solutions program was terminated for convenience (“T for C”) by the customer. Under a T for C, a contractor is entitled to seek specified costs through a termination settlement process including (1) the contract price for completed supplies and services accepted by the government but not previously paid for; (2) the cost incurred in the performance of work terminated plus a reasonable profit on those costs; and (3) its costs incurred in settling with subcontractors and preparing and settling the termination proposal. Under a T for C, the Company would not be able to collect the total withheld amounts until the settlement terms of the costsT for C have been negotiated and agreed to with the customer. At December 29, 2019, approximately $11.5 million in unbilled receivables is probable, it may defer those costs incurred untiloutstanding on this project. In addition, the associated contractCompany is currently in dispute with an international customer in the US segment over approximately $10.0 million in unbilled receivables outstanding as of December 29, 2019. The dispute concerns the completion of system requirements and contractual milestones. Although there could be a delay in billing and collecting amounts due to the Company under the aforementioned contracts, management has been awardedevaluated the present facts of the matters and funded byperformed a reassessment of the customer.contractual amounts due and have determined that no adjustment to previously recognized revenue, or the corresponding unbilled receivables, is necessary at December 29, 2019.


In accounting for
Disaggregation of Revenue

The following series of tables presents the Company’s long-termrevenue disaggregated by several categories. For the majority of contracts, for production of products providedrevenue is recognized over time as work is performed on the contract. Revenue by contract type was as follows (in millions):
 Year Ended December 29, 2019 Year Ended December 30, 2018
Kratos Government Solutions   
 Fixed price$469.4
 $424.9
 Cost plus fee54.3
 32.6
 Time and materials32.4
 27.6
   Total Kratos Government Solutions556.1
 485.1
Unmanned Systems   
 Fixed price126.2
 104.8
 Cost plus fee33.8
 26.5
 Time and materials1.4
 1.6
   Total Unmanned Systems161.4
 132.9
Total Revenues$717.5
 $618.0

Revenue by customer was as follows (in millions):
 Year Ended December 29, 2019 Year Ended December 30, 2018
Kratos Government Solutions   
 U.S. Government (1)
$368.6
 $333.5
 International (2)
111.4
 96.0
 U.S. Commercial and other customers76.1
 55.6
   Total Kratos Government Solutions556.1
 485.1
Unmanned Systems   
 U.S. Government (1)
138.8
 113.5
 International (2)
21.1
 18.3
 U.S. Commercial and other customers1.5
 1.1
   Total Unmanned Systems161.4
 132.9
Total Revenues$717.5
 $618.0

(1) Sales to the U.S. Government include sales from contracts for which the Company utilizes both cost-to-cost and units delivered measures underis the percentage-of-completion method of accounting under the provisions of Topic 605. Under the units delivered measure of the percentage-of-completion method of accounting, sales are recognizedprime contractor, as the units are accepted by the customer generally using sales valueswell as those for units in accordance with the contract terms. The Company estimates profit as the difference between total estimated revenue and total estimated cost of a contract and recognizes that profit over the life of the contract based on units delivered or as computed on the basis of the estimated final average unit costs plus profit. The Company classifies contract revenues as product sales or service revenues depending upon the predominant attributes of the relevant underlying contracts.

Significant management judgments and estimates, including but not limited to the estimated costs to complete projects, must be made and used in connection with the revenue recognized in any accounting period. A cancellation, schedule delay, or modification of a fixed-price contract which is accounted for using the percentage-of-completion method may adversely affect the Company’s gross margins for the period in which the contractCompany is modified or canceled. Under certain circumstances, a cancellation or negative modification could result insubcontractor and the Company having to reverse revenue that was recognized in a prior period, thus significantly reducingultimate customer is the amount of revenues recognized for the period in which the adjustment is made. Correspondingly, a positive modification may positively affect gross margins. In addition, a schedule delay or modifications can result in an increase in estimated cost to complete the project, which would also result in an impact to gross margins. Changes in contract estimates are reviewed on a contract-by-contract basis and are revised periodically throughout the life of the contract such that adjustments to profit resulting from revisions are made cumulative to the date of the revision in accordance with GAAP. Material

F-9

Table of Contents

differences may result in the amount and timingU.S. Government. Each of the Company’s segments derives substantial revenue from the U.S. Government. These sales include foreign military sales contracted through the U.S. Government.

(2)International sales include sales from contracts for any period if management made different judgments or utilized different estimates.

It is the Company’s policy to review any arrangement containing software or software deliverables and services against the criteria contained inASC Topic 985, Software (“Topic 985”). Under the provisions of Topic 985, the Company reviews the contract value of software deliverables and services and determines allocations of the contract value based on vendor-specific objective evidence (“VSOE”) of fair value for each of the software elements. All software arrangements requiring significant production, modification, or customization of the software are accounted for in conformity with Topic 605.

The Company’s contracts may include the provision of more than one of its services (“multiple element arrangements”). In these situations, the Company applies the guidance of Topic 605. Accordingly, for applicable arrangements, revenue recognition includes the proper identification of separate units of accounting and the allocation of revenue across all elements based on relative fair values.

For multiple element arrangements that include hardware products containing software essential to the hardware products’ functionality, the Company allocates revenue to all deliverables based on their relative selling prices. In such circumstances, the Company uses a hierarchy to determine the selling price to be used for allocating revenue to deliverables: (i) VSOE, (ii) third-party evidence of selling price (“TPE”), and (iii) best estimate of the selling price (“ESP”).

VSOE generally exists only when the Company sells the deliverable separately and is the price actually charged by the Company for that deliverable. TPE is determined based on competitor prices for similar deliverables when sold separately. Generally, the Company’s offerings contain significant differentiation such that comparable pricing of products with similar functionality cannot be obtained. Furthermore,which the Company is unable to reliably determine what similar competitor products’ selling prices are on a stand-alone basis. Therefore,the prime contractor, as well as those for which the Company typically is unable to obtain TPE of selling price. ESP reflectsa subcontractor and the Company’s best estimates of whatultimate customer is an international customer. These sales include direct sales with governments outside the selling prices of elements would be if they were sold regularly on a stand-alone basis. The Company determines ESP for a product or service by considering multiple factors including, but not limited to major product groupings, geographies, market conditions, competitive landscape, internal costs, gross margin objectivesU.S. and pricing practices. The determination of ESP is made through consultationcommercial sales with management, taking into considerationcustomers outside the Company’s marketing strategy.U.S.

The Company accounts for multiple element arrangements that consist only of software or software-related products, including the sale of upgrades to previously sold software, in accordance with industry specific software accounting guidance. For such transactions, revenue on arrangements that include multiple elements is allocated to each element based on the relative fair value of each element, and fair value is determined by VSOE. If the Company cannot objectively determine the fair value of any undelivered element included in such multiple element arrangements, the Company defers revenue until all elements are delivered and services have been performed, or until fair value can objectively be determined for any remaining undelivered elements. Under certain of the Company’s contractual arrangements, the Company may also recognize revenue for out-of-pocket expenses in accordance with Topic 605. Depending on the contractual arrangement, these expenses may be reimbursed with or without a fee.

Under certain of its contracts, the Company provides supplier procurement services and materials for its customers. The Company records revenue on these arrangements on a gross or net basis in accordance with Topic 605, depending on the specific circumstances of the arrangement. The Company considers the following criteria, among others, for recording revenue on a gross or net basis:

(1)whether the Company acts as a principal in the transaction;
(2)whether the Company takes title to the products;
(3)whether the Company assumes risks and rewards of ownership, such as risk of loss for collection, delivery or returns;
(4)whether the Company serves as an agent or broker, with compensation on a commission or fee basis; and
(5)whether the Company assumes the credit risk for the amount billed to the customer subsequent to delivery.


For federal contracts, the Company follows U.S. Government procurement and accounting standards in assessing the allowability and the allocability of costs to contracts. Due to the significance of the judgments and estimation processes, it is likely that materially different amounts could be recorded if different assumptions were used

F-10

Table of Contents

or if the underlying circumstances were to change. The Company closely monitors the consistent application of its critical accounting policies and compliance with contract accounting. Business operations personnel conduct periodic contract status and performance reviews. When adjustments in estimated contract revenues or costs are required, any significant changes from prior estimates are included in earnings in the current period. Also, regular and recurringRecurring evaluations of contract cost, scheduling and technical matters are performed by management personnel who are independent from the business operations personnel performing work under the contract.management. Costs incurred and allocated to contracts with the U.S. Government are scrutinized for compliance with regulatory standards by the Company’s personnel, and are subject to audit by the Defense Contract Audit Agency.Agency (“DCAA”).


From time to time, the Company may proceed with work based on customer direction prior to the completion and signing of formal contract documents. The Company has a formal review process for approving any such work. Revenue associated with such work is recognized only when it can be reliably estimatedthe criteria to establish a contract under ASC 606 are met and realization is probable. The Company bases its estimates on previous experiences with the customer, communications with the customer regarding funding status, and its knowledge of available funding forobligations under the contract or program.are legally enforceable. As of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, approximately $1.9


$4.7 million and $2.0$3.8 million, respectively, of the Company’s unbilled accounts receivable balance were under an authorization to proceed or work order from its customers where a formal purchase order had not yet been received.

Costs incurred for shipping and handling are included in cost of product sales at the time the related revenue is recognized. Amounts billed to a customer for shipping and handling are reported as revenue.


(f)Inventoried costs


Inventoried costs are stated at the lower of cost or market.estimated net realizable value. Cost is determined using the average cost or first-in, first-out methods and the applicable method is applied consistently within an operating entity. InventoriedThe Company capitalizes labor, material, subcontractor and overhead costs primarily relateas work-in-process for contracts where control has not yet passed to work under fixed-price contracts using the units-of-delivery methodcustomer. In addition, the Company capitalizes costs incurred to fulfill a contract in advance of percentage-of-completion accounting. These costs represent accumulated contract costs less the portion of such costs allocated to delivered items. Accumulatedaward in inventories as work-in-process if it is determined that contract costs include direct production costs, factory and engineering overhead and production tooling costs.award is probable. Pursuant to contract provisions of U.S. Government contracts, such customers may have title to, or a security interest in inventories related to such contracts as a result of advances, performance-based payments, and progress payments. The Company reflects those advances and payments as an offset against the related inventory balances.


The Company regularly reviews inventory quantities on hand, future purchase commitments with its suppliers, and the estimated utility of its inventory. If the Company’s review indicates a reduction in utility below carrying value, it reduces its inventory to a new cost basis.


(g)Research and Development


Costs incurred in research and development activities are expensed as incurred in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”)FASB ASC Topic 730, Research and Development.


(h)Income Taxes


The Company records deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases and operating loss and tax credit carryforwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be realized. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date.


The Company maintains a valuation allowance on the deferred tax assets for which it is more likely than not that the Company will not realize the benefits of these tax assets in future tax periods. The valuation allowance is based on estimates of future taxable income by tax jurisdiction in which the Company operates, the number of years over which the deferred tax assets will be recoverable, and scheduled reversals of deferred tax liabilities.


In accordance with the recognition standards established byASCTopic 740, Income Taxes,(“ (“Topic 740740”), the Company makes a comprehensive review of its portfolio of uncertain tax positions regularly. In this regard, an uncertain tax position represents the Company’s expected treatment of a tax position taken in a filed tax return, or

F-11

Table of Contents

planned to be taken in a future tax return or claim, which has not been reflected in measuring income tax expense for financial reporting purposes. Until these positions are sustained by the taxing authorities, the Company has not recognized the tax benefits resulting from such positions and reports the tax effects as a liability for uncertain tax positions in its consolidated balance sheets.


(i)Stock-Based Compensation


The Company accounts for stock-based compensation in accordance with ASC Topic 718, Compensation-Stock Compensation(“Topic 718”). All of the Company’s stock-based compensation plans are considered equity plans under Topic 718, and compensation expense recognized is net of estimated forfeitures over the vesting period. The Company issues stock options and stock awards under its existing plans. The fair value of stock options is estimated on the date of grant using a Black-Scholes option-pricing model or a trinomial lattice options pricing model and is expensed on a straight-line basis over the remaining vesting period of the options, which is generally six or less years. The fair value of stock awards is determined based on the closing market price of the Company’s common stock on the grant date and is adjusted at each reporting date based on the amount of shares ultimately expected to vest. Compensation expense for stock awards is expensed over the vesting period, usually five to ten years. Compensation expense for stock issued under the Company’s employee stock purchase plan is estimated at the beginning date of the offering period using a Black-Scholes option-pricing model and is expensed on a straight-line basis over the period of the offering, which is generally six months. months.

When tax deductions from stock options and awards are greater than the cumulative book compensation expense, the tax effect of the resulting difference is a windfall. For the year ended December 29, 2019, an income tax benefit of $2.1 million


was recorded for windfalls generated from stock options and awards exercised in 2019. For the tax years ended December 31, 2017, December 25, 201630, 2018 and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, there were no incremental tax benefits from stock options exercised in the periods.

The following table shows the amounts recognized in the consolidated financial statements for 2017, 2016 and 2015 for stock-based compensation expense related to stock options, stock awards and stock offered under the Company’s employee stock purchase plan (in millions, except per share amounts).


 Year ended December 29, 2019 Year ended December 30, 2018 Year ended December 31, 2017
Selling, general and administrative expenses$11.0
 $7.2
 $7.8
Total cost of employee stock-based compensation included in operating income (loss) from continuing operations$11.0
 $7.2
 $7.8

 2017 2016 2015
Selling, general and administrative expenses$7.8
 $5.1
 $6.1
Total cost of employee stock-based compensation included in operating loss from continuing operations7.8
 5.1
 6.1
Impact on net loss per common share:     
Basic and diluted$(0.09) $(0.08) $(0.10)


(j)Allowance for Doubtful Accounts


The Company maintains an allowance for doubtful accounts for estimated losses resulting from the inability of its customers to make required payments, which results in bad debt expense. Management periodically determines the adequacy of this allowance by periodically evaluating the comprehensive risk profiles of all individual customer receivable balances including, but not limited to, the customer’s financial condition, credit agency reports, financial statements and overall current economic conditions. Additionally, on certain contracts whereby the Company performs services for a prime/general contractor, a specified percentage of the invoiced trade accounts receivable may be retained by the customer until the project is completed. The Company periodically reviews all retainages for collectability and records allowances for doubtful accounts when deemed appropriate, based on its assessment of the associated credit risks. Changes to estimates of contract value are recorded as adjustments to revenue and not as a component of the allowance for doubtful accounts. Individual accounts receivable are written off to the allowance for doubtful accounts when the Company becomes aware of a specific customer’s inability to meet its financial obligation, and all collection efforts are exhausted.


F-12

Table of Contents


The following table outlines the balance of the Company’s allowance for doubtful accounts for 2017, 20162019, 2018 and 2015.2017. The table identifies the additional provisions each year as well as the write-offs that utilized the allowance (in millions).


Allowance for Doubtful AccountsBalance at Beginning of Year Provisions Write-offs/Recoveries Balance at End of Year
Year ended December 31, 2017$1.5
 $
 $(1.0) $0.5
Year ended December 30, 2018$0.5
 $1.8
 $
 $2.3
Year ended December 29, 2019$2.3
 $(0.2) $(0.2) $1.9

Allowance for Doubtful AccountsBalance at Beginning of Year Provisions Write-offs/Recoveries Balance at End of Year
Year ended December 27, 2015$1.9
 $0.4
 $(0.5) $1.8
Year ended December 25, 2016$1.8
 $0.3
 $(0.4) $1.7
Year ended December 31, 2017$1.7
 $0.1
 $(1.2) $0.6


(k)Cash and Cash Equivalents


The Company’s cash equivalents consist of its highly liquid investments with an original maturity of three months or less when purchased by the Company.


The Company hashad 0 restricted cash accounts ofat December 29, 2019 and approximately $0.4 million at December 31, 2017 and $0.5$0.3 million at December 25, 2016.30, 2018. As of December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, restricted cash consistsconsisted primarily of a deposit securing foreign letters of credit related to payment and performance bonds on international contracts.


(l)Property and Equipment, Net


Property and equipment, net owned by the Company is depreciated over the estimated useful lives of individual assets. Equipment acquired under capital leases are amortized over the shorter of the lease term or the estimated useful life of the asset. Improvements, which significantly improve and extend the useful life of an asset, are capitalized and depreciated over the shorter of the lease period or the estimated useful life. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are charged to operations as incurred.



Assets are depreciated predominately using the straight-line method, with the following lives:


 Years
Buildings and improvements15 – 39
Machinery and equipment3 – 10
Computer equipment and software1 – 10
Vehicles, furniture, and office equipment5
Leasehold improvementsShorter of useful life or length of lease


The Company classifies assets and liabilities as held for sale (“disposal group”) when management, having the authority to approve the action, commits to a plan to sell the disposal group, the sale is probable within one year, and the disposal group is available for immediate sale in its present condition. The Company also considers whether an active program to locate a buyer has been initiated, whether the disposal group is marketed actively for sale at a price that is reasonable in relation to its current fair value, and whether actions required to complete the plan indicate that it is unlikely that significant changes to the plan will be made or the plan will be withdrawn.

At the time of classifying assets as held for sale and at the end of each reporting period, the Company compares the carrying value of these assets to estimates of fair value to assess for impairment. The Company compares the carrying value to estimates of fair value utilizing the assistance of third-party broker opinions of value to assist in its fair value estimates.

In the third quarter of 2016, the Company’s management, following the closure of its manufacturing facility in South Carolina, committed to a plan to sell the Walterboro building facility reported within the KGS segment. At that time, the building facility had a carrying value of $1.9 million and was classified as held for sale. In the fourth quarter of 2016, after not receiving any viable offers to purchase the building facility, the Company decided to reclassify the building facility from held for sale to held for use. In accordance with ASC Topic 360-10, Property, Plant and Equipment - Disposal of Long-Lived Assets, utilizing the assistance of a third-party broker to assist in the

F-13

Table of Contents

estimating of fair value, the remeasured fair value of the building was determined to be $500,000. The impairment loss of $1.4 million was recorded at that time and is reflected in unused office space and other restructuring in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss) for the year ended December 25, 2016.


(m)Leases


In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02 (“ASU 2016-02”), Leases, also referred to as “ASC 842”. ASC 842 requires that lessees recognize assets and liabilities for the rights and obligations underlying leases with a lease term of more than one year. The amendments in this ASU are effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018. In July 2018, the FASB issued ASU 2018-11, Leases; Targeted Improvements, which, among other things, allowed the Company to elect an optional transition method that applies the new lease requirements through a cumulative-effect adjustment in the period of adoption. The Company adopted ASC 842 on December 31, 2018 using the optional transition method, and, as a result, did not recast prior period comparative financial statements. All prior period amounts and disclosures are presented under Accounting Standards Codification Topic 840, Leases (“ASC 840”).

The Company uses itshas elected the package of practical expedients, which, among other things, allows carry-forward of prior lease classifications under the prior standard. However, the Company has not elected to adopt the hindsight practical expedient and is therefore maintaining the lease terms previously determined under the prior lease standard. For all new and modified leases after adoption of ASC 842, the Company has taken the component election allowing the Company to account for lease components together with non-lease components in the calculation of the lease asset and corresponding liability. Adoption of the new standard resulted in the recording of additional lease assets and lease liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet. No cumulative-effect adjustment was recognized as the amount was not material, and the impact on the Company’s results of operations and cash flows was also not material.

The Company leases certain facilities, office space, vehicles and equipment. Lease assets and lease liabilities are recognized at the commencement of an arrangement where it is determined at inception that a lease exists. Lease assets represent the right to use an underlying asset for the lease term, and lease liabilities represent the obligation to make lease payments arising from the lease. These assets and liabilities are initially recognized based on the present value of lease payments over the lease term calculated using an incremental borrowing rate ingenerally applicable to the assessment of lease classification as capital or operating and defines the initial lease term to include renewal options determined to be reasonably assured. The Company conducts operations primarily under operating leases.

Most lease agreements for real property contain incentives for tenant improvements, rent holidays, or rent escalation clauses. For incentives for tenant improvements, the Company capitalizes the leasehold improvements which are depreciated over the shorterlocation of the lease termasset, unless the implicit rate is readily determinable. Lease assets also include any upfront lease payments made and exclude lease incentives. Lease terms include options to extend or their estimated useful lifeterminate the lease when it is reasonably certain that those options will be exercised. The Company has operating lease arrangements with lease and recordsnon-lease components. The non-lease components in these arrangements are not significant when compared to the lease components. For all operating leases, the Company accounts for the lease and non-lease components as a deferred rent liability which is amortized over thesingle component.

Variable lease payments are generally expensed as incurred. Leases with an initial term of 12 months or less are not recorded on the lease as a reduction to rent expense. For rent holidaysbalance sheet, and rent escalation clauses during the lease term, the Company records minimum rental expensesexpense for these short-term leases is recognized on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

The depreciable life of lease assets and leasehold improvements is limited by the expected lease term, unless there is a transfer of the lease. For purposestitle or purchase option reasonably certain of recognizing lease incentives, the Company uses the date of initial possession as the commencement date, which is generally when the Company is given the right of accessexercise.
See Note 6 for additional disclosures related to the space and begins to make improvements in preparation for intended use.Company’s lease obligations.


(n)Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets, Net


In accordance with the provisions ofASC Topic 350, Intangibles-Goodwill and Other (“Topic 350”), the Company performs impairment tests for goodwill and indefinite lived intangibles as of the last day of its fiscal October, or when evidence of potential impairment exists. When it is determined that impairment has occurred, a charge to operations is recorded. Goodwill and other purchased intangible asset balances are included in the identifiable assets of the operating segment to which


they have been assigned. Any goodwill impairment, as well as the amortization of other purchased intangible assets, is charged against the respective segments’ operating income.


In accordance with Topic 350, the Company classifies intangible assets into two categories: (1) intangible assets with finite lives subject to amortization and (2) intangible assets with indefinite lives not subject to amortization. Separately, the Company tests intangible assets with finite lives for impairment if conditions exist that indicate the carrying value may not be recoverable. Such conditions may include an economic downturn in a geographic market or a change in the assessment of future operations. The Company records an impairment charge when the carrying value of the finite lived intangible asset is not recoverable by the cash flows generated from the use of the asset.


The Company determines the useful lives of identifiable intangible assets after considering the specific facts and circumstances related to each intangible asset. Factors considered when determining useful lives include the contractual term of any agreement, the history of the asset, the Company’s long-term strategy for the use of the asset, any laws or other local regulations which could impact the useful life of the asset, and other economic factors, including competition and specific market conditions. Intangible assets that are deemed to have finite lives are amortized, generally on a straight-line basis, over their useful lives, ranging from one to 15 years.


(o)Impairment of Long-Lived Assets and Long-Lived Assets to Be Disposed Of


Long-lived assets are reviewed for impairment in accordance withASC Topic 360, Property, Plant, and Equipment, whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset may not be recoverable. Recoverability of assets to be held and used is measured by a comparison of the carrying amount of the assets to future net cash flows (undiscounted and without interest) expected to be generated by the asset. If such assets are considered to be impaired, the impairment to be recognized is measured by the amount by which the carrying amount of the assets exceeds the fair value of the assets. Assets to be disposed of are reported at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less costs to sell.


(p)Fair Value of Financial Instruments


ASC Topic 825, Financial Instruments, requires that fair values be disclosed for the Company’s financial instruments. The carrying amounts of cash equivalents, accounts receivable, accounts payable, accrued expenses, billings in excess of costs and earnings on uncompleted contracts, and income taxes payable, approximate fair value due to the short-term nature of these instruments. The fair value of the Company’s long-term debt is based upon actual

F-14

Table of Contents

trading activity. The fair value of capital lease obligations is estimated based on quoted market prices for the same or similar obligations with the same remaining maturities.prices.


(q)Concentrations and Uncertainties


The Company maintains cash balances at various financial institutions and such balances commonly exceed the $250,000 insured amount by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation. The Company has not experienced any losses in such accounts and management believes that the Company is not exposed to any significant credit risk with respect to such cash and cash equivalents.


Financial instruments, which subject the Company to potential concentrations of credit risk, consist principally of the Company’s billed and unbilled accounts receivable. The Company’s accounts receivable result from sales to customers within the U.S. Government, state and local agencies and with commercial customers in various industries. The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of its commercial customers. Credit is extended based on evaluation of the customer’s financial condition and collateral is not required. Accounts receivable are recorded at the invoiced amount and do not bear interest. See Note 1213 for a discussion of the Company’s significant customers.


(r)Debt Issuance Costs


Fees paid to obtain debt financing and revolving credit facilities or amendments under such debt financing and revolving credit facilities are treated as debt issuance costs and are capitalized and amortized over the expected term of the related debt or revolving credit facility and are shown as a financing activity in the consolidated statements of cash flows. Issuance costs related to debt are presented in the consolidated balance sheets as a direct deduction from the carrying amount of the associated debt liability. Issuance costs related to a revolving credit facility are included in other assets in the consolidated balance sheets.



(s)Interest Expense, Net


Interest expense, net is summarized in the following table (in millions):


 Year ended December 29, 2019 Year ended December 30, 2018 Year ended December 31, 2017
Interest expense incurred primarily on the Senior Secured Notes$(23.5) $(21.6) $(29.1)
Miscellaneous interest income1.9
 0.8
 0.5
Interest expense, net$(21.6) $(20.8) $(28.6)

 2017 2016 2015
Interest expense incurred primarily on the Company’s Senior Secured Notes$(29.1) $(34.7) $(36.0)
Miscellaneous interest income0.5
 
 
Interest expense, net$(28.6) $(34.7) $(36.0)


(t)Foreign Currency


For operations outside the U.S. that prepare financial statements in currencies other than the U.S. dollar, results of operations and cash flows are translated at average exchange rates during the period, and assets and liabilities are generally translated at end-of-period exchange rates. Translation adjustments are included as a separate component of accumulated other comprehensive loss.


The Company transacts with foreign customers in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. It experiences realized and unrealized foreign currency gains or losses on foreign denominated receivables. In addition, certain intercompany transactions give rise to realized and unrealized foreign currency gains or losses. Also, any other transactions between the Company or its subsidiaries and a third-party, denominated in a currency different from the functional currency, are foreign currency transactions.


The aggregate foreign currency transaction gain (loss) included in determining net lossincome (loss) for the years ended December 31, 2017, 29, 2019, December 25, 201630, 2018, and December 27, 201531, 2017 was approximately $0.4$(1.1) million, $0.4$(1.1) million, and $(0.8)$0.4 million, respectively, which is included in other income (expense), net on the accompanying consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss).loss.



F-15

Table of Contents

(u)Recent Accounting Pronouncements


On December 22, 2017, the Securities and Exchange Commission staff issued Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 118 (“SAB 118”) to address the application of U.S. GAAP related to the enactment of the comprehensive tax legislation, commonly referred to as the Tax Cut and Jobs Act (the “2017 Tax Act”). This guidance was adopted in the fourth quarter of 2017. Additional information regarding our adoption of this guidance is contained in Note 7.

In May 2017, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2017-09 (“ASU 2017-09”), Compensation-Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Scope of Modification Accounting. ASU 2017-09 was issued to provide guidance about which changes to the terms or conditions of a share-based payment award require an entity to apply modification accounting. The amendments in this ASU are effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2017. The Company does not expect that the standard will have a material effect on its consolidated financial statements and will apply this guidance to applicable transactions after the adoption date.

In January 2017,June 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2017-042016-13 (“ASU 2017-04”2016-13”), Intangibles - GoodwillFinancial Instruments-Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments. The main objective of this update is to provide financial statement users with more decision-useful information about the expected credit losses on financial instruments and Other (Topic 350): Simplifyingother commitments to extend credit held by a reporting entity at each reporting date. To achieve this objective, the Test for Goodwill Impairment. ASU 2017-04 amendsamendments in this update replace the guidance to simplify the subsequent measurement of goodwill by removing Step 2 of the goodwillincurred loss impairment test. Instead, an entity should perform its annual, or interim, goodwill impairment test by comparing the fair valuemethodology in current GAAP with a methodology that reflects expected credit losses and requires consideration of a reporting unit with its carrying amount. An entity should recognize an impairment charge for the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the reporting unit’s fair value.broader range of reasonable and supportable information to inform credit loss estimates. ASU 2017-042016-13 is effective for annual reporting periodsfiscal years beginning after December 15, 2019, with early adoption permitted. The Company adopted this new guidance in 2017 in its assessment of the carrying value of the DRSS reporting unit, which resulted in a $24.2 million impairment charge.

In October 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-16 (“ASU 2016-16”), Income Taxes (Topic 740), Intra-Entity Transfers of Assets Other Than Inventory. ASU 2016-16 requires that entities recognize the income tax consequences of an intra-entity transfer of an asset other than inventory when the transfer occurs, rather than when the asset is sold to an outside party. ASU 2016-16 is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017, including interim periods within those annual reporting periods. Early adoption is permitted as of the beginning of an annual reporting period (as of the first interim period if an entity issues interim financial statements). ASU 2016-16 requires adoption on a modified retrospective basis through a cumulative-effect adjustment directly to retained earnings as of the beginning of the period of adoption.fiscal years. The Company earlyhas adopted this standard onASU 2016-13 effective December 26, 2016.30, 2019. The adoptionimplementation of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

In February 2016, the FASB issued ASU 2016-02 (“ASU 2016-02”), Leases. ASU 2016-02 requires that lessees recognize assets and liabilities for the rights and obligations underlying leases with a lease term of more than one year. The amendments in this ASU are effective for annual periods beginning after December 15, 2018. Early adoption is permitted. The standard must be applied using a modified retrospective approach. The Company is currently evaluating the impact of the adoption of ASU 2016-02 on its consolidated financial statements.

Note 2.     Acquisition

On February 27, 2019, the Company acquired 80.1% of the issued and outstanding shares of capital stock of Florida Turbine Technologies Inc., a Florida corporation (“FTT Inc.”), and 80.1% of the membership interests in FTT CORE, LLC, a Delaware limited liability company (“FTT Core” and, together with FTT Inc. and their respective subsidiaries, “FTT”), for an aggregate purchase price of approximately $60 million. The Company has developed an implementation planpurchase price was $33 million in cash, with approximately $17.7 million paid at close and approximately $15.3 million to evaluate the contracts across all the business segments, has educated both managementbe paid over a three-year period, subject to adjustments for transaction expenses, indebtedness, cash on hand, certain amounts payable or potentially payable to employees of FTT and post-closing working capital adjustments, and 1,825,406 shares of common stock (with a value of approximately $27 million).

FTT is a leading turbomachinery design and manufacturing company specializing in engineering, development, and testing of gas turbines, propulsion components, engine and other employeessystems for military and commercial applications. FTT is now the KTT Division, which is focused on the effectsdevelopment and production of small, affordable, high-performance jet engines for the next generation of tactical weapon systems and tactical jet UAS. The KTT Division is included in the KGS segment.



The excess of the new guidancepurchase price over the fair value of the tangible and has preliminarily assessedidentifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed in the internal control structure in orderacquisition was allocated to adoptgoodwill. The goodwill represents the ASU on January 1, 2019.

In May 2014,value the FASB issued ASU 2014-09 (“ASU 2014-09”), Revenue from Contracts with Customers. ASU 2014-09 establishes a broad principle that would require an entity to recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entityCompany expects to be entitledcreated by enabling it to accelerate FTT’s small engine development programs, and facilitate integration of these leading-edge engine solutions with evolving Kratos tactical systems.

Simultaneously with the execution of the Purchase Agreement among the Company and the Sellers (as defined in such agreement) (the “Purchase Agreement”) and completion of the acquisition, the Company, FTT Inc., FTT Core and the Sellers entered into an exchange for those goods or services. The FASB has also issued several updatesagreement (the “Exchange Agreement”) pursuant to ASU 2014-09. The new standard supersedes GAAP guidance on revenue recognitionwhich, among other things, (i) FTT Core was converted into a Delaware corporation, (ii) beginning in January 2024, the Holders (as defined in the Exchange Agreement) will have an annual right (the “Put Right”) to sell all of the minority interests in FTT Inc. and requires the use of more estimates and judgments than the present standards. It also requires additional disclosures. ASU 2014-09 may be applied either retrospectively or through the use of a modified-retrospective method. The full retrospective method requires companies to recast each prior reporting period presented as if the new guidance had always existed. Under the modified retrospective method, companies would recognize the cumulative effect of initially applying the standard as an adjustmentFTT Core (the “Minority Interests”) to the opening balanceCompany at a purchase price based on a specified multiple of retained earningsthe trailing 12 months EBITDA of FTT Inc., FTT Core and each of their respective subsidiaries (the “Acquired Companies”) as set forth in the Exchange Agreement (the “Minority Interest Purchase Price”) (provided, however, that following certain events, including a change of control, the Put Right will be accelerated and the Minority Interest Purchase Price will be a specified increased multiple of of the trailing 12 months EBITDA of the Acquired Companies as set forth in th Exchange Agreement), and (iii) beginning in January 2025, the Company will have an annual right to purchase all of the Minority Interests from the Holders at the dateMinority Interest Purchase Price.

The transaction has been accounted for using the acquisition method of initial application.accounting, which requires, among other things, that the assets acquired, the liabilities assumed, and the noncontrolling interest be recognized at their fair values as of the acquisition date. The fair value measurements are based primarily on significant inputs not observable in the marketplace and thus represent Level 3 measurements. The following table summarizes the allocation of the purchase price over the estimated fair values of the major assets acquired, liabilities assumed, and noncontrolling interest (in millions):

Accounts receivable $8.1
Unbilled receivables 4.9
Inventoried costs 7.8
Other current assets 2.1
Property and equipment 5.7
Intangible assets 30.8
Goodwill 23.0
  Total identifiable net assets acquired 82.4
Total identifiable net liabilities assumed (7.5)
  Net assets before noncontrolling interest 74.9
Noncontrolling interest (14.9)
  Net assets acquired, excluding cash $60.0
   


As of February 27, 2019, net liabilities include $7.5 million of current liabilities. There was no contingent purchase consideration associated with the acquisition of an 80.1% majority interest in FTT. The identifiable intangible assets include customer relationships of $19.7 million with a useful life of 13 years, in-process research and development of $8.5 million that will commence amortization at the completion of the development project, backlog of $2.1 million with a useful life of 2 years, and trade name of $0.5 million with a useful life of 2 years. The Company adoptedalso established a deferred tax liability of $7.0 million for the new revenue standard effective January 1, 2018,increase in the financial statement basis of the acquired assets of FTT and a corresponding increase in goodwill. The goodwill recorded in this transaction is not expected to be tax-deductible.

The value of customer relationships was estimated using the multi-period excess earnings method (“MPEEM”), an income approach (Level 3), which converts projected revenues and costs into cash flows. To reflect the fact that certain other assets contribute to the cash flows generated, the returns for these contributory assets were removed to arrive at estimated cash flows solely attributable to the acquired customer relationships, which were discounted at a rate of 12.5% to determine the fair value. The value of backlog was also valued using MPEEM. The value of in-process research and development was estimated using the relief-from-royalty method, an income approach (Level 3), which estimates the cost savings that accrue to the owner of the intangible asset that would otherwise be payable as royalties or license fees on revenues earned through the use of the modified-retrospective method.asset. A royalty rate was applied to the projected revenues associated with the intangible asset to determine the amount of savings, which was at a rate of 10% to determine the fair value.



The Company commenced a detailed analysisamounts of revenue and operating loss of FTT included in the Company's consolidated statement of operations for the year ended December 29, 2019 are $52.5 million and $0.7 million, respectively. Included in the merger and acquisition expenses for the year ended December 29, 2019 are transaction expenses of $1.4 million related to the acquisition of FTT.

A summary of the impactconsideration paid for the acquired ownership in FTT is as follow:
Cash paid $20.7
Deferred purchase consideration 15.3
Common stock issued 27.0
  63.0
Less: Cash acquired (3.0)
Total consideration $60.0
   


Pro Forma Financial Information (Unaudited)

The following table summarizes the supplemental condensed consolidated statement of ASU 2014-09operations information on an unaudited pro forma basis as if the acquisition of FTT occurred on December 31, 2018 and includes adjustments that were directly attributable to the foregoing transactions. There are no material, nonrecurring pro forma adjustments directly attributable to the business combination included in 2016, by evaluating its impact on selected contracts at eachthe reported pro forma revenue and earnings. The pro forma results are for illustrative purposes only for the applicable period and do not purport to be indicative of the Company’s business segments. With this baseline understanding, the Company developed a project plan to evaluate the contracts across all the business segments, spent significant effort in education of both management and other employees on the effects of the new guidance and assessed the internal

F-16

Table of Contents

control structure in order to adopt the ASU on January 1, 2018. ASU 2014-09 also requires expanded disclosure regarding the nature, timing, and uncertainty of revenue, cash flow and customer contract balances, including how and when performance obligations are satisfied and the relationship between revenue recognized and changes in contract balances during a reporting period. An entity is also required to disclose requirements for the remaining performance obligations. Disclosure includes the aggregate amount ofactual results that would have occurred had the transaction price allocated to the performance obligations that are unsatisfied (or partially unsatisfied)been completed as of the endbeginning of the reporting period, and an explanationnor are they indicative of when the entity expects to recognize as revenue the amount of remaining performance obligations. The entity can disclose on a quantitative basis using the time bands that would be most appropriate for the duration of the remaining performance obligations or by using qualitative information.

The Company has evaluated these disclosure requirements and has incorporated the collection of relevant data into its quarterly processes. The Company also designed and implemented specific controls based on its evaluation of the impact of ASU 2014-09, including the calculation of the cumulative effect of adopting ASU 2014-09. Significant changes to the Company’s accounting systems were not determined to be necessary upon adoption of ASU 2014-09. Several new controls were added and certain current controls have been modified to incorporate the revisions that have been made to the Company’s accounting policies and practices.

Based upon an assessment of material active contracts as of December 31, 2017, the Company has determined that the impact on the results of operations and cash flows upon adoption are not material. The Company also does not expect the impactthat may occur in the periods after adoptionfuture:

For the year ended December 29, 2019 (all amounts, except per share amounts, are in millions):
Pro forma revenues$725.6
Pro forma net income before tax$14.8
Pro forma net income$11.7
Pro forma net income attributable to Kratos$11.8
  
Basic pro forma income per share attributable to Kratos$0.11
Diluted pro forma income per share attributable to Kratos$0.11
  


The weighted average common shares used to be material. Under ASU 2014-09, revenue is recognized as control transfers tocalculate income per share also reflects the customer. As such, revenue for the Company’s contracts will generally be recognized over time using the cost-to-cost method, which is consistentissuance of 1,825,406 shares of our common stock in conjunction with the revenue recognition model in use for the majority of contracts prior to adoption. For those contracts where revenue was previously recognized as units are delivered, in most cases the accounting for those contracts changed under ASU 2014-09 such that revenue will be recognized as costs are incurred. This change will generally result in an acceleration of revenue as compared with the pre-adoption revenue recognition method for those contracts.acquisition.

The Company expects the cumulative effect of adopting ASU 2014-09 to result in an increase in revenue of less than $2 million and an increase in operating income of less than $2 million. These changes principally reflect the impact of converting contracts applying the units-of-delivery under the old revenue guidance to the cost-to-cost method of accounting. The cumulative effect of adoption of the new revenue guidance will be recognized as an increase in contract assets, a reduction in inventoried costs, an increase in contract liabilities and a net decrease in accumulated deficit as of January 1, 2018.



Note 2.3.     Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets
 
(a)Goodwill
 
The Company performs its annual impairment test for goodwill in accordance with Topic 350 as of the last day of its fiscal October or when evidence of potential impairment exists.


The Company assesses goodwill for impairment at the reporting unit level, which is defined as an operating segment or one level below an operating segment, referred to as a component. The Company determines its reporting units by first identifying its operating segments, and then assessing whether any components of these segments constitute a business for which discrete financial information is available and where segment management regularly reviews the operating results of that component. The Company aggregates components within an operating segment that have similar economic characteristics.


The KGS reportable segment has four5 operating segments: Defense Rocket Support Services (“DRSS”), Microwave Electronics (“ME”), TechnicalSpace, Training and TrainingCybersecurity Solutions (“TTS”)(ST&C), and Modular Systems (“MS”), and Kratos Turbine Technologies (“KTT”). All of the KGS operating segments provide technology based defense solutions, involving products and services, primarily for mission critical U.S. National Securitynational security priorities, with the primary focus relating to the nation’s Command, Control, Communications, Computing, Combat Systems, Intelligence, Surveillance and Reconnaissance


requirements. The PSS reportable business segment provides integrated solutions for advanced homeland security, public safety, critical infrastructure security, and security and surveillance systems for government, industrial and commercial customers. The US reportable segment consists of ourits unmanned aerial system, unmanned ground, and unmanned seaborne system businesses.products.



F-17

Table of Contents

The Company identified its reporting units to be the DRSS, ME, TTS,ST&C, MS, USKTT and PSSUS operating segments. The Company tests goodwill for impairment by performing a qualitative assessment or using a two-step impairment process. If the Company chooses to perform a qualitative assessment and determines it is not more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, the two-step impairment process is then performed. For operations where the two-step process is used, the identification and measurement of impairment involves the estimation of the fair value of reporting units. If the fair value is determined to be less than the carrying value, a second step is performed to determine the amount of the impairment. When any impairment has occurred, a charge to operations is recorded. In order to test for potential impairment, the Company estimates the fair value of each of itsthe reporting units based on a comparison and weighting of the income approach, specifically the discounted cash flow method and the market approach, which estimates the fair value of the Company’s reporting units based upon comparable market prices and recent transactions and also validates the reasonableness of the implied multiples from the income approach. The Company reconciles the fair value of its reporting units to its market capitalization based upon the last business day of fiscal October and assumes a control premium. The Company uses this methodology to determine the fair value of its reporting units for comparison to their corresponding book values because there are no observable inputs available, a Level 3 measurement (See Note 9). If the book value exceeds the estimated fair value for a reporting unit a potential impairment is indicated, and Topic 350 prescribes the approach for determining the impairment amount, if any.

The Company adopted ASU 2017-04 which amends the guidance to simplify the subsequent measurement of goodwill by removing Step 2 of the goodwill impairment test. This new guidance requires an entity to perform its annual, or interim, goodwill impairment test by comparing the fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount. An entity should recognize an impairment charge for the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the reporting unit’s fair value. As a result of the annual goodwill impairment test, the Company recorded a $24.2 million impairment charge which represented the excess of the carrying amount of goodwill compared to the fair value of the DRSS reporting unit.


In determining the fair value for the reporting units, where the two-step process is used, there are key assumptions relating to future operating performance and revenue growth. If the actual operating performance and financial results are not consistent with the Company’s assumptions, an impairment of the remaining balance in its $461.2 million goodwill and $22.0 million long-lived intangible assets could occur in future periods. Market factors that could impact the Company’s ability to successfully develop new products include the successful completion of certain unmanned system platformsexpected cash flows, terminal growth rates, appropriate discount rates, market multiples, and the successful acceptance of new unmanned system platforms, including fromcontrol premium a political and budgetary standpoint. For example, the US reporting unit fair value includes assumptions that the development of the high performance Unmanned Combat Aerial System (“UCAS”) product is successful and the Company is awarded future contracts for the UCAS product and other new tactical aerial systems. Additionally, the US reporting unit fair value assumes that the Company will receive follow on orders for the Sub-Sonic Aerial Target, which is currently under contract with the U.S. Navy.controlling shareholder could be expected to pay.


During the fourth quarter of 2017, as a result of the Company’s annual impairment test of the carrying value of its goodwill balances, the Company recorded an impairment charge of $24.2 million of the carrying value of the goodwill of its DRSS business reported in its KGS segment, which majority of business and revenue includesat the time included the Company’s legacy government services business. In 2010, the Company changed its strategy to focus on being a system, product, technology and intellectual property based company and deemphasized ourits legacy government services businesses which are no longer considered a core business. Over the past several years, similar to other businesses operating in the federal government technical services space, this business has been adversely impacted by competitive pressures and commoditization resulting from lower priced technically acceptable awards rather than awards based on best value or that are technologically or performance differentiated. Specifically, the Company was recently notified of losses on two newlost 2 sizable five yearfive-year contract opportunities where Kratos was underbid on cost, which significantly impacted the expected future financial performance of this business. There was no impairment recognized for the years ended December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018.


The carrying amounts of goodwill as of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 201630, 2018 by reportable segment are as follows (in millions):

As of December 29, 2019
 US
KGS
Total
Gross value$111.1

$597.8

$708.9
Less accumulated impairment13.8

239.5

253.3
Net$97.3

$358.3

$455.6

      
      
 As of December 30, 2018
 US KGS Total
Gross value$111.1
 $567.9
 $679.0
Less accumulated impairment13.8
 239.5
 253.3
Net$97.3
 $328.4
 $425.7


As of December 31, 2017
 PSS
US
KGS
Total
Gross value$53.9

$111.1

$567.8

$732.8
Less accumulated impairment18.3

13.8

239.5

271.6
Net$35.6

$97.3

$328.3

$461.2


F-18

Table of Contents

 As of December 25, 2016
 PSS US KGS Total
Gross value$53.9
 $111.1
 $567.8
 $732.8
Less accumulated impairment18.3
 13.8
 215.3
 247.4
Net$35.6
 $97.3
 $352.5
 $485.4



(b)Purchased Intangible Assets
 
The following table sets forth information for acquired finite-lived and indefinite-lived intangible assets (in millions):
 
 As of December 29, 2019 As of December 30, 2018
 
Gross
Value
 
Accumulated
Amortization
 
Net
Value
 
Gross
Value
 
Accumulated
Amortization
 
Net
Value
Acquired finite-lived intangible assets: 
  
  
  
  
  
Customer relationships$72.3
 $(53.3) $19.0
 $52.6
 $(50.6) $2.0
Contracts and backlog32.0
 (28.4) 3.6
 29.9
 (26.4) 3.5
Developed technology and technical know-how25.0
 (23.8) 1.2
 25.0
 (21.3) 3.7
Trade names1.9
 (1.6) 0.3
 1.4
 (1.4) 
In-process research and development8.5
 
 8.5
 
 
 
Total finite-lived intangible assets139.7
 (107.1) 32.6
 108.9
 (99.7) 9.2
Indefinite-lived trade names6.9
 
 6.9
 6.9
 
 6.9
Total intangible assets$146.6
 $(107.1) $39.5
 $115.8
 $(99.7) $16.1

 As of December 31, 2017 As of December 25, 2016
 
Gross
Value
 
Accumulated
Amortization
 
Net
Value
 
Gross
Value
 
Accumulated
Amortization
 
Net
Value
Acquired finite-lived intangible assets: 
  
  
  
  
  
Customer relationships$53.7
 $(50.2) $3.5
 $53.7
 $(44.9) $8.8
Contracts and backlog30.8
 (25.7) 5.1
 30.8
 (23.7) 7.1
Developed technology and technical know-how25.0
 (18.6) 6.4
 25.2
 (15.7) 9.5
Trade names1.4
 (1.3) 0.1
 1.4
 (1.1) 0.3
Total finite-lived intangible assets110.9
 (95.8) 15.1
 111.1
 (85.4) 25.7
Indefinite-lived trade names6.9
 
 6.9
 6.9
 
 6.9
Total intangible assets$117.8
 $(95.8) $22.0
 $118.0
 $(85.4) $32.6




The aggregate amortization expense for finite-lived intangible assets was $10.4$7.4 million, $10.5$5.9 million and $13.0$10.4 million, for the years ended December 31, 2017, 29, 2019, December 25, 201630, 2018, and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, respectively. The Company records all amortization expense in selling, general and administrative expenses.


The estimated future amortization expense of acquired intangible assets with finite lives as of December 31, 201729, 2019 is as follows (in millions):
Fiscal YearAmount
20205.8
20213.7
20222.4
20232.4
20242.4
Thereafter15.9
Total$32.6
Fiscal YearAmount
2018$5.9
20195.1
20203.0
20211.1
Total$15.1

 
Note 3.4.    Balance Sheet Details
 
The detail of certain assets in the consolidated balance sheets consists of the following (in millions).following:


Cash and cash equivalents


The Company’s cash equivalents consist of overnight cash sweep accounts that are invested on a daily basis. Cash and cash equivalents at December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 201630, 2018 were $129.6$172.6 million and $69.1$182.7 million, respectively, and approximated their fair value.



F-19

Table of Contents


Accounts receivable, net (in millions)and Unbilled Receivables, net


Receivables including amounts due under long-term contracts are summarized as follows:follows (in millions):
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Billed, current$86.6
 $66.5
Unbilled, current179.7
 173.2
Total current accounts receivable266.3
 239.7
Allowance for doubtful accounts(1.9) (2.3)
Total accounts receivable and unbilled receivables, net$264.4
 $237.4

 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016
Billed, current$101.5
 $102.8
Unbilled, current167.5
 128.3
Total current accounts receivable269.0
 231.1
Allowance for doubtful accounts(0.6) (1.7)
Total accounts receivable, net$268.4
 $229.4

Unbilled receivables represent the balance of recoverable costs and accrued profit, composed principally of revenue recognized on contracts for which billings have not been presented to the customer because the amounts were earned but not contractually billable as of the balance sheet date. Retainages receivable were $6.6 million as of December 31, 2017 and $6.2 million as of December 25, 2016 and are included in accounts receivable net.


Substantially all accounts receivable at December 31, 2017,29, 2019, are expected to be collected in 2018.2020. The Company does not believe it has significant exposure to credit risk, as accounts receivable and the related unbilled amounts are primarily from contracts where the end customer isassociated with the U.S. Government.


U.S. Government contract receivables where the Company is the prime contractor included in accounts receivable, net (in millions):
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Billed$16.6
 $16.5
Unbilled86.4
 83.1
Total U.S. Government contract receivables$103.0
 $99.6

 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016
Billed$17.3
 $15.6
Unbilled55.3
 39.3
Total U.S. Government contract receivables$72.6
 $54.9

 
Inventoried costs, net of progress payments (in millions):
 December 29,
2019
 December 30,
2018
Raw materials$39.1
 $34.7
Work in process20.3
 10.3
Finished goods1.7
 1.8
Total inventoried costs$61.1
 $46.8


 December 31,
2017
 December 25,
2016
Raw materials$35.4
 $31.9
Work in process11.4
 22.1
Finished goods2.3
 1.4
Supplies and other1.9
 1.8
Subtotal inventoried costs51.0
 57.2
Less customer advances and progress payments(0.6) (1.8)
Total inventoried costs$50.4
 $55.4



F-20



Property, plant and equipment, net (in millions)
December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Finance lease right of use assets$39.6
 $
Land and buildings$12.1
 $12.2
$12.2
 $11.9
Computer equipment and software30.1
 26.9
32.7
 28.3
Machinery and equipment49.9
 47.2
78.7
 56.8
Furniture and office equipment5.7
 5.3
7.1
 6.3
Leasehold improvements11.2
 9.9
12.3
 10.9
Construction in progress19.8
 6.1
16.0
 21.5
Property and equipment128.8
 107.6
198.6
 135.7
Accumulated depreciation and amortization(67.6) (57.8)(81.7) (68.6)
Total property and equipment, net$61.2
 $49.8
$116.9
 $67.1


Depreciation expense was $12.1$16.0 million, $12.312.0 million and $12.5$11.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2017, 29, 2019, December 25, 201630, 2018, and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, respectively.




Note 4.5.    Debt
 
(a)    Issuance of 6.5% Senior Secured Notes due 2025


In November 2017, the Company issued and sold $300 million aggregate principal amount of 6.5% Senior Secured Notes due 2025 (the “6.5% Notes”) in a private placement conducted pursuant to Rule 144A and Regulation S under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Act”). The Company incurred debt issuance costs of $6.6 million associated with the new 6.5% Notes. The Company utilized the net proceeds from the sale of the 6.5% Notes, as well as cash from its recent equity offering to extinguish the previously outstanding 7% Notes.7.00% Senior Secured Notes due 2019 (the “7% Notes”). The total reacquisition price of the 7% Notes was $385.2 million, including a $12.0 million call premium, and $0.3 million of accrued interest.


The 6.5% Notes are governed by the Indenture, dated as of November 20, 2017 (the “Indenture”), among the Company, the Company’s existing and future domestic subsidiaries parties thereto (the “Subsidiary Guarantors”) and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as trustee and collateral agent (in such capacity, the “2017 Trustee and Collateral Agent”). A Subsidiary Guarantor can be released from its guarantee if (a) all of the capital stock issued by such Subsidiary Guarantor or all or substantially all of the assets of such Subsidiary Guarantor are sold or otherwise disposed of; (b) the Company designates such Subsidiary Guarantor as an Unrestricted Subsidiary; (c) the Company exercises its legal defeasance option or its covenant defeasance option; or (d) upon satisfaction and discharge of the Indenture or payment in full in cash of the principal of, premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest on the 6.5% Notes.


The 6.5% Notes bear interest at a rate of 6.5% per year from the date of original issuance or from the most recent payment date on which interest has been paid or provided for. Interest on the 6.5% Notes is payable in arrears on May 30 and November 30 of each year, beginning on May 30, 2018. The 6.5% Notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the Subsidiary Guarantors.


The 6.5% Notes and the guarantees (as set forth in the Indenture, the “Guarantees”) are the Company’s senior secured obligations and are equal in right of payment with all other senior obligations of the Subsidiary Guarantors’ existing and future secured debt to the extent of the assets securing that secured debt. The Company’s obligations under the 6.5% Notes are secured by a first priority lien on substantially all of the Company’s assets and the assets of the Subsidiary Guarantors, except with respect to accounts receivable, inventory, deposit accounts, securities accounts, cash, securities and general intangibles (other than intellectual property), on which the holders of the 6.5% Notes have a second priority lien, junior to the lien securing the Company’s obligations under the Credit Agreement.


The 6.5% Notes will be redeemable, in whole or in part, at any time on or after November 30, 2020 at the respective redemption prices specified in the Indenture. In addition, the Company may redeem up to 40% of the 6.5% Notes before November 30, 2020 with the net proceeds of certain equity offerings. The Company may also redeem some or all of the 6.5% Notes before November 30, 2020 at a redemption price of 100% of the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest, to, but excluding, the redemption date, if any, plus a “make whole” premium. In addition, during each 12-month period commencing on the issue date and ending on or prior to November 30, 2020, the Company may redeem up to 10% of the original aggregate principal amount of the 6.5% Notes issued under the Indenture at a redemption price of 103.000% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest, to, but excluding, the date of redemption, if any. The Company may also be required to make an offer to purchase the 6.5% Notes upon a change of control and certain sales of its assets.

F-21

Table of Contents



The Indenture contains covenants limiting, among other things, the Company’s ability and the Subsidiary Guarantors’ ability to: (a) pay dividends on or make distributions or repurchase or redeem the Company’s capital stock or make other restricted payments; (b) incur additional debt and guarantee debt; (c) prepay, redeem or repurchase certain debt; (d) issue certain preferred stock or similar equity securities; (e) make loans and investments; (f) sell assets; (g) incur liens; (h) consolidate, merge, sell or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of the Company’s assets; (i) enter into transactions with affiliates; and (j) enter into agreements restricting the Company’s ability and certain of its subsidiaries’ ability to pay dividends. These covenants are subject to a number of exceptions. As of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, the Company was in compliance with the covenants contained in the Indenture governing the 6.5% Notes.


The terms of the Indenture require that the net cash proceeds from asset dispositions be either utilized to (i) repay or prepay amounts outstanding under the Credit Agreement unless such amounts are reinvested in similar collateral, (ii) permanently reduce other indebtedness, (iii) make an investment in assets that replace the collateral of the 6.5% Notes or (iii) a combination of (i), (ii) and (iii). To the extent there are any remaining net proceeds from the asset disposition after application of (i), (ii) and (iii), such amounts are required to be utilized to repurchase 6.5% Notes at par.



The Indenture also provides for events of default which, if any of them occurs, would permit or require the principal, premium, if any, interest, if any, and any other monetary obligations on all the then-outstanding 6.5% Notes to become or to be declared due and payable immediately.

(b)Issuance of 7.00% Senior Secured Notes due 2019

In May 2014, the Company refinanced its $625.0 million 10% Senior Secured Notes due in 2017 (the “10% Notes”) with $625.0 million of newly issued 7.00% Senior Secured Notes due in 2019 (the “7% Notes”). The net proceeds of the 7% Notes was $618.5 million after an original issue discount of $6.5 million. The Company incurred debt issuance costs of $8.8 million associated with the new 7% Notes. The Company utilized the net proceeds from the 7% Notes, a $41.0 million draw on the Credit Agreement discussed below, as well as cash from operations to extinguish the 10% Notes. The total reacquisition price of the 10% Notes was $661.5 million including a $31.2 million early termination fee, the write-off of $15.5 million of unamortized issue costs, $12.9 million of unamortized premium, along with $5.3 million of additional interest while in escrow, which resulted in a loss on extinguishment of $39.1 million. On October 16, 2014, the Company exchanged the outstanding 7% Notes for an equal amount of 7% Notes that had been registered under the Act.

The 7% Notes were governed by an Indenture dated May 14, 2014 (the “Indenture”) among the Company, certain of the Company’s subsidiaries and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as Trustee and Collateral Agent. The Company paid interest on the 7% Notes semi-annually, in arrears, on May 15 and November 15 of each year. The 7% Notes included customary covenants and events of default as well as a consolidated fixed charge ratio of 2.0:1 for the incurrence of additional indebtedness. Negative covenants include, among other things, limitations on additional debt, liens, negative pledges, investments, dividends, stock repurchases, asset sales and affiliate transactions. Events of default include, among other events, non-performance of covenants, breach of representations, cross-default to other material debt, bankruptcy, insolvency, material judgments and changes in control.

Following the sale of the Herley Entities (as defined below) (see Note 8 - Discontinued Operations), the Company, on August 21, 2015, paid down the $41.0 million outstanding on the $110.0 million Credit Agreement and on September 22, 2015, repurchased $175.0 million of the 7% Notes at par, in accordance with the Indenture. In connection with the $175.0 million repurchase of 7% Notes, the Company wrote off $1.8 million of unamortized issue costs, $1.4 million of unamortized discount, and incurred $0.2 million of legal fees, which resulted in a loss on extinguishment of debt of $3.4 million. The Company reinvested all net proceeds remaining after the repurchase of the $175.0 million of 7% Notes in replacement collateral under the Indenture within the 360 days following the asset disposition in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.

During the year ended December 25, 2016, the Company repurchased and extinguished $14.5 million of the outstanding 7% Notes, which resulted in a gain of $0.4 million offset by $0.1 million of unamortized issuance cost and $0.1 million of unamortized discount resulting in a net gain of $0.2 million.

During the year ended December 31, 2017, the Company redeemed and extinguished the remaining $435.5 million of outstanding 7% Notes as of December 25, 2016, which resulted in a loss of $13.4 million and the realization of $2.3 million of unamortized issuance cost and $1.6 million of unamortized discount resulting in a loss on extinguishment of debt of $17.3 million.


F-22

Table of Contents

(c)(b)    Other Indebtedness
 
Credit and Security Agreement


On May 14, 2014, the Company entered into a $110.0 million Credit and Security Agreement, dated May 14, 2014 (as amended from time to time, the “Credit Agreement”), with the lenders from time to time party thereto, SunTrust Bank, as Agent (the “Agent”), PNC Bank, National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger and Documentation Agent, and SunTrust Robinson Humphrey, Inc., as Joint Lead Arranger and Sole Book Runner. The Credit Agreement established a five-year senior secured revolving credit facility in the maximum amount of $110.0 million (subject to a potential increase of the maximum principal amount to $135.0 million, subject to the Agent’s and applicable lenders’ approval as described therein), consisting of a subline for letters of credit in an amount not to exceed $50.0 million, as well as a swingline loan in an aggregate principal amount at any time outstanding not to exceed $10.0 million. The obligations under the Credit Agreement are secured by a first priority lien on the Company’s accounts receivable, inventory, deposit accounts, securities accounts, cash, securities and general intangibles (other than intellectual property). The obligations under the Credit Agreement are secured by a second priority lien, junior to the lien securing the Notes, on all of the Company’s other assets.

The Credit Agreement contains certain covenants, which include, but are not limited to, restrictions on indebtedness, liens, and investments, and limits on other various payments, as well as a financial covenant relating to a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio. Events of default under the terms of the Credit Agreement include, but are not limited to: failure of the Company to pay any principal of any loans in full when due and payable; failure of the Company to pay any interest on any loan or any fee or other amount payable under the Credit Agreement within three business days after the date when due and payable; failure of the Company or any of its subsidiaries to comply with certain covenants and agreements, subject to applicable grace periods and/or notice requirements; any representation, warranty or statement made in or pursuant to the Credit Agreement or any related writing or any other material information furnished by the Company or any of its subsidiaries to the Agent or the lenders proving to be false or erroneous; and the occurrence of an event or condition having or reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect, which includes a material adverse effect on the business, operations, condition (financial or otherwise) or prospects of the Company or the ability of the Company to repay its obligations. Where an event of default arises from certain bankruptcy events, the commitments will automatically and immediately terminate and the principal of, and interest then outstanding on, all of the loans will become immediately due and payable. Subject to certain notice requirements and other conditions, upon the occurrence of an event of default, including the occurrence of a condition having or reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect, commitments may be terminated and the principal of, and interest then outstanding on, all of the loans may become immediately due and payable. As of December 31, 2017, no event of default had occurred and the Company believes that events or conditions having a material adverse effect, giving rise to an acceleration of any amounts outstanding under the Credit Agreement, have not occurred and the likelihood of such events or conditions occurring is remote.

On May 31, 2015, the Company entered into a third amendment (the “Third Amendment”) to the Credit Agreement. Under the terms of the Third Amendment, the definitions of certain terms of the Credit Agreement were modified, the disposition of the Herley Entities was approved by the lenders, a minimum $175.0 million repurchase of the 7% Notes by the Company was required and the payment in full of the outstanding balance of the Credit Agreement was required upon consummation of the sale of the Herley Entities. Additionally, the measurement of the fixed charge coverage ratio of 1.15:1 was modified as follows: (i) the fixed charge coverage ratio will not be measured as of the end of any quarterly reporting period ending after June 30, 2015, if on such date (a) there are no outstanding revolving loans or swingline loans and (b) the aggregate amount outstanding under letters of credit is less than or equal to $17.0 million, and (ii) as to any subsequent quarterly reporting period ending after June 30, 2015, and not covered by (i) above, a fixed charge coverage ratio of at least 1.05:1 must be maintained if the percentage of (a) outstanding revolving loans plus the sum of the outstanding swingline loans and outstanding letters of credit that are in excess of $17.0 million, to (b) the revolving credit commitment, minus the Herley Disposition Proceeds Reinvestment Reserve, as defined below, is greater than 0.00% but less than 15.00% or a fixed charge coverage ratio of at least 1.10:1 must be maintained if the aforementioned percentage is equal to or greater than 15.00% but less than 25.00%. In all other instances, a fixed charge coverage ratio of at least 1.15:1 must be maintained. For purposes of computing the fixed charge coverage ratio, the associated reduction in consolidated interest expense in connection with the repurchase of 7% Notes with proceeds from the sale of the Herley Entities shall be deemed to have occurred on the first day of the most recently completed four quarterly reporting periods prior to the sale.

On August 20, 2015, the Company entered into a fourth amendment (the “Fourth Amendment”) to the Credit Agreement. Among other things, the Fourth Amendment provides for a modification of the Third Amendment as it relates to when the minimum fixed charge coverage ratio will be measured based upon the Company’s outstanding borrowings. Outstanding borrowings for purposes of computing the applicable minimum fixed charge coverage ratio exclude any letter of credit exposure outstanding of $17.0 million plus the amount of letters of credit outstanding for the divested Herley Entities for

F-23

Table of Contents

which a cash deposit was placed in escrow by the Buyer to cover the amount of such outstanding letters of credit, should the letters of credit be pulled.


On November 20, 2017, the Company entered into an amended and restated Credit Agreement with the lenders from time to time party thereto, the Agent, PNC Bank, National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger and Documentation Agent, and SunTrust Robinson Humphrey, Inc., as Joint Lead Arranger and Sole Book Runner. As amended and restated, the Credit Agreement establishes a five year senior secured revolving credit facility in the aggregate principal amount of $90.0 million (subject to a potential increase of the aggregate principal amount to $115.0 million, subject to SunTrust’s and applicable lenders’ approval), consisting of a subline for letters of credit in an amount not to exceed $50.0 million, as well as a swingline loan in an aggregate principal amount at any time outstanding not to exceed $10.0 million.


Borrowings under the revolving credit facility may take the form of a base rate revolving loan, Eurodollar revolving loan or swingline loan. Base rate revolving loans and swingline loans will bear interest at a rate per annum equal to the sum of the Applicable Margin (as defined in the Credit Agreement) from time to time in effect plus the highest of (i) the Agent’s prime lending rate, as in effect at such time, (ii) the federal funds rate, as in effect at such time, plus 0.50% per annum and (iii) the Adjusted LIBOLIBOR Rate (as defined in the Credit Agreement) determined at such time for an interest period of one month, plus 1.00% per annum. Eurodollar revolving loans will bear interest a rate per annum equal to the sum of the Applicable Margin from time to time in effect plus the Adjusted LIBOLIBOR Rate. The Applicable Margin varies between 1.00%-1.50% for base rate revolving loans and swingline loans and 2.00%-2.50% for Eurodollar loans, and is based on several factors including the Company’s then-existing borrowing base and the lenders’ total commitment amount and revolving credit exposure. The calculation of the Company’s borrowing base takes into account several items relating to the Company and its subsidiaries, including amounts due and owing under billed and unbilled accounts receivables, then held eligible raw materials inventory, work-in-process inventory, and applicable reserves.


The measurement of a minimum fixed charge coverage ratio was modified in the November 2017 amended and restated Credit Agreement to beis required to be measured if Excess Availability, as defined in the Credit Agreement, is less than fifty50 percent of the lesser of the Borrowing Base or the Total Commitment Amount.Amount, each as defined in the Credit Agreement.


As of December 31, 2017,29, 2019 and December 30, 2018, there were no0 borrowings outstanding on the Credit Agreement; there was $9.5$5.4 million outstanding on letters of credit, resulting in net borrowing base availability of $65.8 million.$69.3 million as of December 29, 2019. The Company was in compliance with the financial covenants of the Credit Agreement as of December 31, 2017.29, 2019.


Debt Acquired in Acquisition

The Company has a 10-year term loan with a bank in Israel entered into on September 16, 2008 in connection with the acquisition of one of its wholly owned subsidiaries. The balance as of December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016 was $0.8 million and $1.8 million, respectively. The loan is payable in quarterly installments of $0.3 million plus interest at LIBOR plus a margin of 1.5%. The loan agreement governing the term loan contains various covenants, including a minimum net equity covenant as defined in the loan agreement. The Company was in compliance with all covenants contained in the loan agreement as of December 31, 2017.


Fair Value of Long-term Debt
 
Carrying amounts and the related estimated fair values of the Company’s long-term debt financial instruments not measured at fair value on a recurring basis at December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 201630, 2018 are presented in the following table:
 
 As of December 29, 2019 As of December 30, 2018
$ in millionsPrincipal 
Carrying
Amount
 Fair Value Principal 
Carrying
Amount
 Fair Value
Long-term debt$300.0
 $295.1
 $322.1
 $300.0
 $294.2
 $305.3
 As of December 31, 2017 As of December 25, 2016
$ in millionsPrincipal 
Carrying
Amount
 Fair Value Principal 
Carrying
Amount
 Fair Value
Long-term debt$300.8
 $294.3
 $312.7
 $437.3
 $432.0
 $423.6

 
The fair value of the Company’s long-term debt was based upon actual trading activity (Level 1, Observable inputs —quoted prices in active markets).
 
As of December 31, 201729, 2019, the difference between the carrying amount of $294.3295.1 million and the principal amount of $300.8300.0 million presented in the previous table, is the unamortized debt issuance costs of $6.5$4.9 million, which are being accreted to interest expense over the term of the related debt. As of December 25, 2016,30, 2018, the difference between the carrying amount of

F-24

Table of Contents

$432.0 $294.2 million and the principal amount of $437.3$300.0 million presented in the above table isalso related to the net unamortized original issue discount of $2.4 million and thesame unamortized debt issuance costs of $2.9 million, which are being accreted to interest expense over the term of the related debt.$5.8 million.


Future maturitiesmaturity of long-term debt are $0.8 million in 2018, andis $300.0 million in 2025.
 
Note 5.    Lease Commitments6.    Leases


As a result of a lease modification for its expanded facilities in Colorado, in the first quarter of 2019, the Company was required to reassess the classification of the lease which previously had been accounted for as an operating lease. This reassessment resulted in the reclassification of the operating lease to a $39.3 million finance lease.

The Company leases certain facilities and equipment under operating leases having terms expiring at various dates through 2033.

Future minimumcomponents of lease payments under operating leases as of expense for the year ended December 31, 2017, which does not include $7.4 million in sublease income on the Company’s operating leases, are29, 2019 were as follows (in millions):
Amortization of right of use assets - finance leases  $2.0
Interest expense on lease liabilities - finance leases  2.5
Operating lease cost (expense resulting from amortization of total lease payments)  13.2
Short-term lease cost  0.6
Variable lease cost (cost excluded from lease payments)  0.1
Sublease income  (3.3)
Total lease cost  $15.1
    


The components of leases on the balance sheet were as follows (in millions):
 December 29, 2019
Operating Leases: 
Operating lease right-of-use assets$42.1
Current portion of operating lease liabilities$9.9
Operating lease liabilities, net of current portion$37.6
Finance leases: 
Property, plant and equipment, net$38.1
Other current liabilities$0.6
Other long-term liabilities$38.4




Cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities for the year ended December 29, 2019 was as follows (in millions):
YearOperating Leases
2018$18.0
201919.5
202014.3
202111.4
20229.3
Thereafter55.3
Total future minimum lease payments$127.8
Finance lease - cash paid for interest  $2.5
Finance lease - financing cash flows  $0.5
Operating lease - operating cash flows (fixed payments)  $14.8



Other supplemental noncash information (in millions):
Gross rent
Operating lease liabilities arising from obtaining right-of-use assets, including impact of ASC 842 adoption $59.3
Finance lease liabilities arising from obtaining right-of-use assets, including impact of ASC 842 adoption $39.6
    
Weighted-average remaining lease term (in years):   
Operating leases  5.77
Finance leases  18.91
    
Weighted-average discount rate:   
Operating leases  6.50%
Finance leases  6.52%


The maturity of lease liabilities is (in millions):
 Operating Leases Finance Leases
2020$12.6
 $3.1
202110.0
 3.2
20228.6
 3.3
20238.2
 3.3
20246.2
 3.3
Thereafter11.6
 54.0
Total lease payments57.2
 70.2
Less: imputed interest(9.6) (31.2)
Total present value of lease liabilities$47.6
 $39.0
    


Rental expense underfor operating leases classified under ASC 840 for the years ended December 30, 2018, and December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015 was $21.5 million, $21.6$23.7 million, and $23.1$18.6 million, respectively. Total sublease income for the years ended December 30, 2018, and December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016,totaling $3.3 million, and December 27, 2015, totaling $3.4 million, $3.3 million, and $3.3 million, respectively, has been netted against rent expense.


The Company’s accrual for excess facilities was $3.3 million and $4.0 million, asAs of December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016, respectively. The accruals are included30, 2018, future minimum lease payments under ASC 840 for operating leases, which does not include $4.3 million in other current liabilities and other long-term liabilitiessublease income on the consolidated balance sheets. The Company estimates that the remaining accrual will be paid through 2020.

The accrual for excess facilities isCompany’s operating leases, were as follows (in millions):
YearOperating Leases
2019$16.5
202012.0
20219.6
20228.1
20237.9
Thereafter63.1
Total minimum lease payments$117.2



 Excess Facilities
Balance as of December 27, 2015$5.5
Adjustment of excess facility accrual
Cash payments(1.5)
Balance as of December 25, 20164.0
Adjustments of excess facility accruals
Cash payments(0.7)
Balance as of December 31, 2017$3.3


The lease on certain office facilities includes scheduled base rent increases over the term of the lease. The total amount of the base rent payments is being charged to expense on the straight-line method over the term of the lease. In addition to the base rent payment, the Company pays a monthly allocation of the building’s operating expenses. The Company has recorded deferred rent, included in accrued expenses and other long-term liabilities, of $3.3 million, and $3.9 million, at December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016, respectively, to reflect the excess of rent expense over cash payments since inception of the respective leases.


F-25

Table of Contents

Note 6.7.    Net LossIncome (Loss) Per Common Share
 
The Company calculates net lossincome (loss) per share in accordance with FASB ASCTopic 260,, Earnings per Share (“Topic 260”). Under Topic 260,”). Under Topic 260, basic net lossincome (loss) per common share is calculated by dividing net lossincome (loss) by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the reporting period. Diluted net lossincome (loss) per common share reflects the effects of potentially dilutive securities.


The following shares were excluded from the calculation of diluted loss per share because their inclusion would have been anti-dilutive (in millions):
 Year Ended
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018 December 31, 2017
Shares from stock options and awards
 0.1
 0.1

 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Shares from stock options and awards0.1
 1.4
 1.9


Note 7.8.    Income Taxes


In December 2017, the 2017 Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (“TCJA”) was enacted. The 2017 Tax Act includesenacted, which included a number of changes to existingprevious U.S. tax laws that impactimpacted the Company, most notably a reduction of the U.S. corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21% for tax years beginning after December 31, 2017. The 2017 Tax Act also provides for a one-time transition tax on certain foreign earnings and the acceleration of depreciation for certain assets placed into service after September 27, 2017 as well as prospective changes beginning in 2018, including repeal of the domestic manufacturing deduction, acceleration of tax revenue recognition, modification of NOL carryforwards, capitalization of research and development expenditures (starting in 2022), additional limitations on executive compensation deductions and limitations on the deductibility of interest.

On December 22, 2017, the SEC issued SAB 118, which provides companies with additional guidance on how to account for the 2017 Tax Act in its financial statements, allowing companies to use a measurement period. At December 31, 2017, the Company has not completed its accounting for the tax effects of enactment of the 2017 Tax Act; however, as described below, the Company has made a reasonable estimate of the effects on its existing deferred tax balances and the one-time transition tax. For these items, the Company recognized provisional amounts in accordance with SAB 118, which are included as a component of income tax expense from continuing operations. The Company expects to finalize these provisional estimates before the end of 2018 after completing its review and analysis, including review and analysis of any interpretations issued during this measurement period.

With the adoption of a minimum tax on foreign earnings, the Company will be subject to tax on global intangible low-taxed income (“GILTI”) in future years. The Company is continuing to evaluate this provision and will not make a policy election on how to account for GILTI (as a period expense or as part of its rate on deferred taxes) until it has the necessary information available, including the interpretations of the new rules, to analyze the impacts and complete its analysis. The Company will make an election before the end of 2018. Because the Company has not made a policy election, no amounts for GILTI are included in its deferred taxes.

Reduction of the U.S. Corporate Income Tax Rate
The Company measures deferred tax assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates that will apply in the years in which the temporary differences are expected to be recovered or paid. Accordingly, the Company’s net deferred liability was remeasured to reflect the reduction in the U.S. corporate income tax rate from 35% to 21%, resulting in a $6.9 million income tax benefit for the year ended December 31, 2017 and a corresponding $6.9 million decrease in net deferred tax liabilities as of December 31, 2017.

Modification of Net Operating Loss Carryforward Periods
The Company scheduled the expected reversal of deferred tax assets and liabilities and determined that approximately $6.3 million of federal deferred tax assets will likely generate a net operating loss with an indefinite-lived carryforward period. As such, $6.3 million of federal deferred tax assets were recognized without the need for a valuation allowance. These assets were netted with indefinite-lived deferred tax liabilities and resulted in a benefit recorded to income taxes.

Transition Tax on Foreign Earnings
The one-time transition tax on certain foreign earnings resulted in a $6.2 million decrease to deferred tax assets due to the reduction in net operating loss carryforwards. The decrease in deferred tax assets was offset by a corresponding decrease to

F-26

Table of Contents

the valuation allowance. The determination of the transition tax requires further analysis regarding the amount and composition of the Company’s historical foreign earnings, which is expected to be completed before the end of 2018.


Effective January 1, 2018, the 2017 Tax ActTCJA requires the acceleration of certain types of revenue for tax purposes for certain types of revenue.purposes. The new rules requireprohibit the Company to not deferfrom deferring revenue on unbilled accounts receivable later than when the amounts are recognized as revenue for book purposes. This change impacts several accounting methods previously used by the Company and is expected to result in an acceleration of taxability of such revenue beginning in 2018 as compared with prior U.S. tax laws. Additionally, future interest deductions of the Company will be limited to 30% of tax adjusted EBITDA through 2021.


AlthoughAdditionally, effective January 1, 2018, the Company believesTCJA imposes a U.S. tax on global intangible low taxed income (“GILTI”) that is earned by certain foreign affiliates owned by a U.S. shareholder each year. The computation of GILTI is generally intended to impose tax on the significant impacts from the 2017 Tax Actearnings of a foreign corporation that are those described above, it continuesdeemed to review and evaluate the other provisions of the 2017 Tax Act. This review could result in changesexceed a certain threshold return relative to the amounts that it has provisionally recorded.underlying business investment. The Company expectshas made a policy election to complete this review and evaluation beforetreat future taxes related to GILTI as a current period expense in the end of 2018.reporting period in which the tax is incurred.

The components of income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015 are comprised of the following (in millions):

 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018 December 31, 2017
Domestic$6.8
 $2.2
 $(60.5)
Foreign8.9
 6.5
 3.4
Total$15.7
 $8.7
 $(57.1)



 2017 2016 2015
Domestic$(54.2) $(61.8) $(54.2)
Foreign3.4
 9.5
 9.6
Total$(50.8) $(52.3) $(44.6)


The provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations for the years ended December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015 are comprised of the following (in millions):

 Year Ended
 December 29, 2019
December 30, 2018
December 31, 2017
Federal income taxes:     
Current$(0.2) $(0.4) $(2.9)
Deferred(3.9) (1.8) (9.0)
Total Federal(4.1) (2.2) (11.9)
State and local income taxes:     
Current1.0
 0.4
 0.5
Deferred(0.9) 1.4
 (0.3)
Total State and local0.1
 1.8
 0.2
Foreign income taxes:     
Current9.0
 4.8
 2.0
Deferred(0.2) 0.2
 (0.5)
Total Foreign8.8
 5.0
 1.5
Total$4.8
 $4.6
 $(10.2)


 2017 2016 2015
Federal income taxes:     
Current$(0.7) $(0.5) $(15.7)
Deferred(9.0) 4.0
 1.4
Total Federal(9.7) 3.5
 (14.3)
State and local income taxes     
Current0.7
 2.3
 0.8
Deferred(0.7) 0.7
 
Total State and local
 3.0
 0.8
Foreign income taxes:     
Current2.0
 1.5
 1.2
Deferred(0.5) 0.1
 0.9
Total Foreign1.5
 1.6
 2.1
Total$(8.2) $8.1
 $(11.4)


F-27

Table of Contents

A reconciliation of the total income tax provision (benefit) to the amount computed by applying the statutory federal income tax rate of 21% to the income from continuing operations before income taxes for the years ended December 29, 2019 and December 30, 2018, and applying the statutory federal income tax rate of 35% to the loss from continuing operations before income taxes for the yearsyear ended December 31, 2017December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015 is as follows (in millions):

 Year Ended
 December 29, 2019
December 30, 2018
December 31, 2017
Income tax (benefit) at federal statutory rate$3.3
 $1.8
 $(20.0)
State taxes, net of federal tax benefit and valuation allowance0.6
 0.9
 0.5
Difference in tax rates between U.S. and foreign1.9
 0.7
 
Increase (decrease) in valuation allowance(3.3) 4.7
 (45.6)
Nondeductible expense1.0
 0.6
 1.1
Increase in reserve for uncertain tax positions7.7
 4.0
 1.3
Changes to indefinite life items and separate state deferred taxes0.4
 (0.7) (1.8)
One-time transition tax on previously undistributed foreign earnings
 2.2
 6.2
Goodwill impairment
 
 8.1
Decrease in deferred taxes related to disposition
 (9.6) 
Impact related to the 2017 Tax Cuts and Jobs Act
 
 40.0
Release of valuation allowance due to FTT acquisition(5.2) 
 
Stock-based compensation(1.6) 
 
Total$4.8
 $4.6
 $(10.2)



 2017 2016 2015
Income tax (benefit) at federal statutory rate$(17.8) $(18.3) $(15.6)
State taxes, net of federal tax benefit and valuation allowance0.7
 0.2
 (0.2)
Difference in tax rates between U.S. and foreign
 0.1
 (0.7)
Increase (decrease) in valuation allowance(45.6) 19.1
 
Nondeductible expense1.1
 0.7
 0.8
Increase in reserve for uncertain tax positions1.3
 2.2
 0.9
Changes to indefinite life items and separate state deferred taxes(2.2) 4.1
 3.4
One-time transition tax on previously undistributed foreign earnings6.2
 
 
Goodwill impairment8.1
 
 
Impact related to the 2017 Tax Act40.0
 
 
Total$(8.2) $8.1
 $(11.4)


The tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities as of December 31, 2017 and December 25, 2016 are as follows (in millions):


 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Deferred tax assets:   
Allowance for doubtful accounts$0.6
 $0.6
Sundry accruals2.3
 1.1
Vacation accrual3.0
 2.7
Stock-based compensation5.3
 4.2
Payroll related accruals6.2
 2.4
Lease accruals22.1
 2.0
Investments1.3
 1.3
Net operating loss carryforwards75.1
 81.7
Capital loss carryforwards1.3
 1.9
Tax credit carryforwards11.2
 9.9
Deferred revenue1.1
 1.5
Reserves and other13.6
 10.8
 143.1
 120.1
Valuation allowance(88.6) (92.2)
Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance54.5
 27.9
Deferred tax liabilities:   
Unearned revenue(19.0) (23.9)
Operating lease right-of-use assets(20.2)  
Other intangibles(21.0) (8.9)
Property and equipment, principally due to differences in depreciation(2.0) (0.9)
Other(1.3) (1.2)
Total deferred tax liabilities(63.5) (34.9)
Net deferred tax liability$(9.0) $(7.0)

 2017 2016
Deferred tax assets:   
Allowance for doubtful accounts$0.2
 $0.4
Sundry accruals1.5
 2.2
Vacation accrual3.2
 4.7
Stock-based compensation3.1
 5.2
Payroll related accruals2.1
 2.9
Lease accruals2.5
 4.5
Investments1.3
 2.0
Net operating loss carryforwards95.7
 124.8
Tax credit carryforwards9.5
 9.4
Deferred revenue1.9
 2.5
Reserves and other6.1
 11.9
 127.1
 170.5
Valuation allowance(87.5) (133.1)
Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance39.6
 37.4
Deferred tax liabilities:   
Unearned revenue(38.8) (43.0)
Other intangibles(5.4) (7.0)
Property and equipment, principally due to differences in depreciation(0.7) (2.0)
Other(1.7) (2.7)
Total deferred tax liabilities(46.6) (54.7)
Net deferred tax liability$(7.0) $(17.3)


In assessing the Company’s ability to realize deferred tax assets, management considers, on a periodic basis, whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of theits deferred tax assets will not be realized. As such, managementIn making this assessment, the Company has determinedconcluded that it is appropriatenegative evidence, including cumulative losses in recent years, continues to maintainoutweigh the positive evidence. Accordingly, the Company has maintained a full valuation allowance against the Company’s U.S. federal, combined state and certain foreign net deferred tax assets. However, given the Company’s more recent earnings history, management believes that there is a reasonable possibility that within the next 12 months, sufficient positive evidence may become available to allow management to reach a conclusion that a significant portion of the valuation allowance will no longer be needed. Release of valuation allowance would result in the recognition of certain deferred tax assets with a corresponding decrease to income tax expense for the exceptionperiod the release is recorded. The exact timing and amount of an amount equal to its deferred tax liabilities, which can be expected to reverse over a definite life and certain foreign and separate state deferred tax assets. Management will continue to evaluate the necessity to maintain a valuation allowance againstrelease will be predicated on the Company’s net deferred tax assets.basis of the level of profitability that the Company is able to actually achieve. During fiscal 2017,2019, the Company recorded a net decrease in its federal valuation allowance of $47.8$3.6 million.

F-28

Table of Contents



At December 31, 2017,29, 2019, the Company had federal tax loss carryforwards of $390.7$307.8 million and various state tax loss carryforwards of $348.7$266.9 million. The federal tax loss carryforwards will begin to expire in 20202027 and state tax loss carryforwards will begin to expire in 20182020 in certain states. Additionally, the state capital loss carryforward generated in 2018 will begin to expire in 2023.
Federal and state income tax laws impose restrictions on the utilization of net operating losses (“NOLs”) and tax credit carryforwards in the event that an “ownership change” occurs for tax purposes, as defined by Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (“Section 382”). In general, an ownership change occurs when shareholders owning 5% or more of a “loss corporation” (a corporation entitled to use NOLs or other loss carryovers) have increased their ownership of stock in such corporation by more than 50 percentage points during any 3-year3-year period. The annual base Section 382 limitation is calculated by multiplying the loss corporation’s value at the time of the ownership change by the greater of the long-term tax-exempt rate determined by the Internal Revenue Service in the month of the ownership change or the two preceding months.


This base limitation is subject to adjustments, including an increase for built-in gains recognized in the five year period after the ownership change.
In Marchtax years 2010 anand 2011 the Company experienced a Section 382 “ownership change” occurred that will limit the utilization of NOL carryforwards. In July 2011, another “ownership change” occurred. The March 2010 ownership change limitation is more restrictive. InAdditionally, in prior years the Company acquired corporations with NOL carryforwards at the date of acquisition (“Acquired NOLs”). The Acquired NOLs are subject to separate limitations that may further restrict the use of Acquired NOLs. As a result, the Company’s federal annual utilization of NOL carryforwards was limited to at least $27.0 million a year for the five years succeeding the March 2010 ownership change and at least $11.6 million for each year thereafter subject to separate limitations for Acquired NOLs. If the entire limitation amount is not utilized in a year, the excess can be carried forward and utilized in future years. For the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, there was no impact of such Section 382 limitations on the income tax provision since the amount of taxable income did not exceed the annual limitation amount. However, future equity offerings or acquisitions that have equity as a component of the purchase price could also cause an “ownership change.” If and when any other “ownership change” occurs, utilization of the NOLs or other tax attributes may be further limited. As discussed elsewhere, deferred tax assets relating to the NOLs and credit carryforwards are offset by a full valuation allowance. In addition, utilization of state tax loss carryforwards is dependent upon sufficient taxable income apportioned to the states.
The Company has not provided deferred U.S. income taxes or foreign withholding taxes of approximately $7.7 million on temporary differences relating to the outside basis in its investment in foreign subsidiaries, which are essentially permanent in duration. As of December 31, 2017, all accumulated undistributed earnings of our foreign subsidiaries were subject to the one-time transition tax on foreign earnings required by the 2017 Tax Cuts and Jobs Act. It is the Company’s intention to permanently reinvest undistributed earnings of its foreign subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2017,such, the Company has $10.7not provided deferred U.S. income taxes or foreign withholding taxes of approximately $9.4 million on temporary differences relating to the outside basis in its investment in foreign subsidiaries. As of December 29, 2019, the Company has $24.6 million of cash and cash equivalents available for distribution.


The Company is subject to taxation in the U.S., various state tax jurisdictions and various foreign tax jurisdictions. The Company’s tax years for 2000 and later are subject to examination by the U.S. and state tax authorities due to the existence of NOL carryforwards. Generally, the Company’s tax years for 2002 and later are subject to examination by various foreign tax authorities, as well.


F-29

Table of Contents
During 2018 the Company was notified by the Internal Revenue Service that its federal income tax return for the calendar year ending December 27, 2015 had been selected for examination. The Company is currently awaiting a final determination letter from the Internal Revenue Service and does not anticipate any significant changes in tax liability to the year under audit.




The following table summarizes the activity related to the Company’s unrecognized tax benefits (in millions):


Balance as of December 25, 2016$18.6
Increases related to prior periods0.4
Increases related to current year tax positions1.1
Expiration of applicable statutes of limitations(0.6)
Decrease in federal tax rate(3.9)
Balance as of December 31, 201715.6
Increases related to prior periods0.5
Increases related to current year tax positions4.0
Expiration of applicable statutes of limitations(0.4)
Decreases related to prior year tax positions(0.3)
Decreases related to disposition(1.7)
Balance as of December 30, 201817.7
Increases related to prior periods0.2
Increases related to current year tax positions6.3
Expiration of applicable statutes of limitations(0.1)
Decreases related to settlement with tax authorities(0.1)
Balance as of December 29, 2019$24.0

Balance as of December 28, 2014$16.4
Increases related to prior periods (acquired entities)0.4
Increases related to current year tax positions0.9
Decreases related to disposition(0.5)
Balance as of December 27, 201517.2
Increases related to prior periods (acquired entities)1.4
Increases related to current year tax positions0.2
Expiration of applicable statutes of limitations(0.2)
Balance as of December 25, 201618.6
Increases related to prior periods0.4
Increases related to current year tax positions1.1
Expiration of applicable statutes of limitations(0.6)
Decrease in federal tax rate(3.9)
Balance as of December 31, 2017$15.6


Included in the balance of unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2017,29, 2019, are $15.6$24.0 million of tax benefits that, if recognized, would affect the effective tax rate. Included in this amount is $11.0$11.1 million that would become a deferred tax asset if the tax benefit were recognized. As such, this benefit may be impacted by a corresponding valuation allowance depending upon the Company’s consolidated financial positionassessment of the realizability of the deferred tax asset at the time the benefits are recognized.
 


The Company recognizes interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits in its provision for income taxes. For the years ended December 31, 2017, 29, 2019, December 25, 201630, 2018 and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, the Company recorded $0.5$1.3 million, $0.9$0.6 million, and $0.2$0.5 million, respectively, in interest or penalties.penalty expenses. These amounts are netted by a benefit for interest and penalties related to the reversal of prior positions as noted aboveand the disposition of $0.2PSS in the prior year of $0.1 million, $0.0$1.1 million, and $0.1$0.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, respectively. As of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, the Company had recordedaccrued total interest and penalties of $2.8 million, $1.6 million and $2.2 million, $1.9 million and $1.0 million, respectively.


The Company believes that it is reasonably possible that as much as $0.4$0.1 million of the liabilities for uncertain tax positions will expire within 12 months of December 31, 201729, 2019 due to the expiration of various applicable statues of limitations.


Note 8.9.     Discontinued Operations
 
On August 21, 2015,February 28, 2018, the Company entered into a Stock Purchase Agreement to sell the operations of Kratos Public Safety & Security Solutions, Inc., a Delaware corporation and wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (“PSS”), to Securitas Electronic Security, Inc., a Delaware corporation (“Buyer”). On June 11, 2018, the Company completed the sale of the U.S. and U.K. operations of its Electronic Products Division to Ultra Electronics Holdings plc (“Ultra”), a public limited company formed under the laws of England and Wales and traded on the London Stock Exchange, and Ultra Electronics Defense Inc. (the “Buyer”), a Delaware corporation ultimately owned by Ultra, (the “Transaction”). Pursuant to the terms of that certain Stock Purchase Agreement, dated May 31, 2015, by and among the Company, Ultra and the Buyer (the “Purchase Agreement”), the Company sold to the Buyer all of the issued and outstanding capital stock of its wholly owned subsidiary Herley Industries, Inc. (“Herley”) and certainPSS to Buyer for a purchase price of Herley’s subsidiaries, including Herley-CTI, Inc., EW Simulation Technology, Ltd. and Stapor Research, Inc. (collectively, the “Herley Entities”), for $260.0$69 million in cash, plus $5.0 million for taxes incurred as part of the Transaction, lesssubject to a $2.0 million escrow to satisfy any purchase price adjustments, and an estimatedclosing net working capital adjustment of $8.3(the “Transaction”). The Company and the Buyer are currently in a dispute regarding the closing net working capital adjustment. The amount in dispute is approximately $8 million. The Purchase Agreement also contains certain non-compete and indemnification provisions. Under the Purchase Agreement,To date, the Company entered into an agreement to indemnifyhas collected approximately $3.7 million of the Buyer for any pre-acquisition tax liabilities.retained net working capital. The Company also agreedcurrently expects that the remaining net working capital retained by the Company will be collected during 2020 once certain legacy projects are completed and the project close-out process has been completed. The Company currently expects to indemnify Ultra for pre-existing environmental conditions forrecognize a periodnet break-even on the sale of five years fromthe PSS business once the aggregate net proceeds described above have been collected excluding the impact of the final settlement and determination of the closing date and with a maximum indemnification payment of $34.0 million. The Company does not believe paymentsnet working capital adjustment. Any changes or adjustments to the expected net proceeds will be required under the indemnification provision, and the assessment of the fair value is immaterial. Under the terms of the Purchase Agreement, a joint 338(h)(10) election has been made for income tax purposes, providing a “step up”reflected in tax basis to Ultra. The Company incurred approximately $11.5 million in transaction-related costs. The gain on sale of $80.8 million is subject to changes in the indemnification obligations. future periods.

In accordance with ASC 360-10-45-9, Property, Plant, and Equipment (Topic(Topic 360) and ASC 205-20-45-3 Presentation of Financial Statements (Topic 205), the Herley Entities were classified asPSS and its subsidiaries have been reported in discontinued operations in the accompanying consolidated financial statements for all periods presented.

F-30

Table of Contents


Immediately prior to the closing of the Transaction, the outstanding shares of the capital stock of (i) General Microwave Corporation, a New York corporation, and its direct and indirect wholly owned subsidiaries General Microwave Israel Corporation, a Delaware corporation, General Microwave Israel (1987) Ltd., an Israeli company, and Herley GMI Eyal Ltd., an Israeli company, (ii) MSI Acquisition Corp., a Delaware corporation and its wholly owned subsidiary Micro Systems, Inc., a Florida corporation, and (iii) Herley-RSS, Inc., a Delaware corporation, were distributed as a dividend by Herley to the Company and continued their current operations as wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company.

In November 2015, the Company and Ultra settled the working capital adjustment at $8.1 million, and the net cash position at closing, resulting in a net payment to the Company of $2.7 million. This represents the payment from escrow to the Company of $2.0 million, as well as the payment from Ultra of $0.7 million, reflecting the difference in the estimated working capital and actual working capital and the net cash position at the close of the Transaction. In December 2015, the Company submitted to Ultra for reimbursement the maximum $5.0 million for taxes incurred as part of the Transaction, which was reimbursed in January 2016.


The following table presents the results of discontinued operations (in millions):

 Year ended December 29, 2019 Year ended December 30, 2018 Year ended December 31, 2017
Revenue$0.3
 $44.2
 $149.9
Cost of sales0.9
 34.2
 110.1
Selling, general and administrative expenses1.1
 16.7
 33.6
Other (income) expense items that are not major(3.6) 2.7
 (0.1)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes1.9
 (9.4) 6.3
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations before income taxes
 
 
Total gain (loss) of discontinued operations before income taxes1.9
 (9.4) 6.3
Income tax (benefit) expense0.2
 (1.8) 2.1
Income (loss) from discontinued operations$1.7
 $(7.6) $4.2


 Year ended December 31, 2017 Year ended December 25, 2016 Year ended December 27, 2015
Revenue$
 $
 $59.7
Cost of sales
��
 40.6
Selling, general and administrative expenses
 0.1
 15.2
Interest expense, net
 
 9.1
Other net income (expense) items that are not major
 
 0.1
Loss from discontinued operations before income taxes
 (0.1) (5.3)
Gain on disposal of discontinued operations before income taxes
 
 80.8
Total gain (loss) of discontinued operations before income taxes
 (0.1) 75.5
Income tax expense0.1
 
 22.5
Income (loss) from discontinued operations$(0.1) $(0.1) $53.0

TheRevenue and operating results for the year ended December 27,29, 2019 reflect the performance on the contracts and working capital retained by the Company. Included in the year ended December 29, 2019, is a $3.6 million gain recorded as a result of the release of an indemnification liability following the lapse of the statute of limitations associated with a potential tax liability that was recorded in 2015 are throughas part of the dateprevious sale of disposal of August 21, 2015.

There was $4.2our Electronic Products Division. Discontinued operations for year ended December 30, 2018 were impacted by approximately $2.0 million of depreciationcost adjustments on certain security system deployment projects for a mass transit authority. Transaction expenses of $2.7 million, primarily comprised of investment advisory fees, legal fees, and amortization expenseother direct transaction expenses related to the Transaction, were included in selling, general and administrative expensesOther (income) expense items that are not major for the year ended December 27, 2015.30, 2018. Depreciation expense included in Selling, general and administrative expenses was $0.0 million, $0.1 million and $0.3 million for the years ended December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018, and December 31, 2017 respectively.


Interest expense is included based on an allocation consistent with the redemption of $175.0 million of the Notes and the repayment of $41.0 million in outstanding borrowings on the Credit Agreement that was repaid upon the completion of the sale of the Herley Entities in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Indenture and the Credit Agreement. Refer to Note 4 for further discussion.


Intra-period tax allocation rules require the Company to allocate its provision for income taxes between continuing operations and other categories of earnings, suchearnings. Upon closing of the PSS sale, amounts historically carried as discontinued operations. In periodsunrecognized tax benefits were reclassified to guarantor liability in which there isaccordance with ASC 460. As a year-to-date pre-tax loss from continuing operations and pre-tax income in other categoriesresult of earnings, such as discontinued operations, the Company must allocate the tax provision to the other categories of earnings. A related tax benefit is then recorded in continuing operations. Due to the intra-period allocation rules,reclassification, the Company recorded incomea $2.1 million tax expense of $0.1 million and $22.5 million in discontinued operations for the years ended December 31, 2017, and December 27, 2015, respectively. There was no income tax recordedbenefit in discontinued operations for the year ended December 25, 2016.30, 2018.


F-31

Table of Contents


The following is a summary of the assets and liabilities of discontinued operations as of December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 201630, 2018 (in millions):

 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018
Accounts receivable, net3.3
 8.2
Other current assets
 0.1
Current assets of discontinued operations$3.3
 $8.3
Accounts payable$0.2
 $0.3
Accrued expenses0.3
 0.4
Other current liabilities2.8
 4.6
Current liabilities of discontinued operations$3.3
 $5.3
Other long-term liabilities of discontinued operations$2.8
 $6.4

 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016
Accrued compensation$
 $0.6
Other current liabilities1.1
 1.0
Current liabilities of discontinued operations$1.1
 $1.6
Other long-term liabilities of discontinued operations$3.8
 $3.7


Note 9.10.     Fair Value Measurement
 
ASC Topic 820, Fair Value Measurement, establishes a valuation hierarchy for disclosure of the inputs to valuation used to measure fair value. This hierarchy prioritizes the inputs into three broad levels as follows. Level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 2 inputs are quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets or inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly through market corroboration, for substantially the full term of the financial instrument. Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs based on the Company’s own assumptions used to measure assets and liabilities at fair value. A financial asset or liability’s classification within the hierarchy is determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement.


Note 10.11.    Stockholders’ Equity
 
(a)    Common Stock


On November 23, 2016, the Company sold approximately 13.4 million shares of its common stock at a purchase price of $6.00 per share in an underwritten public offering. The Company received gross proceeds of approximately $80.5 million. After deducting underwriting fees and other offering expenses, the Company received approximately $76.2 million in net proceeds. The Company used $14.1 million of the net proceeds from this transaction to redeem approximately $14.5 million of its Notes.
On March 7, 2017 and September 12, 2017, the Company sold approximately 11.9 million and 16.1 million, respectively, shares of common stock at a purchase price of $7.25 and $12.25, respectively, per share in underwritten public offerings. The Company received gross proceeds of approximately $283.5 million. After deducting underwriting fees and other offering expenses, the Company received approximately $269.1 million in net proceeds. The Company used the net proceeds to repurchase and extinguish $135.5 million of its outstanding 7% Notes.


The remainder of the funds will be used for general corporate purposes, including funding expected growth and strategic investments in the Company’s high performance unmanned aerial vehicle business area and other new programs under contract.

(b)Stock Option Plans and Restricted Stock Unit Plans


In March 2014 the Company’s board of directors (the “Board”) approved the 2014 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2014 Plan”). The 2014 Plan is the successor to the Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. 2011 Equity Incentive Plan, the Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. Amended and Restated 2005 Equity Incentive Plan, the Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. 2000 Nonstatutory Stock Option Plan, the Kratos Defense & Security Solutions, Inc. 1999 Equity Incentive Plan, the Amended and Restated Integral Systems, Inc. 2008 Stock Incentive Plan, the Amended and Restated Herley Industries, Inc. 2010 Stock Plan, the Herley Industries, Inc. 2003 Stock Option Plan, the Henry Bros. Electronics, Inc. 2007 Stock Option Plan, the Henry Bros. Electronics, Inc. 2006 Stock Option Plan, the Amended and Restated 2005 Digital Fusion, Inc. Equity Incentive Plan, the 2000 Digital Fusion, Inc. Stock Option Plan, the 1999 Digital Fusion, Inc. Stock Option Plan, and the 1998 Digital Fusion, Inc. Stock Option Plan (collectively, the “Prior Plans”).


The 2014 Plan became effective May 14, 2014 and no0 additional stock awards will be granted under the Prior Plans as of April 1, 2014. All outstanding stock awards granted subject to the terms of the Prior Plans will continue to be subject to the terms and conditions as set forth in the agreements evidencing such stock awards and the terms of the respective Prior Plans. Any shares subject to outstanding stock awards granted under the Prior Plans or granted outside of a Prior Plan that, at any time after March 27, 2014, (i) expire or terminate for any reason prior to exercise or settlement; (ii) are forfeited, canceled or otherwise returned to the Company because of the failure to meet a contingency or condition required to vest such shares; or

F-32

Table of Contents


(iii) are reacquired, withheld (or not issued) to satisfy a tax withholding obligation in connection with an award or to satisfy the purchase price or exercise price of a stock award (collectively, the “Returning Shares”) will immediately be added to the share reserve of the 2014 Plan and become available for issuance pursuant to stock awards granted under the 2014 Plan.


As of March 27, 2014, there were 2,306,256 shares remaining available for issuance under the Prior Plans. The total number of awards outstanding under all of the Prior Plans and outside of any Prior Plan was 5,511,322 as of March 27, 2014. The 2014 Plan decreased the number of shares remaining available for issuance under its equity compensation plans from 2,306,256 to 1,550,000, although, per the 2014 Plan, up to 5,511,322 shares subject to outstanding awards under the Prior Plans and non-plan grants could potentially become Returning Shares available for issuance under the 2014 Plan. In May 2017, the Company’s shareholders approved an amendment to the 2014 Plan to increase the aggregate number of shares that may be issued under the plan by 2,500,000 shares.


The Board may grant equity-based awards to selected employees, directors and consultants of the Company pursuant to its 2014 Plan. As of December 31, 201729, 2019, there were 3,954,9121,736,561 shares reserved for issuance for future grant under the 2014 Plan. The Board may amend or terminate the 2014 Plan at any time. Certain amendments, including an increase in the share reserve, require stockholder approval. Generally, options and restricted stock units outstanding vest over periods not exceeding ten years. When the Company grants stock options, they are granted with a per share exercise price not less than the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the date of grant, and generally would be exercisable for up to ten years from the grant date.


The Company records compensation expense for employee stock options based on the estimated fair value of the options on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model or a trinomial lattice options pricing model with the weighted average assumptions (annualized percentages) included in the following table. Awards with graded vesting are recognized using the straight-line method with the following assumptions:


 2019 2018 2017
Stock Options     
Expected life10.0 10.0 10.0
Risk-free interest rate(1)2.5% - 2.6% 2.9% - 3.2% 2.2% - 2.5%
Volatility(2)47.5% - 49.1% 52.9% - 53.4% 53.8% - 55.0%
Forfeiture rate(3)5.1% 5.1% 5.0%
Dividend yield(4)—% —% —%

 2017 2016 2015
Stock Options     
Expected life10.0 10.0 10.0
Risk-free interest rate(1)2.2% - 2.5% 1.8% - 2.4% 2.1% - 2.3%
Volatility(2)53.8% - 55.0% 55.2% - 55.8% 54.4% - 54.7%
Forfeiture rate(3)5.0% 5.0% 5.0%
Dividend yield(4)—% —% —%


(1) The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury yields in effect at the time of grant with a term equal to the expected term of the options.
(2) In 2017, 20162019, 2018, and 2015,2017, the Company estimated implied volatility based upon trailing volatility.
(3) Forfeitures are estimated at the time of grant based upon historical information. Forfeitures will be revised, if necessary, in subsequent periods if actual forfeitures differ from estimates.
(4) The Company has no history or expectation of paying dividends on its common stock.


A summary of the status of the Company’s stock option plan as of December 31, 2017,29, 2019, and changes in options outstanding under the plan for the year ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, is as follows:


  
Number of
Shares Under Option
 Weighted-Average Exercise Price per Share 
Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
(in years)
 Aggregate Intrinsic Value
  (000’s)     (000’s)
Options outstanding at December 30, 2018 768
 $5.17
 4.2 $6,587.5
Granted 2
 $16.81
    
Exercised (619) $5.23
    
Forfeited or expired (5) $7.87
    
Options outstanding at December 29, 2019 146
 $4.98
 3.0 $1,866.3
Options exercisable at December 29, 2019 146
 $4.98
 3.0 $1,866.3
  
Number of
Shares Under Option
 Weighted-Average Exercise Price per Share 
Weighted-
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
(in years)
 Aggregate Intrinsic Value
  (000’s)     (000’s)
Options outstanding at December 25, 2016 963
 $8.05
 5.2 $1,924.1
Granted 7
 $9.78
    
Exercised (49) $8.85
    
Forfeited or expired (22) $16.40
    
Options outstanding at December 31, 2017 899
 $7.82
 4.4 4,224.8
Options exercisable at December 31, 2017 322
 $12.91
 3.4 $965.6


F-33

Table of Contents




As of December 31, 2017, there was $0.1 million of total unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to nonvested options, which is expected to be recognized over a remaining weighted-average vesting period of .5 years. Upon exercise of an option, the Company issues new shares of common stock.


During the years ended December 31, 2017,29, 2019, December 25, 2016,30, 2018, and December 27, 201531, 2017, the following values relate to the grants and exercises under the Company’s option plans:


 2019 2018 2017
Weighted average grant date fair value of options granted$10.25
 $7.54
 $6.39
Total intrinsic value of options exercised (in thousands)$8,874.9
 $40.6
 $67.1

 2017 2016 2015
Weighted average grant date fair value of options granted$6.39
 $3.36
 $3.31
Total intrinsic value of options exercised (in thousands)$67.1
 $
 $


The following table summarizes the Company’s Restricted Stock Unit activity:


  Restricted
Stock Units
(000’s)
 Weighted-Average Grant Date Fair Value
Nonvested balance at December 30, 2018 3,293
 $8.22
Grants 1,147
 $13.86
Vested (228) $15.22
Vested but not released (163) $9.29
Nonvested balance at December 29, 2019 4,049
 $9.38

  Restricted
Stock Units
(000’s)
 Weighted-Average Grant Date Fair Value
Nonvested balance at December 25, 2016 2,246
 $6.81
Grants 1,180
 $7.45
Vested (841) $7.48
Forfeitures (20) $7.28
Vested but not released (307) $7.24
Nonvested balance at December 31, 2017 2,258
 $6.83


As of December 31, 201729, 2019, there was $7.2$19.2 million of total unrecognized stock-based compensation expense related to nonvested restricted stock units which is expected to be recognized over a remaining weighted-average vesting period of 3.12.2 years. The fair value of restricted stock unit awards that vested in 2017, 20162019, 2018, and 20152017 was $3.5 million, $0.8 million, and $6.3 million, $4.7 million, and $3.6 million, respectively.


(c)Amended and Restated Employee Stock Purchase Plan


In August 1999, the Board approved the 1999 Employee Stock Purchase Plan (as amended from time to time, the “Purchase Plan”). A total of 5,200,000 shares of common stock had been previously approved for reservation of the Company’s common stock for purchase by employees under the Purchase Plan. In May 2017, the Company’s shareholders approved an amendment to the Purchase Plan to increase the maximum number of shares of common stock that may be issued under the Purchase Plan by 3,000,000 shares. The Purchase Plan qualifies as an employee stock purchase plan within the meaning of Section 423 of the Internal Revenue Service Code. Unless otherwise determined by the Compensation Committee of the Board, all employees are eligible to participate in the Purchase Plan, so long as they are employed by the Company (or a subsidiary designated by the Board) for at least 20 hours per week and were customarily employed by the Company (or a subsidiary designated by the Board) for at least 5 months per calendar year.


Employees who actively participate in the Purchase Plan are eligible to have up to 15% of their earnings for each purchase period withheld pursuant to the Purchase Plan. The amount that is withheld is used at various purchase dates within the offering period to purchase shares of common stock. The price paid for common stock at each such purchase date is equal to the lower of 85% of the fair market value of the common stock at the commencement date of that offering period or 85% of the fair market value of the common stock on the relevant purchase date. Employees are also able to end their participation in the offering at any time during the offering period, and participation ends automatically upon termination of employment. From the Purchase Plan’s inception through December 31, 2017,29, 2019, the cumulative number of shares of common stock that have been issued under the Purchase Plan is 5.05.5 million and approximately 3.22.7 million shares are available for future issuance. During fiscal 2017,2019, approximately 870,000356,000 shares were issued under the plan at an average price of $5.65.$10.79.





F-34

Table of Contents

The fair value of Kratos’ Purchase Plan shares for 20172019 was estimated using the Black-Scholes option pricing model. The assumptions and resulting fair values of options granted for 2017, 20162019, 2018 and 20152017 were as follows:


Offering
Periods
January 1 to
December 31
2017
 
Offering
Periods
January 1 to
December 31,
2016
 
Offering
Periods
January 1 to
December 31,
2015
Offering
Periods
January 1 to
December 31
2019
 
Offering
Periods
January 1 to
December 31,
2018
 
Offering
Periods
January 1 to
December 31,
2017
Expected term (in years)(1)0.5 0.5 0.50.5 0.5 0.5
Risk-free interest rate(2).62% - 1.14% 0.36% - 0.49% 0.11% - 0.12%2.09% - 2.56% 1.53% - 2.11% 0.62% - 1.14%
Expected volatility(3)44.38% - 53.70% 53.00% - 55.55% 39.63% - 40.91%37.22% - 43.70% 40.24% - 44.83% 44.38% - 53.70%
Expected dividend yield(4)—% —% —%—% —% —%
Weighted average grant-date fair value per share$2.51 $1.23 $1.43$4.74 $3.03 $2.51


(1)The expected term is equivalent to the offering period.
(2)The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury yields in effect at the time of grant with a term equal to the expected term.
(3)    The Company estimated implied volatility based upon trailing volatility.
(4)    The Company has no history or expectation of paying dividends on its common stock.


As of December 31, 201729, 2019, there was no material unrecognized compensation expense related to the Purchase Plan.


Note 11.12.    Retirement Plans


The Company provides eligible employees the opportunity to participate in defined-contribution savings plans (commonly known as 401(k) plans), which permit contributions on a before-tax basis. Generally, salaried employees and certain hourly employees are eligible to participate in the plans. Under most plans, the employee may contribute to various investment alternatives. In certain plans, the Company matches a portion of the employees’ contributions. The Company’s matching contributions to these defined-contribution savings plans totaled $4.7$4.4 million in 2017, $4.32019, $3.9 million in 20162018, and $4.9$3.8 million in 2015.2017.


Note 12.13.    Significant Customers
 
Revenue from the U.S. Government (which includes Foreign Military Sales) includes revenue from contracts for which the Company is the prime contractor as well as those for which the Company is a subcontractor and the ultimate customer is the U.S. Government. The KGS and US segments have substantial revenue from the U.S. Government. Sales to the U.S. Government amounted to approximately $452.8$507.4 million, $398.3$447.0 million, and $402.9$451.9 million or 60%71%, 60%72%, and 61%75%, of total revenue for the years ended December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018, and December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015, respectively. 
 
Note 13.14.    Segment Information
 
The Company operates in three2 reportable segments. The KGS reportable segment is comprised of an aggregation of KGS operating segments, including defenseDRSS, ME, TTS, MS, and rocket support services, microwave electronic products and satellite communications, technical and training solutions, and modular systems operating segments.KTT. The US reportable segment consists of the Company’s unmanned aerial, unmanned ground, unmanned seaborne and command, control and communications system business. The KGS and US segments provide products, solutions and services for mission critical national security programs. KGS and US customers primarily include national security related agencies, the DoD, intelligence agencies and classified agencies, and to a lesser degree, international government agencies and domestic and international commercial customers. The PSS segment designs, engineers, deploys, operates, integrates into command and control infrastructure, maintains and operates security and surveillance solutions for homeland security, public safety, critical infrastructure, government and commercial customers. PSS customers include those in the critical infrastructure, power generation, power transport, nuclear energy, financial, IT, healthcare, education, transportation and petro-chemical industries, as well as certain government and military customers.


The Company organizes its reportable segments based on the nature of the products, solutions and services offered. Transactions between segments are generally negotiated and accounted for under terms and conditions similar to other government and commercial contracts. In the following table total operating income (loss) from continuing operations of the reportable business segments is reconciled to the corresponding consolidated amount. The reconciling item “unallocated

F-35

Table of Contents

corporate expense, net” includes costs for certain stock-based compensation programs (including stock-based compensation costs for stock options, employee stock purchase plan and restricted stock units), the effects of items not considered part of management’s evaluation of segment operating performance, merger and acquisition expenses, corporate costs not allocated to the segments, and other miscellaneous corporate activities.



As discussed in “Discontinued Operations” in Note 89 of these notes to consolidated financial statements, the Company began reporting the Herley EntitiesPSS business as discontinued operations effective in the secondfirst quarter of fiscal 2015.2018. Prior to the decision to sell the Herley Entities,PSS business, the Company reported their financial results in the KGSa separate PSS reportable segment. Accordingly, segment results have been recast for 2015 to reflect the disposition of the Herley Entities as discontinued operations.


As certain overhead type costs previously allocated to the Herley EntitiesPSS business were not allocable to discontinued operations, prior period corporate costs have been reallocated amongst the continuing reportable segments.

F-36

Table of Contents




Revenues, operating income (loss) and assets disclosed below provided by the Company’s reportable segments for the years ended December 31, 2017, 29, 2019, December 25, 201630, 2018, and December 27, 2015,31, 2017, are as follows (in millions):


 2019 2018 2017
Revenues:     
Kratos Government Solutions     
Service revenues$272.6
 $200.7
 $197.8
Product sales283.5
 284.4
 283.8
Total Kratos Government Solutions556.1
 485.1
 481.6
Unmanned Systems     
Service revenues
 
 
Product sales161.4
 132.9
 121.7
Total Unmanned Systems161.4
 132.9
 121.7
Total revenues$717.5
 $618.0
 $603.3
Depreciation and amortization:     
Kratos Government Solutions$18.2
 $13.2
 $14.4
Unmanned Systems5.2
 4.7
 7.8
Total depreciation and amortization$23.4
 $17.9
 $22.2
Operating income (loss):     
Kratos Government Solutions$45.2
 $35.5
 $(0.1)
Unmanned Systems6.1
 5.1
 (3.6)
Corporate activities(13.3) (10.1) (8.3)
Total operating income (loss)$38.0
 $30.5
 $(12.0)
 2017 2016 2015
Revenues:     
Kratos Government Solutions     
Service revenues$196.5
 $221.0
 $209.5
Product sales283.8
 244.8
 236.6
Total Kratos Government Solutions480.3
 465.8
 446.1
Public Safety & Security     
Service revenues149.9
 127.1
 144.7
Product sales
 
 
Total Public Safety & Security149.9
 127.1
 144.7
Unmanned Systems     
Service revenues
 
 
Product sales121.7
 75.8
 66.3
Total Unmanned Systems121.7
 75.8
 66.3
Total revenues$751.9
 $668.7
 $657.1
Depreciation and amortization:     
Kratos Government Solutions$14.3
 $14.9
 $18.2
Public Safety & Security0.4
 0.5
 0.6
Unmanned Systems7.8
 7.4
 6.7
Total depreciation and amortization$22.5
 $22.8
 $25.5
Operating income (loss) from continuing operations:     
Kratos Government Solutions$1.7
 $17.3
 $16.1
Public Safety & Security3.8
 (3.0) 2.6
Unmanned Systems(3.0) (27.7) (16.2)
Corporate activities(8.3) (5.2) (7.0)
Total operating loss from continuing operations$(5.8) $(18.6) $(4.5)

 
Revenues from foreign customers were approximately $132.5 million or 18%, $114.3 million or 19% and $84.7 million or 11%, $80.1 million or 12% and $73.2 million or 11%14% of total revenue for the years ended December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018, and December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016, and December 27, 2015, respectively.

Included in the 2016 operating losses for the US reportable segment is an $18.7 million loss accrual recorded on the Air Force Research Laboratory (“AFRL”) Low-Cost Attritable Strike UAS Demonstration (“LCASD”) cost share contract awarded in July 2016. Included in the 2015 operating losses for the US reportable segment are increased costs of $5.7 million, primarily related to certain retrofits necessary to address product design changes as well as due to a contract conversion adjustment on certain of the Company’s aerial platforms.

Included in the 2016 operating losses for the PSS reportable segment is a $1.9 million charge related to the settlement
of a contract dispute and $4.1 million in unexpected cost growth on several large long-term security integration projects which
are nearing completion.


Included in the 2017 operating loss for the KGS reportable segment is a $24.2 million impairment of the carrying value of the goodwill of the DRSS business within the KGS segment.

Included in the 2016 operating income for the KGS reportable segment is a $9.2 million charge that was recorded in the Company’s modular systems business as a result of the closure of one of its manufacturing facilities, and the exit from certain lower margin product business lines.


F-37

Table of Contents


Reportable segment assets are as follows (in millions):
 December 29, 2019 December 30, 2018 December 31, 2017
Assets:     
Kratos Government Solutions$777.6
 $602.8
 $597.9
Unmanned Systems246.3
 220.9
 201.9
Discontinued operations3.3
 8.3
 97.4
Corporate activities158.8
 178.1
 126.8
Total assets$1,186.0
 $1,010.1
 $1,024.0

 December 31, 2017 December 25, 2016 December 27, 2015
Assets:     
Kratos Government Solutions$597.9
 $609.8
 $606.8
Unmanned Systems201.9
 172.1
 162.0
Public Safety & Security97.4
 92.0
 96.8
Corporate activities126.8
 74.7
 37.7
Total assets$1,024.0
 $948.6
 $903.3


Assets of foreign subsidiaries in the KGS segment were $116.7$124.7 million, $113.7$126.7 million and $106.2$116.7 million as of December 29, 2019, December 30, 2018 and December 31, 2017, December 25, 2016 and December 27, 2015, respectively.


Note 14.15.    Commitments and Contingencies


In addition to commitments and obligations in the ordinary course of business, the Company is subject to various claims, pending and potential legal actions for damages, investigations relating to governmental laws and regulations and other matters arising out of the normal conduct of the Company’s business. The Company assesses contingencies to determine the degree of probability and range of possible loss for potential accrual in its consolidated financial statements. An estimated loss contingency is accrued in the Company’s consolidated financial statements if it is probable that a liability has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. Because litigation is inherently unpredictable and unfavorable resolutions


could occur, assessing litigation contingencies is highly subjective and requires judgments about future events. When evaluating contingencies, the Company may be unable to provide a meaningful estimate due to a number of factors, including but not limited to the procedural status of the matter in question, the presence of complex or novel legal theories, and the ongoing discovery and development of information important to the matters. In addition, damage amounts claimed in litigation against it may be unsupported, exaggerated or unrelated to possible outcomes, and as such are not meaningful indicators of its potential liability. The Company regularly reviews contingencies to determine the adequacy of its accruals and related disclosures. The amount of ultimate loss may differ from these estimates. It is possible that cash flows or results of operations could be materially affected in any particular period by the unfavorable resolution of one or more of these contingencies. Whether any losses finally determined in any claim, action, investigation or proceeding could reasonably have a material effect on the Company’s business, financial condition, results of operations or cash flows will depend on a number of variables, including: the timing and amount of such losses; the structure and type of any remedies; the monetary significance any such losses, damages or remedies may have on the consolidated financial statements; and the unique facts and circumstances of the particular matter that may give rise to additional factors.


Legal and Regulatory Matters.
U.S. Government Cost Claims


The Company’s contracts with the DoD are subject to audit by the Defense Contract Audit Agency (“DCAA”).DCAA. As a result of these audits, from time to time the Company is advised of claims concerning potential disallowed, overstated or disputed costs. For example, during the course of recent audits of the Company’s contracts, the DCAA is closely examining and questioning certain of the established and disclosed practices that it had previously audited and accepted. Costs incurred and allocated to contracts with the U.S. Government are regularly scrutinized for compliance with regulatory standards by the Company’s personnel. On July 28, 2015, the Company received a determination letter from Defense Contract Management Agency (“DCMA”) regarding what DCMA believed were certain unallowable costs for one of the Company’s subsidiaries with respect to fiscal year 2007. In April 2016, the Company reached agreement with the DCAA to settle matters related to unallowable costs for this subsidiary for fiscal years 2007 and 2008 for approximately $0.2 million. For those Company subsidiaries and fiscal years which have not yet been audited by the DCAA or for those audits which are in process which have not been completed by the DCAA, the Company cannot reasonably estimate the range of loss, if any, that may result from audits and reviews in which it is currently involved given the inherent difficulty in predicting regulatory action, fines and penalties, if any, and the various remedies and levels of judicial review available to the Company in the event of an adverse finding. As a result, the Company has not recorded any liability related to these matters.


F-38

Table of Contents


Other Litigation Matters


The Company is subject to normal and routine litigation arising from the ordinary course and conduct of business, and, at times, as a result of acquisitions and dispositions. Such disputes include, for example, commercial, employment, intellectual property, environmental and securities matters. The aggregate amounts accrued related to these matters are not material to the total liabilities of the Company. The Company intends to defend itself in any such matters and does not currently believe that the outcome of any such matters will have a material adverse impact on its financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.




Note 15.16.     Redeemable Noncontrolling Interest


As discussed in “Acquisition” in Note 2, in connection with the Company’s acquisition of FTT, (i) beginning in January 2024, the Holders will have an annual Put Right to sell all of the Minority Interests to the Company at a purchase price based on a specified multiple of the trailing 12 months EBITDA of the Acquired Companies, subject to adjustment as set forth in the Exchange Agreement (provided, however, that following certain events, including a change of control, the Put Right will be accelerated and the Minority Interest Purchase Price will be a specified increased multiple of the trailing 12 months EBITDA of the Acquired Companies); and (ii) beginning in January 2025, the Company will have an annual right to purchase all of the Minority Interests from the Holders at the Minority Interest Purchase Price.

The Company adjusts the carrying value of such redeemable noncontrolling interest based on an allocation of subsidiary earnings based on ownership interest. Redeemable noncontrolling interest is recorded outside of permanent equity at the higher of its carrying value or management’s estimate of the amount (the “Redemption Amount”) that the Company could be required to pay in connection with the Put Rights. Adjustments to Redemption Amount will have a corresponding effect on net income per share attributable to Kratos shareholders. As of December 29, 2019, no adjustment of the carrying value of the redeemable noncontrolling interest was required.



Note 17.     Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)


The following financial information reflects all normal and recurring adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results of the interim periods. As discussed in “Discontinued Operations” in Note 9 of these notes to consolidated financial statements, the Company began reporting the PSS business as discontinued operations effective in the first quarter of fiscal 2018. Accordingly, the financial results for the PSS business have been reported in discontinued operations for all periods presented.

Summarized quarterly data for the years ended December 31, 201729, 2019 and December 25, 2016,30, 2018, is as follows (in millions, except per share data):


 First Quarter Second Quarter Third Quarter Fourth Quarter
Fiscal year 2017       
Revenues$167.8
 $185.7
 $196.2
 $202.2
Gross profit45.1
 47.4
 48.1
 56.7
Operating income (loss) from continuing operations1.7
 2.6
 3.1
 (13.2)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes1.5
 1.8
 0.2
 (11.7)
Loss from continuing operations(9.9) (6.2) (4.2) (22.3)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations(0.1) 
 (0.1) 0.1
Net loss$(10.0) $(6.2) $(4.3) $(22.2)
Basic loss per common share:       
   Loss from continuing operations$(0.13) $(0.07) $(0.05) $(0.21)
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations$
 $
 $
 $
     Net loss per common share$(0.13) $(0.07) $(0.05) $(0.21)
Diluted loss per common share:       
   Loss from continuing operations$(0.13) $(0.07) $(0.05) $(0.21)
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations$
 $
 $
 $
     Net loss per common share$(0.13) $(0.07) $(0.05) $(0.21)
 First Quarter Second Quarter Third Quarter Fourth Quarter
Fiscal year 2019       
Revenues$160.4
 $187.9
 $184.1
 $185.1
Gross profit44.9
 48.1
 48.6
 48.4
Operating income8.2
 9.0
 11.5
 9.3
Provision (benefit) for income taxes(1.5) 2.5
 2.8
 1.0
Income from continuing operations3.7
 1.3
 2.6
 3.3
Income (loss) from discontinued operations(0.6) 3.0
 
 (0.7)
Net income$3.1
 $4.3
 $2.6
 $2.6
Less: Net income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interest
 0.4
 0.1
 (0.4)
Net income attributable to Kratos3.1
 3.9
 2.5
 3.0
Basic income (loss) per common share attributable to Kratos:       
   Income from continuing operations$0.04
 $0.01
 $0.02
 $0.03
   Income (loss) from discontinued operations$(0.01) $0.03
 $
 $
     Net income per common share$0.03
 $0.04
 $0.02
 $0.03
Diluted income per common share attributable to Kratos:       
   Income from continuing operations$0.03
 $0.01
 $0.02
 $0.03
   Income from discontinued operations$
 $0.03
 $
 $
     Net income per common share$0.03
 $0.04
 $0.02
 $0.03

In the fourth quarter of 2017, the Company recorded an impairment of $24.2 million of the carrying value of the goodwill related to its DRSS reporting unit within its KGS reportable segment. The Company also recorded a $15.2 million loss on extinguishment of debt in the fourth quarter of 2017 related to the redemption and extinguishment of the Company’s 7% Notes.


F-39
 First Quarter Second Quarter Third Quarter Fourth Quarter
Fiscal year 2018       
Revenues$143.0
 $151.2
 $159.4
 $164.4
Gross profit40.8
 39.3
 44.1
 45.5
Operating income7.0
 2.6
 10.1
 10.8
Provision for income taxes0.9
 0.1
 3.4
 0.2
Income (loss) from continuing operations1.3
 (3.8) 1.4
 5.2
Income (loss) from discontinued operations(3.5) (3.9) 0.3
 (0.5)
Net income (loss)$(2.2) $(7.7) $1.7
 $4.7
Basic income (loss) per common share:       
�� Income (loss) from continuing operations$0.01
 $(0.04) $0.01
 $0.05
  Income (loss) from discontinued operations$(0.03) $(0.03) $0.01
 $
     Net income (loss) per common share$(0.02) $(0.07) $0.02
 $0.05
Diluted income (loss) per common share:       
  Income (loss) from continuing operations$0.01
 $(0.04) $0.01
 $0.05
  Income (loss) from discontinued operations$(0.03) $(0.03) $0.01
 $(0.01)
     Net income (loss) per common share$(0.02) $(0.07) $0.02
 $0.04

Table of Contents




 First Quarter Second Quarter Third Quarter Fourth Quarter
Fiscal year 2016       
Revenues$153.0
 $168.2
 $165.4
 $182.1
Gross profit35.9
 45.2
 25.9
 46.6
Operating income (loss) from continuing operations(10.2) 
 (13.0) 4.6
Provision for income taxes3.6
 1.8
 1.9
 0.8
Loss from continuing operations(22.2) (10.3) (23.5) (4.4)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations
 (0.1) (0.1) 0.1
Net loss$(22.2) $(10.4) $(23.6) $(4.3)
Basic loss per common share:       
  Loss from continuing operations$(0.37) $(0.17) $(0.39) $(0.07)
  Income (loss) from discontinued operations$
 $
 $
 $
     Net loss per common share$(0.37) $(0.17) $(0.39) $(0.07)
Diluted loss per common share:       
  Loss from continuing operations$(0.37) $(0.17) $(0.39) $(0.07)
  Income (loss) from discontinued operations$
 $
 $
 $
     Net loss per common share$(0.37) $(0.17) $(0.39) $(0.07)

In the first, second, third, and fourth quarters of 2016, the Company recorded restructuring charges of $3.0 million, $4.7 million, $0.1 million, and $1.4 million, respectively, related to the closure of one of its facilities for its modular systems business and exit from certain lower margin product lines. In the third quarter of 2016, the Company recorded an $18.7 million loss accrual recorded on the AFRL LCASD cost share contract awarded in July 2016.



Note 16.     Condensed Consolidating Financial Statements

The Company has $300.0 million in outstanding 6.5% Notes (see Note 4). The 6.5% Notes are guaranteed by the Subsidiary Guarantors and are collateralized by the assets of certain of the Company’s 100% owned subsidiaries. The 6.5% Notes are fully and unconditionally guaranteed on a joint and several basis by each guarantor subsidiary and the Company. There are no contractual restrictions limiting cash transfers from guarantor subsidiaries by dividends, loans or advances to the Company. The 6.5% Notes are not guaranteed by the Company’s foreign subsidiaries (the “Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries”).

The following tables present condensed consolidating financial statements for the parent company, the Subsidiary Guarantors and the Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries, respectively, for 2017, 2016, and 2015. The consolidating financial information below follows the same accounting policies as described in the consolidated financial statements, except for the use of the equity method of accounting to reflect ownership interests in wholly-owned subsidiaries, which are eliminated upon consolidation.



F-40

Table of Contents


Note 18.     Subsequent Events
Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet
December 31, 2017
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Assets         
Current Assets:         
  Cash and cash equivalents$121.1
 $(2.2) $10.7
 $
 $129.6
  Accounts receivable, net
 239.9
 28.5
 
 268.4
  Amounts due from affiliated companies238.1
 
 
 (238.1) 
  Inventoried costs
 32.2
 18.2
 
 50.4
  Other current assets3.9
 15.6
 3.4
 
 22.9
    Total current assets363.1
 285.5
 60.8
 (238.1) 471.3
Property, plant and equipment, net1.9
 52.5
 6.8
 
 61.2
Goodwill
 418.3
 42.9
 
 461.2
Intangible assets, net
 15.8
 6.2
 
 22.0
Investment in subsidiaries471.1
 70.0
 
 (541.1) 
Other assets0.8
 7.5
 
 
 8.3
    Total assets$836.9
 $849.6
 $116.7
 $(779.2) $1,024.0
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity         
Current liabilities:         
  Accounts payable$2.3
 $42.0
 $4.5
 $
 $48.8
  Accrued expenses5.7
 38.3
 3.3
 
 47.3
  Accrued compensation5.6
 25.3
 3.9
 
 34.8
Billings in excess of costs and earnings on uncompleted contracts
 42.6
 4.6
 
 47.2
  Amounts due to affiliated companies
 206.4
 31.7
 (238.1) 
  Other current liabilities1.4
 4.6
 3.7
 
 9.7
Current liabilities of discontinued operations1.0
 
 0.1
 
 1.1
    Total current liabilities16.0
 359.2
 51.8
 (238.1) 188.9
Long-term debt, net of current portion293.5
 
 
 
 293.5
Other long-term liabilities12.1
 7.3
 6.9
 
 26.3
Non-current liabilities of discontinued operations3.8
 
 
 
 3.8
    Total liabilities325.4
 366.5
 58.7
 (238.1) 512.5
Total stockholders’ equity511.5
 483.1
 58.0
 (541.1) 511.5
    Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity$836.9
 $849.6
 $116.7
 $(779.2) $1,024.0



F-41

Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet
December 25, 2016
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Assets         
Current Assets:         
  Cash and cash equivalents$67.2
 $(3.3) $5.2
 $
 $69.1
  Accounts receivable, net
 197.9
 31.5
 
 229.4
  Amounts due from affiliated companies204.6
 
 
 (204.6) 
  Inventoried costs
 37.2
 18.2
 
 55.4
  Other current assets6.3
 11.6
 1.3
 
 19.2
    Total current assets278.1
 243.4
 56.2
 (204.6) 373.1
Property, plant and equipment, net1.6
 41.7
 6.5
 
 49.8
Goodwill
 442.5
 42.9
 
 485.4
Intangible assets, net
 24.5
 8.1
 
 32.6
Investment in subsidiaries458.0
 67.5
 
 (525.5) 
Other assets0.4
 7.3
 
 
 7.7
    Total assets$738.1
 $826.9
 $113.7
 $(730.1) $948.6
Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity         
Current liabilities:         
  Accounts payable$4.5
 $43.7
 $4.5
 $
 $52.7
  Accrued expenses5.6
 44.5
 3.5
 
 53.6
  Accrued compensation4.0
 31.2
 3.9
 
 39.1
  Billings in excess of costs and earnings on uncompleted contracts
 38.9
 2.9
 
 41.8
  Amounts due to affiliated companies
 174.6
 30.0
 (204.6) 
  Other current liabilities1.4
 4.1
 2.2
 
 7.7
  Current liabilities of discontinued operations1.5
 
 0.1
 
 1.6
    Total current liabilities17.0
 337.0
 47.1
 (204.6) 196.5
Long-term debt, net of current portion430.2
 
 0.8
 
 431.0
Other long-term liabilities10.8
 19.9
 10.3
 
 41.0
Non-current liabilities of discontinued operations3.7
 
 
 
 3.7
    Total liabilities461.7
 356.9
 58.2
 (204.6) 672.2
 Total stockholders’ equity276.4
 470.0
 55.5
 (525.5) 276.4
    Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity$738.1
 $826.9
 $113.7
 $(730.1) $948.6

F-42

Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Year Ended December 31, 2017
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Service revenues$
 $334.3
 $12.1
 $
 $346.4
Product sales
 360.2
 60.0
 (14.7) 405.5
  Total revenues
 694.5
 72.1
 (14.7) 751.9
Cost of service revenues
 238.6
 8.9
 
 247.5
Cost of product sales
 274.4
 47.4
 (14.7) 307.1
  Total costs
 513.0
 56.3
 (14.7) 554.6
  Gross profit
 181.5
 15.8
 
 197.3
Selling, general and administrative expenses9.1
 163.6
 12.6
 
 185.3
Research and development expenses
 16.6
 1.2
 
 17.8
  Operating income (loss) from continuing operations(9.1) 1.3
 2.0
 
 (5.8)
Other income (expense):         
  Interest income (expense), net(28.9) 0.2
 0.1
 
 (28.6)
Loss on extinguishment of debt(17.3) 
 
 
 (17.3)
  Other income (expense), net
 0.2
 0.7
 
 0.9
  Total other income (expense), net(46.2) 0.4
 0.8
 
 (45.0)
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes(55.3) 1.7
 2.8
 
 (50.8)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations0.4
 (8.9) 0.3
 
 (8.2)
Income (loss) from continuing operations(55.7) 10.6
 2.5
 
 (42.6)
Loss from discontinued operations(0.1) 
 
 
 (0.1)
Equity in net income (loss) of subsidiaries13.1
 2.5
 
 (15.6) 
Net income (loss)$(42.7) $13.1
 $2.5
 $(15.6) $(42.7)
Comprehensive income (loss)$(42.4) $13.1
 $2.8
 $(15.9) $(42.4)


F-43

Table of Contents


Condensed Consolidating Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Year Ended December 25, 2016
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Service revenues$
 $330.9
 $17.2
 $
 $348.1
Product sales
 273.8
 54.6
 (7.8) 320.6
  Total revenues
 604.7
 71.8
 (7.8) 668.7
Cost of service revenues
 244.0
 11.8
 
 255.8
Cost of product sales
 225.0
 42.1
 (7.8) 259.3
  Total costs
 469.0
 53.9
 (7.8) 515.1
  Gross profit
 135.7
 17.9
 
 153.6
Selling, general and administrative expenses6.3
 142.3
 9.7
 
 158.3
Research and development expenses
 13.5
 0.4
 
 13.9
  Operating income (loss) from continuing operations(6.3) (20.1) 7.8
 
 (18.6)
Other income (expense):         
  Interest expense, net(34.6) (0.1) 
 
 (34.7)
  Gain on extinguishment of debt0.2
 
 
 
 0.2
  Other income (expense), net
 0.2
 0.6
 
 0.8
  Total other income (expense), net(34.4) 0.1
 0.6
 
 (33.7)
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes(40.7) (20.0) 8.4
 
 (52.3)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations(0.1) 7.0
 1.2
 
 8.1
Income (loss) from continuing operations(40.6) (27.0) 7.2
 
 (60.4)
Loss from discontinued operations(0.1) 
 
 
 (0.1)
Equity in net income (loss) of subsidiaries(19.8) 7.2
 
 12.6
 
Net income (loss)$(60.5) $(19.8) $7.2
 $12.6
 $(60.5)
Comprehensive income (loss)$(60.8) $(19.8) $6.9
 $12.9
 $(60.8)

F-44

Table of Contents


Condensed Consolidating Statement of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss)
Year Ended December 27, 2015
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Service revenues$
 $339.0
 $15.2
 $
 $354.2
Product sales
 262.3
 56.3
 (15.7) 302.9
  Total revenues
 601.3
 71.5
 (15.7) 657.1
Cost of service revenues
 255.5
 11.0
 
 266.5
Cost of product sales
 203.1
 41.4
 (15.7) 228.8
  Total costs
 458.6
 52.4
 (15.7) 495.3
  Gross profit
 142.7
 19.1
 
 161.8
Selling, general and administrative expenses10.1
 130.8
 9.2
 
 150.1
Research and development expenses
 15.7
 0.5
 
 16.2
Operating income (loss) from continuing operations(10.1) (3.8) 9.4
 
 (4.5)
Other income (expense):    .    
  Interest expense, net(35.8) (0.1) (0.1) 
 (36.0)
Loss on extinguishment of debt(3.4) 
 
 
 (3.4)
  Other income (expense), net
 (3.3) 2.6
 
 (0.7)
  Total other income (expense), net(39.2) (3.4) 2.5
 
 (40.1)
Income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes(49.3) (7.2) 11.9
 
 (44.6)
Provision (benefit) for income taxes from continuing operations(17.8) 4.4
 2.0
 
 (11.4)
Income (loss) from continuing operations(31.5) (11.6) 9.9
 
 (33.2)
Income (loss) from discontinued operations71.8
 (21.1) 2.3
 
 53.0
Equity in net income (loss) of subsidiaries(20.5) 12.2
 
 8.3
 
Net income (loss)$19.8
 $(20.5) $12.2
 $8.3
 $19.8
Comprehensive income (loss)$20.1
 $(20.5) $12.3
 $8.2
 $20.1


F-45

Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows
Year Ended December 31, 2017
(in million)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities from continuing operations$(25.9) $(8.8) $7.7
 $
 $(27.0)
Investing activities:         
  Investment in affiliated companies(33.2) 
 
 33.2
 
  Capital expenditures(0.8) (23.9) (1.8) 
 (26.5)
Proceeds from sale of assets
 0.7
 
 
 0.7
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities from continuing operations(34.0) (23.2) (1.8) 33.2
 (25.8)
Financing activities:         
  Proceeds from the issuance of long-term debt300.0
 
 
 
 300.0
  Extinguishment of long-term debt(448.8) 
 
 
 (448.8)
Repayments under credit facility
 
 (1.0) 
 (1.0)
  Debt issuance costs(6.6) 
 
 
 (6.6)
  Proceeds from the issuance of common stock269.1
 
 
 
 269.1
Proceeds from exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, employee stock purchase plan, and other0.7
 
 
 
 0.7
  Financings from affiliated companies
 33.2
 
 (33.2) 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities from continuing operations114.4
 33.2
 (1.0) (33.2) 113.4
Net cash flows of continuing operations54.5
 1.2
 4.9
 
 60.6
Net investing cash flows from discontinued operations(0.6) 
 
 
 (0.6)
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
 
 0.5
 
 0.5
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents$53.9
 $1.2
 $5.4
 $
 $60.5


F-46

Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows
Year Ended December 25, 2016
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities from continuing operations$(26.3) $16.6
 $(2.7) $
 $(12.4)
Investing activities:  
 
    
  Cash paid for acquisitions, net of cash acquired
 (5.1) 
 
 (5.1)
  Change in restricted cash
 0.3
 
 
 0.3
  Investment in affiliated companies
 (3.0) 
 3.0
 
  Capital expenditures(0.5) (7.1) (1.6) 
 (9.2)
  Proceeds from the sale of assets
 0.1
 
 
 0.1
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities from continuing operations(0.5) (14.8) (1.6) 3.0
 (13.9)
Financing activities:         
Extinguishment of long-term debt(14.1) 
 
 
 (14.1)
Repayments under credit facility
 
 (1.0) 
 (1.0)
Proceeds from the issuance of common stock76.2
 
 
 
 76.2
Proceeds from exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, and employee stock purchase plan2.0
 
 
 
 2.0
  Financings from affiliated companies3.0
 
 
 (3.0) 
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities from continuing operations67.1
 
 (1.0) (3.0) 63.1
Net cash flows of continuing operations40.3
 1.8
 (5.3) 
 36.8
Net operating cash flows from discontinued operations0.4
 (0.3) 
 
 0.1
Net investing cash flows from discontinued operations4.0
 
 
 
 4.0
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
 
 (0.3) 
 (0.3)
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents$44.7
 $1.5
 $(5.6) $
 $40.6


F-47

Table of Contents

Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows
Year Ended December 27, 2015
(in millions)
 Parent Company Subsidiary Guarantors on a Combined Basis Non-Guarantors on a Combined Basis Eliminations Consolidated
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities from continuing operations$(2.0) $(30.8) $3.1
 $
 $(29.7)
Investing activities:         
  Change in restricted cash
 4.7
 
 
 4.7
  Investment in affiliated companies(33.8) 
 
 33.8
 
  Capital expenditures(1.0) (9.5) (0.8) 
 (11.3)
Proceeds from the sale of assets
 0.9
 
 
 0.9
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities from continuing operations(34.8) (3.9) (0.8) 33.8
 (5.7)
Financing activities:         
  Extinguishment of long-term debt(175.0) 
 
 
 (175.0)
Repayments under credit facility(41.0) 
 (1.0) 
 (42.0)
Proceeds from exercise of restricted stock units, employee stock options, and employee stock purchase plan3.4
 
 
 
 3.4
  Financing from affiliated companies
 33.8
 
 (33.8) 
Other, net
 (1.1) 
 
 (1.1)
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities from continuing operations(212.6) 32.7
 (1.0) (33.8) (214.7)
Net cash flows of continuing operations(249.4) (2.0) 1.3
 
 (250.1)
Net operating cash flows from discontinued operations
 3.1
 (0.3) 
 2.8
Net investing cash flows from discontinued operations243.2
 (0.4) (0.3) 
 242.5
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
 
 (0.2) 
 (0.2)
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents$(6.2) $0.7
 $0.5
 $
 $(5.0)


F-48

Table of Contents

Note 17.     Subsequent Event

TheOn February 24, 2020, the Company announcedacquired a turbine technology company focused on February 28, 2018 that it has signed a definitive agreement to divest its PSS businesstactical unmanned aerial drones and other systems for approximately $69$10.5 million in cash, subject to a netadjustments for transaction expenses, indebtedness, cash on hand, and post-closing working capital target at closing, with the estimated net cash proceeds expected to be received by Kratos of approximately $70 million including a negotiated transaction services agreement amount between the two companies, receipt by Kratos of approximately $7 million in net working capital retained by Kratos, and associated transaction fees and expenses. The transaction is expected to close in the next 90 days, contingent on customary closing and regulatory conditions. As a result of the expected divestiture, the PSS segment will be reflected as a discontinued operation going forward in the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Accordingly, all prior year financial statement comparative data in future periodic filings will be recast to reflect this business as discontinued operations for all periods presented.adjustments.





F-49F-41